FUJIFILM Business Innovation H825CDW Color Multifunction Printer User Manual
Fuji Xerox Co., Ltd. Color Multifunction Printer
Contents
- 1. (Short-Term Confidential) User manual_1
- 2. (Short-Term Confidential) User manual_2
- 3. (Short-Term Confidential) User Manual-Important Info
- 4. (Short-Term Confidential) User Manual-Regulatory Info for USA
(Short-Term Confidential) User manual_1
Dell™ Color Cloud Multifunction Printer | H625cdw Dell™ Color Cloud Multifunction Printer | H825cdw Dell™ Color Smart Multifunction Printer | S2825cdn User's Guide Regulatory Model: H625cdw H825cdw S2825cdn Notes, Cautions, and Warnings NOTE: • A NOTE indicates important information that helps you make better use of the printer. CAUTION: • A CAUTION indicates potential damage to hardware or loss of data if instructions are not followed. WARNING: • A WARNING indicates a potential for property damage, personal injury, or death. Information in this document is subject to change without notice. © 2015 Dell Inc. All rights reserved. Reproduction of these materials in any manner whatsoever without the written permission of Dell Inc. is strictly forbidden. Trademarks used in this text: Dell and the DELL logo are trademarks of Dell Inc. Microsoft, Windows, Windows Server, and Windows Vista are either trademarks or registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation in the United States and/or other countries. Bonjour, iPhone, Macintosh, Mac OS, and AirPrint are trademarks of Apple Inc., registered in the U.S. and other countries. Adobe, PostScript, and Photoshop are either registered trademarks or trademarks of Adobe Systems Incorporated in the United States and/or other countries. RSA and BSAFE are either registered trademarks or trademarks of EMC Corporation in the United States and/or other countries. Microsoft product screen shot(s) reprinted with permission from Microsoft Corporation. Other trademarks and trade names may be used in this document to refer to either the entities claiming the marks and names or their products. Dell Inc. disclaims any proprietary interest in trademarks and trade names other than its own. About License XML Paper Specification (XPS): This product may incorporate intellectual property owned by Microsoft Corporation. The terms and conditions upon which Microsoft is licensing such intellectual property may be found at http://go.microsoft.com/fwlink/?LinkId=52369; DES: This product includes software developed by Eric Young (eay@mincom.oz.au); AES: Copyright (c) 2003, Dr Brian Gladman, Worcester, UK. All rights reserved. This product uses published AES software provided by Dr Brian Gladman under BSD licensing terms; TIFF (libtiff): Copyright (c) 1988-1997 Sam Leffler and Copyright (c) 1991-1997 Silicon Graphics, Inc.; ICC Profile (Little cms): Copyright (c) 1998-2004 Marti Maria. As for RSA BSAFE This printer includes RSA® BSAFE® Cryptographic software from EMC Corporation. ICC Profile Header Copyright (c) 1994-1996 SunSoft, Inc. Rights Reserved Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to the following conditions: The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NON-INFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL SUNSOFT, INC. OR ITS PARENT COMPANY BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. Except as contained in this notice, the name of SunSoft, Inc. shall not be used in advertising or otherwise to promote the sale, use or other dealings in this Software without written authorization from SunSoft Inc. JPEG Library Independent JPEG Group's free JPEG software ____________________ This package contains C software to implement JPEG image encoding, decoding, and transcoding. JPEG is a standardized compression method for full-color and gray-scale images. The distributed programs provide conversion between JPEG "JFIF" format and image files in PBMPLUS PPM/PGM, GIF, BMP, and Targa file formats. The core compression and decompression library can easily be reused in other programs, such as image viewers. The package is highly portable C code; we have tested it on many machines ranging from PCs to Crays. We are releasing this software for both noncommercial and commercial use. Companies are welcome to use it as the basis for JPEG-related products. We do not ask a royalty, although we do ask for an acknowledgement in product literature (see the README file in the distribution for details). We hope to make this software industrial-quality --- although, as with anything that's free, we offer no warranty and accept no liability. For more information, contact jpeg-info@jpegclub.org. Contents of this directory ____________________ jpegsrc.vN.tar.gz contains source code, documentation, and test files for release N in Unix format. jpegsrN.zip contains source code, documentation, and test files for release N in Windows format. jpegaltui.vN.tar.gz contains source code for an alternate user interface for cjpeg/djpeg in Unix format. jpegaltuiN.zip contains source code for an alternate user interface for cjpeg/djpeg in Windows format. wallace.ps.gz is a PostScript file of Greg Wallace's introductory article about JPEG. This is an update of the article that appeared in the April 1991 Communications of the ACM. jpeg.documents.gz tells where to obtain the JPEG standard and documents about JPEG-related file formats. jfif.ps.gz is a PostScript file of the JFIF (JPEG File Interchange Format) format specification. jfif.txt.gz is a plain text transcription of the JFIF specification; it's missing a figure, so use the PostScript version if you can. TIFFTechNote2.txt.gz is a draft of the proposed revisions to TIFF 6.0's JPEG support. pm.errata.gz is the errata list for the first printing of the textbook "JPEG Still Image Data Compression Standard" by Pennebaker and Mitchell. jdosaobj.zip contains pre-assembled object files for JMEMDOSA.ASM. If you want to compile the IJG code for MS-DOS, but don't have an assembler, these files may be helpful. Math Library Copyright (C) 1993 by Sun Microsystems, Inc. All rights reserved. Developed at SunPro, a Sun Microsystems, Inc. business. Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software is freely granted, provided that this notice is preserved. ==================================================== copysignf.c: * Copyright (C) 1993 by Sun Microsystems, Inc. All rights reserved. math_private.h: * Copyright (C) 1993 by Sun Microsystems, Inc. All rights reserved. powf.c: * Copyright (C) 1993 by Sun Microsystems, Inc. All rights reserved. scalbnf.c: * Copyright (C) 1993 by Sun Microsystems, Inc. All rights reserved. libtiff Copyright (C) 1988-1997 Sam Leffler Copyright (C) 1991-1997 Silicon Graphics, Inc. Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted without fee, provided that (i) the above copyright notices and this permission notice appear in all copies of the software and related documentation, and (ii) the names of Sam Leffler and Silicon Graphics may not be used in any advertising or publicity relating to the software without the specific, prior written permission of Sam Leffler and Silicon Graphics. THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS-IS" AND WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS, IMPLIED OR OTHERWISE, INCLUDING WITHOUT LIMITATION, ANY WARRANTY OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. IN NO EVENT SHALL SAM LEFFLER OR SILICON GRAPHICS BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OF ANY KIND, OR ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER OR NOT ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF DAMAGE, AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE. Zlib zlib.h -- interface of the 'zlib' general purpose compression library version 1.2.8, April 28th, 2013 Copyright (C) 1995-2013 Jean-loup Gailly and Mark Adler This software is provided 'as-is', without any express or implied warranty. In no event will the authors be held liable for any damages arising from the use of this software. Permission is granted to anyone to use this software for any purpose, including commercial applications, and to alter it and redistribute it freely, subject to the following restrictions: 1. The origin of this software must not be misrepresented; you must not claim that you wrote the original software. If you use this software in a product, an acknowledgment in the product documentation would be appreciated but is not required. 2. Altered source versions must be plainly marked as such, and must not be misrepresented as being the original software. 3. This notice may not be removed or altered from any source distribution. Jean-loup Gailly Mark Adler jloup@gzip.org madler@alumni.caltech.edu ____________________ UNITED STATES GOVERNMENT RESTRICTED RIGHTS This software and documentation are provided with RESTRICTED RIGHTS. Use, duplication or disclosure by the Government is subject to restrictions as set forth in subparagraph (c)(1)(ii) of the Rights in Technical Data and Computer Software clause at DFARS 252.227-7013 and in applicable FAR provisions: Dell Inc., One Dell Way, Round Rock, Texas, 78682, USA. October 2015 Rev. A00 Contents Notes, Cautions, and Warnings About License 1 Before Beginning 20 About This Guide 21 Conventions 21 Finding Information 22 Product Features 23 Printer Overview 26 Front and Rear View 26 Front View 26 Rear View 27 Duplex Automatic Document Feeder (DADF) 28 Operator Panel 28 Status of Wi-Fi Button LED 30 Optional Accessory 30 2 Setting Up the Printer 31 Overview of the Printer Setup 32 Preparing to Set Up the Printer 33 Space Requirements 33 Securing the Printer 33 Connecting Your Printer to a Telephone Line 34 Connecting the Printer to the Wall Jack 34 Connecting the Printer to a Modem 35 Connecting a Telephone or Answering Machine 35 Turning On/Off the Printer 37 Turning On the Printer 37 Turning Off the Printer 38 Setting Initial Settings on the Operator Panel 38 Connecting Your Printer to a Computer 44 Overview 44 Connecting to a Wireless Network 45 ® Contents Connecting With Dell Printer Easy Install (Windows Only) 45 Connecting With WPS 46 Manually Connecting to a Wireless Network 47 Changing the Wireless Settings 49 Connecting to a Wired (Ethernet) Network 49 Connecting the Ethernet Cable 49 Connecting With Dell Printer Easy Install (Windows® Only) 50 Configuring With Other Methods 50 Connecting to a Computer With USB 51 Connecting the USB Cable 51 Connecting With Dell Printer Easy Install (Windows® Only) 51 Configuring With Other Methods 52 ® Installing the Software for Windows Computers 52 Installing the Software and Print Drivers with Dell Printer Easy Install 52 Installing the Software and Print Drivers When the Printer is Connected to the Network or Computer 52 Setting Up for Web Services on Devices (WSD) 57 Installing the Software for Macintosh Computers 58 Installing the Software and Print Drivers 58 Adding a Printer Using USB Connection 58 Adding a Printer Using IP Printing 58 Adding a Printer Using Bonjour 59 Configuring With Optional Accessories 60 Connecting Your Printer to Mobile Devices 61 Overview 61 Wi-Fi Direct 61 Setting Up Wi-Fi Direct 61 Printing via Wi-Fi Direct 63 Disconnecting Wi-Fi Direct Network 63 Resetting the Passphrase 64 Resetting the PIN 64 Dell Document Hub 64 Android 64 iOS 64 Tap To Print/Scan 65 Preparations 65 Adding the Printer to the Mobile Device 65 Printing or Scanning 66 AirPrint 66 Setting Up AirPrint on Your Printer 66 Printing via AirPrint 67 Google Cloud Print 67 Preparing to Use the Printer With Google Cloud Print 67 Selecting the Version of the Google Cloud Print Service 67 Registering the Printer to Your Google Account 68 Sharing the Printer With the Google Cloud Print Service 69 Contents Canceling the Registration to Google Cloud Print 70 Printing via Google Cloud Print 70 Mopria Print Service Setting Up Mopria Print Service on Your Printer 71 Printing via Mopria Print Service 71 Installing Print Drivers on Linux Computers Using Common UNIX Printing System (CUPS) Operation on Red Hat Enterprise Linux 6 Desktop 72 72 Installing the Print Driver 72 Setting Up the Print Queue 72 Setting Up the Default Queue 73 Specifying the Printing Options 73 Uninstalling the Print Driver 74 74 Setup Overview 74 Installing the Print Driver 74 Setting Up the Print Queue 75 Setting Up the Default Queue 75 Specifying the Printing Options 76 Setting the Password for Authority as the Printer Administrator 76 Uninstalling the Print Driver 76 Operation on Ubuntu 12.04 LTS 77 Setup Overview 77 Installing the Print Driver 77 Setting the IP Address Assigning an IP Address 80 80 When Using the Dell Printer Easy Install (Windows® Only) 80 When Using the Operator Panel 81 Verifying the IP Settings 81 Verifying the Settings Using Operator Panel 82 Verifying the Settings Using System Settings Report 82 3 Using Your Printer Using the Operator Panel 83 84 About the Home Screen 84 Basic Operations on the Touch Panel 85 Selecting the Item on the Screen 85 Scrolling the Screen or the Listed Items 85 Moving, Adding or Deleting the Tiles 72 Setup Overview Operation on SUSE Linux Enterprise Desktop 11 71 Contents 86 To Move the Tiles 86 To Add the Tiles 86 To Delete the Tiles 87 Using the Keyboard Displayed on the Touch Panel 87 To Change the Keyboard Layout 87 Changing the Language 88 Panel Lock 88 Enabling the Panel Lock 88 Changing the Panel Lock Password 88 Disabling the Panel Lock 89 Setting the Power Saver Timer 89 About the Concurrent Jobs Feature 89 Understanding the System Menus 90 Report / List 90 System Settings 90 Panel Settings 90 PCL Fonts List 90 PCL Macros List 90 PS Fonts List 90 PDF Fonts List 90 Job History 90 Error History 91 Print Meter 91 Color Test Page 91 Protocol Monitor 91 Speed Dial 91 Address Book 91 Server Address 91 Fax Activity 91 Fax Pending 91 Stored Documents 91 Printing a Report / List 92 Wi-Fi | WPS 92 Wi-Fi 92 Wi-Fi Direct 92 WPS (Connect via PBC) 92 WPS (Connect via PIN) 92 Paired Device 92 Admin Settings 92 Phone Book 93 PCL 93 PS 95 PDF 96 Network 97 Ethernet 101 Fax Settings 104 System Settings 109 Contents Maintenance 115 Secure Settings 117 USB Settings 120 Default Settings 121 Copy Defaults 121 Fax Defaults 121 Scan Defaults 121 Direct Print Defaults/USB Direct Print Defaults 122 Tray Management Tray Settings 122 Tray Priority 123 Language Settings 123 Panel Language 123 Keyboard Layout 123 Resetting Defaults Understanding the Job Menus Print 125 125 125 Private Mailbox 125 Public Mailbox 125 Proof Print 126 Secure Fax Receive 126 Tile Settings 126 126 Quantity 126 Darken/Lighten 126 Output Color 127 Select Tray 127 2 Sided Copying 127 Sharpness 127 Reduce/Enlarge 127 Original Size 127 Original Type 128 Collation 128 2-Up 128 Color Saturation 128 Margin 128 Auto Exposure 128 Save Settings 128 ID Copy Save Settings 123 Secure Print Copy 10 122 128 129 Scan to Email 129 Scan to Network Folder 129 Scan to USB 129 Contents Scan to Computer 130 Tile Settings 130 Scan Settings 130 Save Settings 132 Fax 132 Fax Settings 132 Save Settings 133 Print PDF/TIFF 133 Print JPEG 133 Print Settings 134 Dell Document Hub 135 Search for Files 135 Browse for Files 135 Scan 136 Smart OCR Scan 136 E-mail Me 137 Business Card Reader 138 Add App 138 Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool 139 Preparing to Use the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool Setting Up Internet 139 Explorer® 139 Confirming the Menu on the Operator Panel 139 Starting the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool 140 Page Display Format 140 Top Frame 140 Left Frame 141 Right Frame 142 Changing the Settings of the Menu Items 142 Details of the Menu Items 143 Printer Status 145 Printer Jobs 146 Printer Settings 146 Print Server Settings 159 Copy Printer Settings 179 Print Volume 179 Address Book 181 Tray Management 185 Print Media Guidelines 187 Supported Print Media 187 Multipurpose Feeder (MPF) 187 Tray1 188 Optional 550-Sheet Feeder 189 Supported Paper Weight 190 Contents 11 Unacceptable Print Media 190 Recommended Print Media 190 Recommended Pre-Printed Media and Letterheads 191 Recommended Pre-Punched Print Media 191 Recommended Envelopes 191 Recommended Labels 192 Print Media Storage Guidelines 192 Loading Print Media 193 Before Loading 193 Loading Print Media in Tray1 and the Optional 550-Sheet Feeder 193 Loading Envelopes in the Tray1 Loading Print Media in the Multipurpose Feeder (MPF) 197 198 Loading Envelopes in the MPF 200 Loading Labels in the MPF 201 Loading Letterhead, Pre-Printed, and Pre-Punched Paper 202 Linking Trays 202 Loading Documents 204 Before Loading Documents in the DADF 204 Loading a Document in the Duplex Automatic Document Feeder (DADF) 204 Loading a Document on the Document Glass 205 4 Printing, Copying, Scanning, Faxing, and Dell Document Hub 207 Printing Sending a Job to Print 208 Canceling a Print Job 208 Canceling a Job From the Operator Panel 208 Canceling a Job From a Computer 209 Duplex Printing 209 Using Booklet Print 210 211 Overview 211 Procedures for Printing Stored Print 213 Printing From USB Flash Drive 214 Supported USB Flash Drive 214 Supported File Formats 215 Printing a PDF/TIFF or JPEG File in a USB Flash Drive 215 Printer Settings Copying Making Copies From the Document Glass 209 Using Duplex Print Using Stored Print 12 208 Contents 216 217 217 Making Copies From the DADF 217 Using the ID Copy 218 Changing the Default Copy Settings 218 Scanning 220 Scanning Overview 220 Tips for Easy Network Scanning 221 Scanning to a Computer With a USB Connection 221 Scanning to a Computer With a Network Connection 221 Printer Setup for Scan to Web Services on Devices (WSD) 221 Scanning and Sending Images to the Computer 222 Scanning From a Computer Using Web Services on Devices (WSD) 223 Preparations for Scanning From the Computer 224 Scanning From the Computer 224 Scanning Using the TWAIN Driver 224 ® Scanning Using the Windows Image Acquisition (WIA) Driver 225 Scanning an Image From the Drawing Software 226 Scanning Using Wi-Fi Direct 226 Scanning via Wi-Fi Direct 227 Scanning to a Computer or Server With SMB/FTP 227 Overview 227 Overview for Scanning to an FTP Server 228 Overview for Scanning to a Shared Folder Using SMB 228 Setting a User Account (SMB Only) 228 Creating a Shared Folder (SMB Only) 229 Setting SMB/FTP Destination Into the Address Book 231 Sending the Scanned Data on the Network 236 Scanning to a USB Flash Drive 237 Procedures 237 Specifying a Folder to Save the Scanned Data 237 Sending a Scanned Data via E-Mail 238 Gathering the Necessary Information About Your E-mail Account 238 Setting the DNS Server Address 238 Setting the Information Necessary to Access the Mail Server 239 Registering a Destination E-Mail Address to Address Book 240 Sending an E-mail With the Scanned Data 241 Managing the Scanner 242 Port Settings 242 Password Settings 243 Changing the Default Scan Setting 244 Faxing 245 Initial Settings 245 Specifying the Fax Initial Settings Using the Dell Printer Easy Install 245 Specifying the Fax Initial Settings Using the Operator Panel 246 Contents 13 Changing the Fax Settings 246 Sending a Fax 246 Sending a Fax From Memory 246 Sending a Fax Manually 248 Confirming Transmissions 248 Automatic Redialing 248 Sending a Delayed Fax 249 Sending a Fax Directly From a Computer 249 Overview 250 Procedure 250 Automatic Dialing 254 Speed Dialing 254 Group Dialing 255 Printing a Speed Dial List 256 Phone Book 257 Receiving a Fax 257 Loading Paper for Receiving Faxes 257 Receiving a Fax Automatically 258 Receiving a Fax Manually 258 Receiving Faxes Using the Distinctive Ring Pattern Detection (DRPD) 258 Receiving Faxes in the Secure Receiving Mode 259 Receiving Faxes in the Memory 260 Polling Receive 260 Reports Related to Fax 260 Changing the Default Fax Setting 261 Dell™ Document Hub (Windows® Only) Registering the User and Signing In to the Dell Document Hub 262 262 Registering a New User to the Dell Document Hub 262 Signing In to the Dell Document Hub 263 Icons for the Dell Document Hub Screens 263 When the Favorite List Screen Is Displayed When You Tap the Tile on the Dell Document Hub Screen 264 Returning to the Home Screen 264 Logging Out From the Printer 264 Searching for and Printing Files 264 Browsing and Printing Files 265 Scanning 267 Scanning the Document Using Optical Character Recognition (OCR) 268 Sending the Scanned Data to Yourself via E-Mail 269 Sending a Scanned Data of a Business Card to Yourself via E-Mail 270 5 Know Your Printer Understanding the Software of Your Printer 14 Contents 271 272 Overview 272 Dell Printer Hub/Dell Print Management Tool 272 Printer Status Window 273 Status Monitor Console/Status Monitor Widget 273 Tool Box 273 Address Book Editor 273 Dell™ Supplies Management System 273 User Setup Disk Creating Tool 273 App Manager 274 Using the Status Monitor Widget for Macintosh 275 Status Monitor Widget 275 Before Installing the Status Monitor Widget 275 Installing the Status Monitor Widget 276 Opening and Closing the Status Monitor Widget 276 Printer Status Window 276 Order Window 278 Preferences 279 Using the Status Monitor Console for Linux 279 Status Monitor Console 279 Before Installing the Status Monitor Console 280 Installing the Status Monitor Console 280 Starting the Status Monitor Console 280 Printer Selection Window 280 Printer Status Window 281 Dell Supplies Management System Window 282 Service Tag Window 284 Settings Window 284 Software Update 285 User Authentication 286 Creating and Editing the User Accounts 286 Creating a New User Account 286 Editing the User Account 287 Deleting the User Account 287 Logging In to the User Account 287 Logging In Using the Touch Panel 288 Logging In Using the NFC Authentication Card 288 Logging In Using the Local Authentication or Remote Authentication 288 Logging Out 289 Multiple Desktop - Tile Customization 290 Adding a New Tile 290 Selecting From the Pre-defined Tiles 290 Creating a New Tile Including the Job Settings 290 Contents 15 Using the Address Book and Phone Book 292 Types of Address Books 292 Adding and Editing Entries to the Address Books 292 Using Operator Panel of the Printer 293 Using Address Book Editor 293 Address Book Panel 293 Editing an Entry 293 Using Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool 294 Using the Server Address Book and Server Phone Book 294 Preparing the Printer to Access the External LDAP Server 294 Starting the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool 294 Setting Authentication Type 294 Setting LDAP Server 295 Setting LDAP User Mapping 296 Sending an E-mail With the Scanned Data Using the E-mail Server Address Book 297 Sending a Fax Using the Fax Server Phone Book 297 Using Digital Certificates 298 Managing Certificates 298 Preparing to Use HTTPS Communication 298 Creating and Downloading a Certificate Signing Request (CSR) 299 Importing a Digital Certificate 299 Setting a Digital Certificate 300 Confirming the Settings of a Digital Certificate 300 Deleting a Digital Certificate 301 Exporting a Digital Certificate 301 Setting the Features 302 Setting the Certificate in the IPsec Digital Signature Mode 302 Setting the SSL-Use Server Certificate (HTTP/IPP) 303 Setting SMTP-SSL/TLS Communication 303 Setting LDAP-SSL/TLS Communication 303 Setting for Wireless LAN WPA-Enterprise (EAP-TLS) 304 Setting for Wireless LAN WPA-Enterprise (PEAPV0-MS-CHAPV2, EAP-TTLS PAP, EAPTTLS CHAP) 305 Setting Client Certificate for IEEE 802.1x (EAP-TLS) 306 Understanding Printer Messages Status Codes 307 Error Messages 314 Specifications 16 307 317 Operating System Compatibility 317 Power Supply 317 Dimensions 317 Weight 318 Contents Memory 318 Page Description Language (PDL)/Emulation, Operating System, and Interface 318 Management Information Base (MIB) Compatibility 319 Environment 319 Operation 319 Print Quality Guarantee 319 Storage 319 Altitude 319 Cables 319 Print Specifications 319 Copy Specifications 320 Scanner Specifications 322 Fax Specifications 322 Wireless Connection Specifications 323 6 Maintaining Your Printer 324 Maintaining Your Printer 325 Checking the Status of Supplies 325 E-mail Alert Setting 325 Conserving Supplies 325 Ordering Supplies 325 Using Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool 325 Using the Dell Supplies Management System 326 Storing Print Media 326 Storing Consumables 326 Replacing the Toner Cartridges 327 Removing the Toner Cartridge 327 Installing a Toner Cartridge 328 Replacing the Drum Cartridges 329 Removing the Drum Cartridge 329 Installing a Drum Cartridge 332 Replacing the Waste Toner Box 334 Removing the Waste Toner Box 334 Installing a Waste Toner Box 336 Cleaning Inside the Printer 337 Cleaning the Color Toner Density (CTD) Sensor 337 Cleaning the LED Print Head 338 Cleaning the Scanner 341 Cleaning the DADF Feed Rollers 343 Moving the Printer 343 Removing Options 345 Removing the Optional 550-Sheet Feeder 345 Contents 17 7 Troubleshooting Troubleshooting Clearing Jams 348 348 Identifying the Location of Paper Jams 348 Clearing Paper Jams From the DADF 348 Clearing Paper Jams From the Multipurpose Feeder (MPF) and Tray1 351 Clearing Paper Jams From Inside the Rear Cover 353 Clearing Paper Jams From the Optional 550-Sheet Feeder 357 Basic Printer Problems 358 Display Problems 359 Printing Problems 359 Print Quality Problems 360 Light Printout 361 Smearing Toner/Loose Toner 362 Random Spots/Blurred Images 363 Blank Printout 363 Streaks 364 Black Printout (Partial or Entire Page) 365 Equally Spaced Colored Dots 365 Vertical Blanks 366 Mottle 367 Ghosting 367 Light-Induced Fatigue 368 Fog 369 Bead-Carry-Out (BCO) 369 Jagged Characters 370 Horizontal Bands 370 Diagonal Lines 371 Wrinkled/Stained Printout 371 Damage on the Leading Edge of Printout 372 Jam/Alignment Problems 18 347 372 Incorrect Margins on the Top and Side 373 Disorganized Color Registration 373 Skewed Images 373 Tray1/Optional 550-Sheet Feeder Misfeed Jam 374 Multipurpose Feeder (MPF) Misfeed Jam 374 Regi Jam (Exit Sensor On JAM) 375 Tray1/Optional 550-Sheet Feeder Multi-feed Jam 375 Multipurpose Feeder (MPF) Multi-feed Jam 376 Noise 376 Copy Problems 376 Fax Problems 377 Scanning Problems 378 Contents Digital Certificate Problems 380 Wireless Problems 381 Problems With Installed Optional 550-sheet feeder 382 Wi-Fi Direct Problems 382 Scanner Driver/Printer Utility Problems 383 Other Problems 383 Contacting Service 383 Appendix 384 Appendix 385 Dell™ Technical Support Policy 385 Online Services 385 Warranty and Return Policy 385 Recycling Information 385 Contacting Dell 385 Contents 19 1 Before Beginning 20 About This Guide 21 Finding Information 22 Product Features 23 Printer Overview 26 About This Guide Click the bookmarks to the left for information on the features, optional accessory, and operation of your Dell H625cdw, Dell H825cdw, or Dell S2825cdn. For details about other documentation included with your printer, see "Finding Information." NOTE: • In this manual, Dell H625cdw, Dell H825cdw, or Dell S2825cdn is referred to as the "printer." • In this manual, the procedures for the computer are explained using Microsoft® Windows® 7 unless stated otherwise. • The images and screenshots used in this manual are those of the Dell H825cdw unless otherwise mentioned. Conventions The following describe the meaning of the symbols and fonts used in this manual: Item Description Bold texts • Names of hardware button on the operator panel. • Menus, commands, windows, or dialog boxes displayed on the computer screen. Texts in Courier New font • • • • • Key on the keyboard of the computer. Menus and messages displayed on the touch panel. Screen name on the touch panel. Characters entered from the computer. Directory paths. • Indicates a process flow. • Cross references in this manual. • Characters entered from the operator panel. • Messages displayed on the computer screen. About This Guide 21 Finding Information What are you looking for? Find it here Drivers and manuals for my printer Software and Documentation disc: The Software and Documentation disc contains manuals, drivers, and software for the printer. You can use the Software and Documentation disc to install drivers and software, and refer to manuals. Readme files may be included on your Software and Documentation disc to provide last-minute updates about technical changes to the printer or advanced technical reference material for experienced users or technicians. How to set up my printer Setup Guide How to use my printer Safety information Warranty information Important Information WARNING: • Read and follow all safety instructions in the Important Information prior to setting up and operating the printer. Express Service Code and Service The Express Service Code and Service Tag are located inside the front Tag cover of the printer. Service Tag ABCD123 Express Service Code 01234567890 Latest drivers for my printer Visit www.dell.com/support. Documentation for my printer Answers to technical service and support questions Visit www.dell.com/support. Select your region, and fill in the requested details to access help tools and information. www.dell.com/support provides several online tools, including: • Solutions — Troubleshooting hints and tips, articles from technicians, and online courses • Upgrades — Upgrade information for components, such as the print drivers • Customer Care — Contact information, order status, warranty, and repair information • Downloads — Drivers • Manuals— Printer documentation and product specifications 22 Finding Information Product Features This chapter describes the product features and indicates their links. Dell Document Hub App Easily access and share documents, images and digital content with the Dell Document Hub App. This innovative cloud collaboration solution connects your printer and devices to popular cloud services, providing a flexible and secure way to collaborate from virtually anywhere. Using your computer or mobile device, you can search file across multiple cloud services simultaneously to print documents or you can scan documents directly to the cloud using the app. For downloading the app, please visit Microsoft® Windows Store, Google® Play Store and Apple® App Store. For more information about using Dell Document Hub, see the FAQs in Dell.com/documenthub. Dell Print Management Tool (Dell S2825cdn) Dell Print Management Tool is a program that monitorT and informT you of the printer status and allowT you to customize the printer settings. The program also notifJFT you of the firmware/ software updates. Dell Print Management Tool is included on your Software and Documentation disc and is installed with the manuals, drivers, and software for the printer. For more information, open the program and click on the top right of the main window to see the FAQs. Dell Printer Hub (Dell H625cdw and Dell H825cdw) Dell Printer Hub is a program that monitorT and informT you of the printer status and allowT you to customize the printer settings. The program also notifJFT you of the firmware/software updates. For convenient use, you can access the Dell Document Hub from the Dell Printer Hub. Dell Printer Hub is included on your Software and Documentation disc and is installed with the manuals, drivers, and software for the printer. For more information, open the program and click on the top right of the main window to see the FAQs. Converting and storing with Dell Document Hub (Dell H625cdw and Dell H825cdw) You can scan hard copy documents and store them directly in your preferred cloud storage service with the Dell Document Hub. You can also convert hard copy documents into editable digital content before sending them to the cloud storage. See "Scanning the Document Using Optical Character Recognition (OCR)." Product Features 23 Printing with Dell Document Hub (Dell H625cdw and Dell H825cdw) You can easily locate and print documents stored in cloud storage with the Dell Document Hub. You can also search for files across multiple clouds storage services simultaneously. See "Searching for and Printing Files." USB Direct Print You can print files directly from a USB flash drive without requiring you to start your computer and a program with the USB Direct Print feature. See "Printing From USB Flash Drive." Scan to Email ID Copy You can copy both sides of an ID card on one side of a single sheet of paper in its original size by a simple operation with the ID Copy feature. See "Using the ID Copy." You can send scanned data by e-mail as an attachment with the Scan to Email feature. After scanning, select destination e-mail addresses from the address book on the printer or server or enter the address from the touch panel of the printer. See "Sending a Scanned Data via E-Mail." Scan to Network Folder Scan to USB You can transfer scanned data to a PC or a server via Server Message Block (SMB) or FTP without software. Although prior registration of the destination FTP server or PC on the address book is required, it helps save your time. See "Scanning to a Computer or Server With SMB/FTP." You don't need a PC to save scanned data to a USB flash drive with the Scan to USB feature. Specify the USB flash drive inserted into the printer's port as a data saving location when you scan data. See "Scanning to a USB Flash Drive." 24 Product Features Scanning From the Document Glass You can scan the pages of a book or a brochure from the document glass. See "Making Copies From the Document Glass." Scanning From the Duplex Automatic Document Feeder (DADF) You can scan pieces of unbound paper using the DADF. See "Making Copies From the DADF." Product Features 25 Printer Overview Front and Rear View Front View 12 11 10 Output Tray Extension Right Side Cover Front USB Port Front Cover Operator Panel Tray1 Duplex Automatic Document Feeder (DADF) 10 Optional 550-Sheet Feeder (Tray2) Drum Cartridges 11 Waste Toner Box 12 Toner Cartridges 26 Printer Overview Multipurpose Feeder (MPF) Rear View Phone Connector "Blue" Plug Wall Jack Connector Duplex Unit Ethernet Port Fusing Unit USB Port Rear Cover Power Connector Printer Overview 27 Duplex Automatic Document Feeder (DADF) DADF Cover Document Feeder Tray Document Guides Document Stopper DADF Chute Cover Document Output Tray Document Glass DADF Feed Rollers NOTE: • Pull out the document stopper to prevent the document from falling off the printer. Operator Panel Dell H625cdw/Dell H825cdw 14 13 Dell S2825cdn 28 Printer Overview 12 11 10 1 14 13 12 11 (Home) button Moves to the Home screen. (Log In/Out) button Logs out if pressed while the user is logged in. Touch Panel Specifies the settings by directly tapping the screen. Displays various settings, instructions, and error messages. Ready/Error LED Shows a green light when the printer is ready and a blinking green light when data is being received. Shows an amber light when an error occurs and a blinking amber light when an unrecoverable print error occurs. Number Pad Enters numbers and characters. (Wi-Fi) button* Shows a white light when the Wi-Fi® is activated and blinks in certain conditions. See "Status of Wi-Fi Button LED." (Redial/Pause) button Re-dials a telephone number. Inserts a pause into a telephone number. When the (Redial/Pause) button is pressed, "-" appears on the touch panel. (Copy) button Starts copying the document. Effective only from the Home screen while you are logged in to the printer. (Power) button Turns on and off the printer. Also enters or exits the Power Saver mode. When the printer is not used for a while, it enters the Power Saver mode to reduce power consumption. The white light will flash in a breathing pattern (gradually flashes on and off) when the Power Saver mode is active. 10 11 (NFC) reader* (Speed Dial 1/ Speed Dial 2) button 12 13 14 (Delete) button (Job Status) button (Information) button Starts communication between the printer and an NFC card or a mobile device with the NFC function when the card or the device is tapped to or waved over the reader. Dials the number registered as "001" or "002" respectively of the FAX Speed Dial. Effective only when the Home screen is displayed. Deletes numbers and characters. Moves to the Job Status screen. From this screen, you can check or cancel active jobs. Moves to the Information screen. You can access various information and settings menu, check consumable levels and network status, and print various types of reports and lists. This is available on Dell H625cdw and Dell H825cdw. NOTE: • Moving to a different menu or returning to a previous screen cancels the current entry or setting. Make sure to select OK to save the current entry or setting. Printer Overview 29 Status of Wi-Fi Button LED (Wi-Fi) LED Off Printer Status Wi-Fi has been turned off. Connecting to the network via Ethernet cable Entering the power saver mode On Wireless link established Blinking Searching/Connecting with wireless LAN access point or router Blinking slowly Wi-Fi is turned on but not connected to an access point or router. Optional Accessory The optional 550-sheet feeder is available for the printer. To install the optional 550-sheet feeder, refer to the installation instruction that comes with the optional 550-sheet feeder. 30 Printer Overview 2 Setting Up the Printer Overview of the Printer Setup 32 Preparing to Set Up the Printer 33 Connecting Your Printer to a Telephone Line 34 Turning On/Off the Printer 37 Connecting Your Printer to a Computer 44 Connecting Your Printer to Mobile Devices 61 Installing Print Drivers on Linux Computers Using Common UNIX Printing System (CUPS) 72 Setting the IP Address 80 31 Overview of the Printer Setup The following are the procedures necessary to set up the printer. Hardware preparations/Initial settings "Preparing to Set Up the Printer" "Turning On/Off the Printer" "Setting Initial Settings on the Operator Panel" Connections/Printer setup "Connecting Your Printer to a Telephone Line" "Connecting Your Printer to a Computer" "Connecting Your Printer to Mobile Devices" 32 Overview of the Printer Setup Preparing to Set Up the Printer Space Requirements Provide enough room to open the printer trays, covers, and optional accessory, and for proper ventilation. 180 mm/ 7.09 inches 500 mm/ 19.69 inches 220 mm/8.66 inches 300 mm/ 11.81 inches 420 mm/16.54 inches 180 mm/7.09 inches 499 mm/19.65 inches 250 mm/9.84 inches Securing the Printer To protect the printer from theft, you can use a Kensington lock. Attach the Kensington lock to the security slot of the printer. Security Slot Security Slot Refer to the operating instructions supplied with the Kensington lock. Preparing to Set Up the Printer 33 Connecting Your Printer to a Telephone Line CAUTION: • Do not connect the printer directly to a Digital Subscriber Line (DSL). This may damage the printer. To use a DSL, you are required to use an appropriate DSL filter. Contact your service provider for the DSL filter. Connecting the Printer to the Wall Jack To connect the printer to a telephone line, connect a telephone line cord into the wall jack connector on the rear of the printer. Connect the other end of the cord into an active wall jack. To the wall jack If the phone communication is serial in your country (such as Germany, Sweden, Denmark, Austria, Belgium, Italy, France, and Switzerland), and a "Yellow" terminator is supplied, perform the following procedure: 1 Remove the "Blue" plug from the phone connector. "Blue" plug 2 Insert the "Yellow" terminator into the phone connector. 34 Connecting Your Printer to a Telephone Line "Yellow" terminator Connecting the Printer to a Modem You can connect the printer to a computer with a modem on the same telephone line as the printer. Make sure that the modem is connected to an active wall jack connector, and then connect a telephone line cord into the phone connector on the modem. Connect the other end of the cord into the wall jack connector on the rear of the printer. To an active wall jack Phone connector Wall jack connector NOTE: • When using the fax function of the printer, turn off the fax-receive feature of the computer modem. • Do not use the computer modem if the printer is sending or receiving a fax. • To fax via the computer modem, follow the instructions provided with your computer modem and fax program. Connecting a Telephone or Answering Machine If you share a telephone line with voice calls and fax, you can connect a telephone or an answering machine to the printer to take the voice calls. 1 Make sure that a telephone line is connected to the printer. See "Connecting the Printer to the Wall Jack." 2 Remove the "Blue" plug from the phone connector. Connecting Your Printer to a Telephone Line 35 "Blue" plug 3 Connect a telephone or answering machine line cord into the phone connector on the rear of the printer. Connect the other end of the cord into an external telephone or answering machine. To an external telephone or answering machine 36 Connecting Your Printer to a Telephone Line Turning On/Off the Printer NOTE: • The images used in this chapter are those of the Dell H625cdw and Dell H825cdw unless otherwise mentioned. Turning On the Printer WARNING: • Do not use extension cords or power strips. • The printer should not be connected to an uninterruptible power supply (UPS) system. 1 Connect the power cord to the power connector on the rear of the printer, and then to an electrical outlet. 2 Press the (Power) button on the operator panel. Turning On/Off the Printer 37 Turning Off the Printer NOTE: • The data in the memory is cleared when the printer is turned off. Press and hold the panel. (Power) button and select Power Off displayed on the operator Setting Initial Settings on the Operator Panel You need to set the printer language, country, clock date, time, and fax settings when you turn on the printer for the first time. When you turn the printer on, the wizard screen to perform the initial setup appears on the touch panel. Perform the following procedure to set the initial settings. NOTE: • If you do not start configuring the initial settings, the printer restarts in 3 minutes, and the Home screen appears on the touch panel. After that, you can set the following initial setup by enabling the Power On Wizard on the touch panel from: The (Information) button Tools tab Admin Settings System Settings General Power On Wizard. You can also set the same setting using the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool. See "Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool." 1 Turn on the printer. 2 Tap until desired language appears, and then tap the desired language. 3 Tap Next. 4 Tap Date & Time. Geographic Region Time Zone Africa (UTC) Accra, Bamako, Dakar, Nouakchott (UTC) Casablanca (UTC +01:00) Algiers, Douala, Libreville, Luanda (UTC +01:00) Tunis (UTC +01:00) Windhoek (UTC +02:00) Cairo (UTC +02:00) Harare, Johannesburg, Kinshasa, Tripoli (UTC +03:00) Addis Ababa, Khartoum, Mogadishu, Nairobi 38 Turning On/Off the Printer Geographic Region Time Zone Americas (UTC -10:00) Adak (UTC -09:00) Alaska (UTC -08:00) Pacific Time (US & Canada) (UTC -08:00) Tijuana (UTC -07:00) Arizona, Dawson Creek, Sonora (UTC -07:00) Chihuahua, Mazatlan (UTC -07:00) Mountain Time (US & Canada) (UTC -06:00) Cancun, Mexico City, Monterrey (UTC -06:00) Central America (UTC -06:00) Central Time (US & Canada) (UTC -06:00) Saskatchewan (UTC -05:00) Atikokan, Resolute (UTC -05:00) Bogota, Lima, Panama, Quito (UTC -05:00) Cayman Islands, Jamaica, Port-au-Prince (UTC -05:00) Eastern Time (US & Canada) (UTC -05:00) Grand Turk (UTC -05:00) Havana (UTC -04:30) Caracas (UTC -04:00) Asuncion (UTC -04:00) Atlantic Time (Canada) (UTC -04:00) Blanc-Sablon (UTC -04:00) Caribbean Islands (UTC -04:00) Cuiaba (UTC -04:00) Georgetown, La Paz, Manaus (UTC -04:00) Thule (UTC -03:30) St. John's (UTC -03:00) Brasilia, Cayenne, Paramaribo (UTC -03:00) Buenos Aires (UTC -03:00) Greenland (UTC -03:00) Miquelon (UTC -03:00) Montevideo (UTC -02:00) Noronha Antarctica (UTC -04:00) Palmer Archipelago, Santiago (UTC -03:00) Rothera (UTC +03:00) Syowa (UTC +06:00) Mawson, Vostok (UTC +07:00) Davis (UTC +08:00) Casey (UTC +10:00) Dumont d'Urville (UTC +12:00) McMurdo Turning On/Off the Printer 39 Geographic Region Time Zone Asia (UTC +02:00) Amman (UTC +02:00) Beirut (UTC +02:00) Damascus (UTC +02:00) Jerusalem (UTC +02:00) Nicosia (UTC +02:00) Palestine (UTC +03:00) Aden, Baghdad, Qatar, Riyadh (UTC +03:30) Tehran (UTC +04:00) Baku (UTC +04:00) Dubai, Muscat, Tbilisi (UTC +04:00) Yerevan (UTC +04:30) Kabul (UTC +05:00) Aqtau, Aqtobe, Ashgabat, Samarkand (UTC +05:00) Ekaterinburg (UTC +05:00) Karachi (UTC +05:30) Colombo, Kolkata (UTC +05:45) Kathmandu (UTC +06:00) Almaty, Bishkek, Dhaka, Thimphu (UTC +06:00) Novosibirsk, Omsk (UTC +06:30) Yangon (Rangoon) (UTC +07:00) Bangkok, Ho Chi Minh, Hovd, Jakarta (UTC +07:00) Krasnoyarsk (UTC +08:00) Chongqing, Hong Kong, Shanghai (UTC +08:00) Irkutsk (UTC +08:00) Kuala Lumpur, Makassar, Manila, Singapore (UTC +08:00) Taipei (UTC +08:00) Ulaan Baatar (UTC +09:00) Dili, Jayapura (UTC +09:00) Pyongyang (UTC +09:00) Seoul (UTC +09:00) Tokyo (UTC +09:00) Yakutsk (UTC +10:00) Sakhalin, Vladivostok (UTC +11:00) Magadan (UTC +12:00) Anadyr, Kamchatka Atlantic Ocean (UTC -04:00) Bermuda (UTC -04:00) Stanley (UTC -02:00) South Georgia Island (UTC -01:00) Azores, Scoresbysund (UTC -01:00) Cape Verde (UTC) Reykjavik 40 Turning On/Off the Printer Geographic Region Time Zone Australia (UTC +08:00) Perth (UTC +08:45) Eucla (UTC +09:30) Adelaide (UTC +09:30) Darwin (UTC +10:00) Brisbane, Lindeman (UTC +10:00) Hobart, Melbourne, Sydney (UTC +10:30) Lord Howe Island Europe (UTC) Dublin, Edinburgh, Lisbon, London (UTC +01:00) Amsterdam, Berlin, Rome, Stockholm, Vienna (UTC +01:00) Belgrade, Bratislava, Budapest, Prague (UTC +01:00) Brussels, Copenhagen, Madrid, Paris (UTC +01:00) Sarajevo, Skopje, Warsaw, Zagreb (UTC +02:00) Athens, Bucharest, Istanbul (UTC +02:00) Helsinki, Kiev, Riga, Sofia (UTC +02:00) Kaliningrad, Minsk (UTC +03:00) Moscow (UTC +04:00) Samara Indian Ocean (UTC +03:00) Antananarivo, Comoro Islands, Mayotte (UTC +04:00) Mahe, Reunion (UTC +04:00) Mauritius (UTC +05:00) Kerguelen, Maldives (UTC +06:00) Chagos (UTC +06:30) Cocos Islands (UTC +07:00) Christmas Island Pacific Ocean (UTC -11:00) Midway Island, Niue, Samoa (UTC -10:00) Cook Islands, Hawaii, Tahiti (UTC -09:30) Marquesas Islands (UTC -09:00) Gambier Islands (UTC -08:00) Pitcairn Islands (UTC -06:00) Easter Island (UTC -06:00) Galapagos Islands (UTC +09:00) Palau (UTC +10:00) Guam, Port Moresby, Saipan (UTC +11:00) Efate, Guadalcanal, Kosrae (UTC +11:30) Norfolk Island (UTC +12:00) Auckland (UTC +12:00) Fiji, Marshall Islands (UTC +12:45) Chatham (UTC +13:00) Tongatapu (UTC +14:00) Kiritimati 5 Tap until the desired geographic region appears, and then tap the desired geographic region. 6 Tap until the desired time zone appears, and then tap the desired time zone. Turning On/Off the Printer 41 7 Tap OK Date. 8 Select a date format from the menu displayed by selecting Format. 9 After tapping the box under Year, tap – or +, or use the number pad to enter the desired value. Repeat this step to enter the desired value for Month and Day. 10 Tap OK Time. 11 Select the time format from 12 Hour or 24 Hour. If you select 12 Hour, select AM or PM. 12 After tapping the box under Hour, use the number pad to enter the desired value. Repeat this step to enter the desired value for Minute. 13 Tap OK Next. 14 Perform either of the following: To set Fax settings, select Yes, Setup FAX and perform the following procedure: a Enter the fax number of the printer using the number pad. b Tap Country. c Tap until the desired country appears, and then tap the desired country. The default paper size is automatically set when you select a country. 42 Australia A4 Austria A4 Belgium A4 Canada Letter Colombia Letter Denmark A4 Finland A4 France A4 Germany A4 Ireland A4 Italy A4 Malaysia A4 Mexico Letter Netherlands A4 New Zealand A4 Norway A4 Singapore A4 South Africa A4 Spain A4 Sweden A4 Switzerland A4 Thailand A4 United Kingdom A4 United States Letter Turning On/Off the Printer Unknown Letter d Tap Next. To end the settings, select No, I'll Do It Later. 15 When the Setup Complete (Congratulations, setup is complete.) screen appears, tap OK. The printer restarts. Turning On/Off the Printer 43 Connecting Your Printer to a Computer You can connect the printer directly to your computer with USB, or connect the printer to a wireless or wired network. NOTE: • Wireless network is available on Dell H625cdw and Dell H825cdw. Overview The following are the simple procedures recommended to connect the printer. Wireless connection Necessary preparations Check the settings of your access point or wireless router. Windows® Dell Printer Easy Install Macintosh WPS-PBC settings Drivers and software installation "Connecting With Dell Printer Easy Install (Windows® Only)" "Connecting With WPS" "Installing the Software for Macintosh Computers" For wireless connection procedures other than the above, see "Connecting to a Wireless Network." 44 Connecting Your Printer to a Computer Wired connection (Ethernet or USB) Necessary preparations Connect an Ethernet cable or a USB cable into the port on the rear of the printer. "Connecting to a Wired (Ethernet) Network" "Connecting to a Computer With USB" Windows® Dell Printer Easy Install Macintosh Drivers and software installation "Connecting With Dell Printer Easy Install (Windows® Only)" "Installing the Software for Macintosh Computers" Connecting to a Wireless Network Connecting With Dell Printer Easy Install (Windows® Only) 1 Insert the Software and Documentation disc in your computer. Alternatively, go to www.dell.com/support, enter the Service Tag of your printer, download the latest software and driver, and then open the file that you downloaded. NOTE: • Make sure that there is no cable connected between the printer and your computer. 2 On the Dell Printer Easy Install window, click Next. Dell Printer Easy Install begins to search for your printer. 3 Wait for Dell Printer Easy Install wizard to find your printer. Connecting Your Printer to a Computer 45 4 After the printer is found, click Install to complete the setup. Connecting With WPS WPS-PBC and WPS-PIN are simple methods to setup wireless connection. For WPS-PBC, press the button provided on your access point or wireless router, and then perform WPS-PBC setting on the operator panel. This setting is available only when the access point supports WPS. For WPS-PIN, enter PIN assignments to your printer and computer. This setting, performed on an access point, is available only when the access points of your wireless router support WPS. NOTE: • This is available on Dell H625cdw and Dell H825cdw. • Make sure to connect the printer to a wireless network and disconnect the Ethernet cable. • Before starting WPS-PBC, check where the WPS button (button name may vary) is located on the wireless LAN access point. For details about WPS operation on the wireless LAN access point, refer to the manual supplied with the wireless LAN access point. • For WPS operation on the wireless LAN access point, refer to the manual supplied with the wireless LAN access point. WPS-PBC (Using the Wi-Fi Protected Setup™ (WPS) Button) 1 Press and hold the (Wi-Fi) button for more than 2 seconds. If Panel Lock Control is set to Enable, enter the password. See "Panel Lock." NOTE: • If you press the (Wi-Fi) button for less than 1 second, the Wi-Fi | WPS screen appears. • Make sure that the message Push WPS Button on router is displayed, and then start the WPS-PBC on the wireless LAN access point (Registrar) within 2 minutes. 2 Turn off the printer, and then turn it on again. Wireless LAN connection setting is complete. After the setting is complete, install the software. See "Installing the Software for Windows® Computers" or "Installing the Software for Macintosh Computers." WPS-PBC (Using the Touch Panel) When using the (Wi-Fi) button: 1 Press the (Wi-Fi) button. If Panel Lock Control is set to Enable, enter the password. See "Panel Lock." 2 Tap WPS (Connect via PBC). 3 Turn off the printer, and then turn it on again. When using the (Information) button: 1 Press the (Information) button. 2 Tap the Tools tab Admin Settings Network Wi-Fi Push Button Configuration Start Configuration. WPS Setup 3 Turn off the printer, and then turn it on again. Wireless LAN connection setting is complete. After the setting is complete, install the software. See "Installing the Software for 46 Connecting Your Printer to a Computer Windows® Computers" or "Installing the Software for Macintosh Computers." WPS-PIN 1 Press the (Wi-Fi) button. If Panel Lock Control is set to Enable, enter the password. See "Panel Lock." 2 Tap WPS (Connect via PIN). 3 Turn off the printer, and then turn it on again. Wireless LAN connection setting is complete. After the setting is complete, install the software. See "Installing the Software for Windows® Computers" or "Installing the Software for Macintosh Computers." NOTE: • Write down the eight-digit PIN code displayed on the touch panel. To print the PIN code, tap Print PIN Code. • Make sure that the message Operate Wireless Router is displayed, and then enter the PIN code into the wireless LAN access point (Registrar). Manually Connecting to a Wireless Network Connect to the wireless network using the SSID of your access point or wireless router. For details about the SSID of your access point or wireless router, contact your network administrator. Auto SSID Setup 1 Press the (Information) button. 2 Tap the Tools tab Admin Settings Network Wi-Fi. If Panel Lock Control is set to Enable, enter the password. See "Panel Lock." 3 Tap Wi-Fi Setup Wizard. The printer searches for access points on the wireless network. 4 Tap until the desired access point appears, and then select the access point. If the desired access point does not appear, proceed to "Manual SSID Setup." NOTE: • Some SSIDs are hidden and may not be displayed. If the SSID is not detected, turn on SSID broadcast from the router. 5 Tap Next. 6 Enter the WEP key or passphrase. If the encryption type of the selected access point is WEP in step 4: a Tap the WEP Key text box, and then enter the WEP key. b Tap OK. If the encryption type of the selected access point is WPA™, WPA2™, or Mixed in step 4: a Tap the Passphrase text box, and then enter the passphrase. Connecting Your Printer to a Computer 47 b Tap OK. NOTE: • A passphrase is an encryption key and may be described on access points or routers. For details, refer to the manual supplied with the access point or router. 7 Turn off the printer, and then turn it on again. Wireless LAN connection setting is complete. After the setting is complete, install the software. See "Installing the Software for Windows® Computers" or "Installing the Software for Macintosh Computers." Manual SSID Setup 1 Press the (Information) button. 2 Tap the Tools tab Admin Settings Network Wi-Fi Wi-Fi Setup Wizard. If Panel Lock Control is set to Enable, enter the password. See "Panel Lock." 3 Select the Manual SSID Setup check box, and then tap Next. 4 Enter the SSID, and then tap Next. 5 Select the network mode from Infrastructure and Ad-hoc according to your environment, and then tap Next. If you select Infrastructure, proceed to step 6. If you select Ad-hoc, proceed to step 7. NOTE: • When Wi-Fi Direct is set to Enable, you cannot select Ad-hoc. 6 Select the encryption type from No Security, Mixed mode PSK, WPA2-PSK-AES, or WEP. If you do not set security for your wireless network: a Tap until No Security appears, and then tap No Security. b Tap OK. If you use Mixed mode PSK or WPA2-PSK-AES encryption: a Tap until Mixed mode PSK or WPA2-PSK-AES appears, and then tap the desired encryption type. b Tap the Passphrase text box, and then enter the passphrase. c Tap OK. If you use WEP encryption: a Tap until WEP appears, and then tap WEP. b Tap the WEP Key text box, and then enter the WEP key. c Tap Transmit Key, and then select the desired transmit key from Auto or WEP Key 1 to WEP Key 4. d Tap OK. 48 Connecting Your Printer to a Computer Proceed to step 8. NOTE: • A passphrase is an encryption key and may be described on access points or routers. For details, refer to the manual supplied with the access point or router. 7 Select the encryption type from No Security or WEP. If you do not set security for your wireless network: a Tap until No Security appears, and then tap No Security. b Tap OK. To use WEP encryption: a Tap until WEP appears, and then tap WEP. b Tap the WEP Key text box, and then enter the WEP key. c Tap Transmit Key, and then select the desired transmit key from WEP Key 1 to WEP Key 4. d Tap OK. 8 Turn off the printer, and then turn it on again. Wireless LAN connection setting is complete. After the setting is complete, install the software. See "Installing the Software for Windows® Computers" or "Installing the Software for Macintosh Computers." Changing the Wireless Settings To change the wireless settings of the printer from your computer, start the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool. See "Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool." You can also set the same settings using the Software and Documentation disc. Connecting to a Wired (Ethernet) Network Connecting the Ethernet Cable To connect the printer to an Ethernet network, connect an Ethernet cable into the Ethernet port on the rear of the printer, and then connect the other end of the cable into an Ethernet outlet or a hub. Connecting Your Printer to a Computer 49 Ethernet outlet/hub NOTE: • To connect to a wireless network, make sure to disconnect the Ethernet cable. The printer will be connected to the same wireless network that the computer used is currently connected. Connecting With Dell Printer Easy Install (Windows® Only) 1 Insert the Software and Documentation disc in your computer. Alternatively, go to www.dell.com/support, enter the Service Tag of your printer, download the latest software and driver, and then open the file that you downloaded. NOTE: • Make sure that the printer is connected to your computer using an Ethernet cable. 2 On the Dell Printer Easy Install window, click Next. Dell Printer Easy Install begins to search for your printer. 3 Wait for Dell Printer Easy Install wizard to find your printer. 4 After the printer is found, select the printer, and then click Finish to complete the setup. Configuring With Other Methods For details, see "Installing the Software for Windows® Computers" or "Installing the Software for Macintosh Computers." 50 Connecting Your Printer to a Computer Connecting to a Computer With USB Connecting the USB Cable To connect the printer directly to the computer, connect the smaller USB connector into the USB port on the rear of the printer, and then connect the other end of the cable into a USB port of the computer. CAUTION: • Do not connect the printer to a USB hub. NOTE: • Make sure to match the USB symbol on the cable plug with the USB symbol on the printer. Connecting With Dell Printer Easy Install (Windows® Only) 1 Insert the Software and Documentation disc in your computer. Alternatively, go to www.dell.com/support, enter the Service Tag of your printer, download the latest software and driver, and then open the file that you downloaded. NOTE: • Make sure that the printer is connected to your computer using a USB cable. 2 On the Dell Printer Easy Install window, click Next. Dell Printer Easy Install begins to search for your printer. Connecting Your Printer to a Computer 51 3 Wait for Dell Printer Easy Install wizard to find and install your printer. Configuring With Other Methods For details, see "Installing the Software for Windows® Computers" or "Installing the Software for Macintosh Computers." Installing the Software for Windows® Computers Installing the Software and Print Drivers with Dell Printer Easy Install Insert the Software and Documentation disc into your computer. If the Software and Documentation disc does not start, perform the following. The following procedure uses Windows® 7/Windows® 10 as an example. 1 Click Start All Programs Accessories Run. For Windows® 10: Right-click the Start button, and then click Run. 2 Enter D:\setup_assist.exe (D is the drive letter of the optical drive), and then click OK. 3 In the Dell Printer Easy Install window, click Setup. 4 Select a connection method to the printer. 5 Follow the on-screen instructions until the Ready to Print! screen appears. 6 Click Finish. If necessary, click Print Test Page to verify installation. Installing the Software and Print Drivers When the Printer is Connected to the Network or Computer If the printer connection via USB/Ethernet/Wireless is already configured, perform the following to install the print driver and software. You can install the driver for a printer 52 Connecting Your Printer to a Computer with USB connection or network connection. NOTE: • To install the print driver with network connection, you need the IP address that is assigned to the printer. To check the IP address of the printer, perform one of the procedures in "Verifying the IP Settings." • Wireless network is available on Dell H625cdw and Dell H825cdw. Installing the Printer Control Language (PCL), PostScript (PS), and Fax Driver with USB Cable Connection NOTE: • If you are connecting the printer to a network, see "Installing the Printer Control Language (PCL), PostScript (PS), and Fax Driver with Network Connection." 1 In the Dell Printer Easy Install window, click Connect. 2 Select USB Cable Connection, and then click Next. 3 Follow the on-screen instructions until the Ready to Print! screen appears. 4 Click Finish. If necessary, click Print Test Page to verify installation. Installing the XML Paper Specification (XPS) Print Driver with USB Cable Connection NOTE: • XML Paper Specification (XPS) driver is supported on Windows Vista® or later. • If you are using Windows Vista® or Windows Server® 2008, you need to install Service Pack 2 or later, and then the Windows® Platform Update (KB971644). The update (KB971644) is available for download from Windows® Update. The following procedure uses Windows® 7 and Windows® 10 as examples. For Windows® 7: 1 Extract the following zip file to your desired location. D:\Drivers\XPS\Win_7Vista\XPS-V3_H625cdw_H825cdw_S2825cdn.zip (D is the drive letter of the optical drive) 2 Click Start Devices and Printers Add a printer. Connecting Your Printer to a Computer 53 If the User Account Control dialog box appears, click Yes. NOTE: • If you are logged on as an administrator on the computer, click Yes; otherwise, contact your administrator to continue the desired action. 3 Click Add a local printer. 4 Select the port connected to this product, and then click Next. 5 Click Have Disk. The Install From Disk dialog box is displayed. 6 Click Browse, and then select the inf file in the folder extracted in step 1. 7 Click OK. 8 Select the printer name, and then click Next. If you want to change the printer name, enter the printer name in the Printer name box, and then click Next. 9 Select either Do not share this printer or Share this printer so that others on your network can find and use it, and then click Next. 10 When the driver installation is completed, click Print a test page to verify installation. If you want to use this printer as the default printer, select the Set as the default printer check box, and then click Next. 11 Click Finish. For Windows® 10: 1 Extract the zip file you downloaded to your desired location. D:\Drivers\XPS\Win_8\XPS-V4_H625cdw_H825cdw_S2825cdn.zip (D is the drive letter of the optical drive) 2 Right-click the Start button, and then click Control Panel. 3 Click Hardware and Sound Devices and Printers Add a printer. 4 Click The printer that I want isn’t listed. 5 Click Add a local printer or network printer with manual settings Have Disk. Next Next The Install From Disk dialog box is displayed. 6 Click Browse, and then select the inf file in the folder extracted in step 1. 7 Click OK. 8 Select the printer name, and then click Next. If you want to change the printer name, enter the printer name in the Printer name box, and then click Next. 9 When the driver installation is completed, click Print a test page to verify installation. If you want to use this printer as the default printer, select the Set as the default printer check box. 10 Click Finish. 54 Connecting Your Printer to a Computer Installing the Printer Control Language (PCL), PostScript (PS), and Fax Driver with Network Connection NOTE: • To use the printer in a Linux environment, you need to install a Linux driver. See "Installing Print Drivers on Linux Computers Using Common UNIX Printing System (CUPS)." 1 In the Dell Printer Easy Install window, click Connect. 2 Select Wireless or Ethernet Connection, and then click Next. NOTE: • Wireless network is available on Dell H625cdw and Dell H825cdw. 3 Follow the on-screen instructions until the Ready to Print! screen appears. 4 Click Finish to exit the wizard. If necessary, click Print Test Page to verify installation. Installing the XML Paper Specification (XPS) Print Driver with Network Connection For Windows® 7: 1 Extract the following zip file to your desired location. D:\Drivers\XPS\Win_7Vista\XPS-V3_H625cdw_H825cdw_S2825cdn.zip (D is the drive letter of the optical drive) 2 Click Start Devices and Printers Add a printer. 3 Click Add a network, wireless or Bluetooth printer. NOTE: • Wireless network is available on Dell H625cdw and Dell H825cdw. 4 Select a printer, and then click Next. Or Click The printer that I want isn't listed. If you select the printer, proceed to step 7. If you click The printer that I want isn't listed, proceed to step 5. 5 Select Add a printer using a TCP/IP address or host name, and then click Next. Connecting Your Printer to a Computer 55 6 Select TCP/IP Device from Device type, enter the IP address for Hostname or IP address, and then click Next. NOTE: • If the User Account Control dialog box appears and if you are the administrator of the computer, click Yes. Otherwise, contact your administrator to continue the desired action. 7 Click Have Disk. The Install From Disk dialog box is displayed. 8 Click Browse, and then select the inf file in the folder extracted in step 1. 9 Click OK. 10 Select the printer name, and then click Next. If you want to change the printer name, enter the printer name in the Printer name box, and then click Next. 11 Select either Do not share this printer or Share this printer so that others on your network can find and use it, and then click Next. 12 When the driver installation is completed, click Print a test page to verify installation. If you want to use this printer as the default printer, select the Set as the default printer check box, and then click Next. 13 Click Finish. For Windows® 10: 1 Extract the zip file you downloaded to your desired location. D:\Drivers\XPS\Win_8\XPS-V4_H625cdw_H825cdw_S2825cdn.zip (D is the drive letter of the optical drive) 2 Right-click the Start button, and then click Control Panel. 3 Click Hardware and Sound Devices and Printers Add a printer. 4 Click The printer that I want isn’t listed. 5 Click Add a local printer or network printer with manual settings Have Disk. The Install From Disk dialog box is displayed. Next Next 6 Click Browse, and then select the inf file in the folder extracted in step 1. 7 Click OK. 8 Select the printer name, and then click Next. If you want to change the printer name, enter the printer name in the Printer name box, and then click Next. 9 When the driver installation is completed, click Print a test page to verify installation. If you want to use this printer as the default printer, select the Set as the default printer check box. 10 Click Finish. 56 Connecting Your Printer to a Computer Setting Up for Web Services on Devices (WSD) Adding Roles of Printer Services (Windows Server® Operating Systems Only) When you use Windows Server® operating system, you need to add the roles of print services to the operating system. For Windows Server® 2008 R2: 1 Click Start Administrative Tools Server Manager. 2 Select Add Roles from the Action menu. 3 Select the Print and Document Services check box on the Server Roles window in the Add Roles Wizard, and then click Next Next. 4 Select the Print Server check box, and then click Next Install. Installing a Print Driver Using the Add Printer Wizard The following procedure uses Windows® 7/Windows® 10 as an example. 1 Click Start Devices and Printers. For Windows® 10: Right-click the Start button, and then click Control Panel Hardware and Sound Devices and Printers Add a printer. For Windows® 10: Proceed to step 3. 2 Select Add a network, wireless or Bluetooth printer. NOTE: • Wireless network is available on Dell H625cdw and Dell H825cdw. 3 In the list of available printers, select the one you want to use, and then click Next. NOTE: • In the list of available printers, the Web Services on Devices (WSD) printer is displayed in the form of http://IP address/ws/. • If no Web Services on Devices (WSD) printer is displayed in the list, enter the printer's IP address to create a Web Services on Devices (WSD) printer. To enter the printer's IP address, perform the following procedure. For Windows Server® 2008 R2, to create a Web Services on Devices (WSD) printer, you must be a member of Administrators group. 1 Click The printer that I want isn't listed. 2 Select Add a printer using a TCP/IP address or hostname, and then click Next. 3 Select Web Services Device from Device type. 4 Enter the printer's IP address in the Hostname or IP address text box, and then click Next. • Before installing the driver using the Add Printer wizard on Windows Server® 2008 R2 or Windows® 7, perform one of the following: - Establish the Internet connection so that Windows® Update can scan your computer. - Add the print driver to your computer. 4 If prompted, install the print driver on your computer. If you are prompted for an administrator password or confirmation, enter the password or provide confirmation. 5 Complete the additional steps in the wizard, and then click Finish. 6 Print a test page to verify print installation. Connecting Your Printer to a Computer 57 a Click Start Devices and Printers. For Windows® 10: Right-click the Start button, and then click Control Panel Hardware and Sound Devices and Printers. b Right-click the icon for the printer you just created, and then click Printer properties. c On the General tab, click Print Test Page. When a test page is printed successfully, installation is complete. Installing the Software for Macintosh Computers Installing the Software and Print Drivers 1 Insert the Software and Documentation disc on the Macintosh computer, and then click the CD icon. 2 Double-click your printer icon, and then click Continue. 3 When the popup dialog box prompts you to confirm the program included in the installation package, click Continue. 4 Click Continue on the Important Information screen. 5 Select a language for the Software License Agreement screen. 6 After reading Software License Agreement, click Continue. 7 If you agree to the terms of Software License Agreement, click Agree to continue the installation process. 8 Specify the installation location, and then click Continue. 9 Click Install. If you want to select a custom installation, click Customize and select items that you want to install. 10 Enter the administrator's name and password, and then click Install Software Continue Installation. 11 Click Log Out or Close. Adding a Printer Using USB Connection The following procedure uses OS X 10.10 as an example. 1 Turn on the printer. 2 Connect the USB cable to the printer and the Macintosh computer. Adding a Printer Using IP Printing The following procedure uses OS X 10.10 as an example. 1 Turn on the printer. 2 Make sure that Macintosh computer and the printer are connected. 58 Connecting Your Printer to a Computer If you use wired connection, connect the printer to the network via an Ethernet cable. If you use wireless connection, make sure that the wireless connection is configured properly on your Macintosh computer and the printer. NOTE: • Wireless network is available on Dell H625cdw and Dell H825cdw. 3 Open the System Preferences, and then click Printers & Scanners. 4 Click the Plus (+) sign, select Add Printer or Scanner, and then click IP. 5 Select Line Printer Daemon - LPD for Protocol. 6 Enter the IP address for the printer in the Address area. 7 Select Dell Color MFP H625cdw, Dell Color MFP H825cdw, or Dell Color MFP S2825cdn for Use. NOTE: • When printing is set up using IP printing feature, the queue name is displayed as blank. You do not need to specify it. 8 Click Add. 9 Specify the options that have been installed on the printer, and then click Continue. 10 Make sure that the printer is displayed in the Printers & Scanners dialog box. Adding a Printer Using Bonjour The following procedure uses OS X 10.10 as an example. 1 Turn on the printer. 2 Make sure that Macintosh computer and the printer are connected. If you use wired connection, connect the printer to the network via an Ethernet cable. If you use wireless connection, make sure that the wireless connection is configured properly on your Macintosh computer and the printer. NOTE: • Wireless network is available on Dell H625cdw and Dell H825cdw. 3 Open the System Preferences, and then click Printers & Scanners. 4 Click the Plus (+) sign, select Add Printer or Scanner, and then click Default. 5 Select the printer connected via Bonjour from the Printer Name list. 6 Name and Use are automatically entered. NOTE: • If AirPrint Printer is selected for Print Using (or Use), select Dell Color MFP H625cdw, Dell Color MFP H825cdw, or Dell Color MFP S2825cdn manually. 7 Click Add. 8 Specify the options that have been installed on the printer, and then click Continue. 9 Make sure that the printer is displayed in the Printers & Scanners dialog box. Connecting Your Printer to a Computer 59 Configuring With Optional Accessories On the driver, specify the optional accessories that have been installed on the printer to enable features associated with those accessories. 1 Open the System Preferences, and then click Printers & Scanners. 2 Select the printer in the Printers list, and then click Options & Supplies. 3 Select Options, and select the options that have been installed on the printer, and then click OK. 60 Connecting Your Printer to a Computer Connecting Your Printer to Mobile Devices You can connect the printer directly to your mobile devices, such as computers, smart phones, and tablets, and then you can print or scan documents, photos, web pages, or e-mail quickly and easily. Overview The following shows the compatibility between the mobile printing services and operating systems. Windows® Macintosh iOS Android™ Wi-Fi Direct® Dell Document Hub Tap to Print/Scan AirPrint™ Google Cloud Print™ Mopria™ Print ( : compatible, Blank: not compatible) Wi-Fi Direct Wi-Fi Direct allows your mobile devices to connect to the printer directly via a Wi-Fi network. With Wi-Fi Direct, you can print documents, photos, or e-mail on your mobile devices directly without an access point or a wireless router. NOTE: • • • • Wi-Fi Direct is available on Dell H625cdw and Dell H825cdw. The maximum number of mobile devices that can be connected via the Wi-Fi Direct network is 3. You cannot connect your mobile device to the Internet via the printer’s Wi-Fi Direct network. Depending on the mobile device, the channel used to connect the mobile device to the printer via Wi-Fi Direct may differ from the channel used by the printer to connect to a network via Wi-Fi infrastructure mode. In such a case, simultaneous connection with Wi-Fi Direct and Wi-Fi infrastructure mode may not work properly. • The printer connected with Wi-Fi Direct supports the following protocols; LPD, Port9100, WSD*, Bonjour (mDNS), SNMPv1/v2c, Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool. * WSD stands for Web Services on Devices. Setting Up Wi-Fi Direct To use Wi-Fi Direct, you need to first set up the Wi-Fi Direct settings from the operator panel of the printer. To connect the mobile device to the printer via Wi-Fi Direct, select the SSID of the printer from the list of wireless networks on the mobile device and enter the passphrase necessary for connection. Setting Up the Printer NOTE: • You can set the same setting using the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool. See "Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool." 1 Press the (Wi-Fi) button. If Panel Lock Control is set to Enable, enter the password. See "Panel Lock." Connecting Your Printer to Mobile Devices 61 2 Tap Wi-Fi Direct. 3 In the Wi-Fi Direct menu, tap Wi-Fi Direct Enable OK. If a popup message about the mobile devices is displayed, tap Close. 4 Tap Group Role Group Owner OK Paired Device. 5 Make sure that no device is connected with the Wi-Fi Direct connection. NOTE: • When other mobile device is connected, the device name and Connected are displayed on Paired Device, and you cannot use the Wi-Fi Direct connection. Disconnect the other mobile device from the Wi-Fi Direct network. See "Disconnecting Wi-Fi Direct Network." 6 Turn off the printer, and then turn it on again. 7 Repeat steps 1 and 2 after the printer is restarted, and then tap Group Owner. 8 Tap SSID and Passphrase to check what the SSID and passphrase are. NOTE: • To check the printer's SSID and passphrase, you can also print the list by tapping Print Passphrase under the Passphrase menu. Connecting the Mobile Device The following procedure uses Windows® 7, Windows® 10, OS X 10.10, iOS, and Android as examples. Connect the mobile device to the Wi-Fi Direct network. For Windows® 7: 1 Click the network icon on the taskbar. 2 Click the printer's SSID Connect. 3 Enter the passphrase, and then click OK. 4 Click Cancel, and then exit the Set Network Location window. For Windows® 10: 1 Click the Start button, and then click Settings. 2 Click the Wi-Fi icon. 3 Click the printer's SSID Connect. 4 Enter the passphrase, and then click Next. For OS X 10.10: 1 Click the network icon on the Menu Bar. 2 Click the printer's SSID. 3 Enter the passphrase, and then click Join. For iOS: 1 Tap Settings Wi-Fi. 2 Tap the printer's SSID. 62 Connecting Your Printer to Mobile Devices 3 Enter the passphrase, and then tap Join. For Android: The procedure varies depending on your mobile device you are using. Refer to the manual supplied with your mobile device. Printing via Wi-Fi Direct Installing the Print Driver Before printing, you are required to install the print driver accordingly. For Windows® 7/Windows® 10: You need to install the print driver on the mobile device. See "Installing the Software for Windows® Computers." For OS X 10.10: You need to install the print driver on the mobile device. See "Installing the Software for Macintosh Computers." For iOS: You need to install the printing program from App Store, and then the printer is ready for use. For details, see "Dell Document Hub." For Android: You need to install the printing program from Google Play™, and then the printer is ready for use. For details, see "Dell Document Hub." The printing procedure varies depending on your mobile device you are using. Refer to the manual supplied with your mobile device to print as you normally do from the mobile device. Disconnecting Wi-Fi Direct Network 1 Press the (Wi-Fi) button. 2 Tap Wi-Fi Direct Paired Device. NOTE: • The Paired Device menu is displayed only when the printer is connected via Wi-Fi Direct. 3 Tap the mobile device name to disconnect, or select Disconnect All. 4 Tap Disconnect now or Disconnect and Reset Passphrase You can also disconnect the mobile device from the following steps: 1 Press the (Information) button. 2 Tap the Tools tab Device. Admin Settings Network Yes. Wi-Fi Direct Paired If Panel Lock Control is set to Enable, enter the password. See "Panel Lock." 3 Tap Disconnect All. 4 Tap Disconnect now or Disconnect and Reset Passphrase Yes. Connecting Your Printer to Mobile Devices 63 Resetting the Passphrase 1 Press the (Wi-Fi) button. If Panel Lock Control is set to Enable, enter the password. See "Panel Lock." 2 Tap Wi-Fi Direct. until Passphrase appears, and then tap Passphrase. 3 Tap 4 Tap Reset Passphrase Yes. The Wi-Fi Direct is disconnected and the passphrase is reset. Resetting the PIN 1 Press the (Wi-Fi) button. If Panel Lock Control is set to Enable, enter the password. See "Panel Lock." 2 Tap Wi-Fi Direct. until WPS Setup appears, and then tap WPS Setup. 3 Tap 4 Tap PIN Code Reset Code Yes. The Wi-Fi Direct is disconnected and the PIN is reset. Dell Document Hub The Dell Document Hub app allows you to scan to and print from a variety of common cloud storage services. Easy to use and navigate, this free app enables direct printing of photos, documents, web content and more, to supported Dell printers on a Wi-Fi, Wi-Fi Direct, or Ethernet network. You can also view the printer status and configuration of print and scan settings. For details, click Learn more at www.dell.com/dochub. Android Download the Dell Document Hub app for free from Google Play. Scan the QR Code® for quick access to the relevant application store. iOS Download the Dell Document Hub app for free from App Store. Scan the QR Code for quick access to the relevant application store. 64 Connecting Your Printer to Mobile Devices Tap To Print/Scan Tap To Print allows you to add the printer to a mobile device such as a tablet or a notebook computer, simply by tapping the mobile device onto the printer. Once the printer is added to the mobile device, you can start printing or scanning from the mobile device. NOTE: • To utilize the Tap To Print feature, make sure the followings: - The mobile device should be NFC-enabled and running the Windows® 8.1 or Windows® 10 operating system. - The printer should be connected to a network. If the printer is connected with the computer only with the USB cable, the Tap To Print feature is not available. • The Tap To Print feature is available on Dell H625cdw and Dell H825cdw. Preparations • Make sure that the Tap To Print feature is enabled. The Tap To Print feature is enabled as default on the printer. To enable the Tap To Print feature from the operator panel, perform the following. NOTE: • You can set the same setting using the Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool. See "Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool." • • 1 Press the (Information) button. 2 Tap the Tools tab Admin Settings System Settings. 3 Tap until NFC - Tap to Print appears, and then tap NFC - Tap to Print. 4 Tap Enable OK. 5 Turn off the printer, and then turn it on again to apply the settings. Make sure that both the printer and the computer are on the same network. It is recommended that the computer is connected to the Internet so that the latest driver could be installed on the computer. Adding the Printer to the Mobile Device While the printer is connected to the same subnet of the network with the mobile device, you can add the printer to the mobile device by tapping the mobile device onto the printer. The printer is added as a Web Services on Devices (WSD) printer. The following procedure uses Windows® 8.1/Windows® 10 as an example. NOTE: • Make sure that the NFC function is activated on the mobile device. • This is available on Dell H625cdw and Dell H825cdw. Connecting Your Printer to Mobile Devices 65 1 Locate the NFC reader of the mobile device. 2 Tap the mobile device onto the For the location of (NFC) reader of the printer. (NFC) reader, see "Operator Panel." The printer beeps when it detects the mobile device, and the following message appears in the top right corner of the mobile device. The following procedure uses Dell H825cdw as an example. Add a device? Tap to set up your Dell-H825cdw-xxxxxx. 3 Tap the message window to set up the printer on the mobile device. The printer icon appears on the mobile device. NOTE: • The time required until the driver is installed depending on the network traffic. • To check the printer icon, right-click the Start button, and then click Control Panel Hardware and Sound Devices and Printers. • If a printer icon already exists on the mobile device, the message appears in the top right corner of the mobile device screen confirming whether to connect to the printer. In this case, tap the message window to connect the mobile device to the printer. Printing or Scanning Once the printer is added and connected to the mobile device, you can start printing or scanning. See "Sending a Job to Print" or "Scanning to a Computer With a Network Connection." AirPrint AirPrint allows you to print through a network with the device running iOS or OS X. Be sure to install the latest version of iOS for iOS device. For OS X, be sure to update OS X and the apps you have purchased from the App Store using the Software Update. Setting Up AirPrint on Your Printer 1 Make sure that the printer is connected to the network. 2 Start the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool. 66 Connecting Your Printer to Mobile Devices See "Starting the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool." 3 Click Print Server Settings the Print Server Settings tab AirPrint. 4 Select the Enable AirPrint check box. 5 Click Apply New Settings Restart Printer. Printing via AirPrint The following procedure uses the iPhone running iOS 8.1 as an example. 1 Open your e-mail, photo, web page, or document that you want to print. 2 Tap the action icon 3 Tap Print. 4 Select the printer and set printer options. 5 Tap Print. Google Cloud Print By registering the printer to your GoogleTM account, Google Cloud Print service allows you to print from various devices connected to the Internet. You can print documents, photos or e-mails using the Google ChromeTM browser or applications such as Google DriveTM on your mobile device. For details about Google Cloud Print, visit the Google web site. Preparing to Use the Printer With Google Cloud Print To use Google Cloud Print, you need to prepare the following in advance: • Connect the printer to a network that has access to the Internet. NOTE: • Google Cloud Print supports only IPv4 connection. • If the printer is connected to a network via a proxy server, you need to specify the settings in Proxy Server from the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool. See "Proxy Server." • • Acquire a Google account and a GmailTM address. Enable Google Cloud Print on the operator panel. NOTE: • You can set the same setting using the Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool. See "Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool." 1 Press the (Information) button. 2 Tap the Tools tab Admin Settings Network Protocols. If Panel Lock Control is set to Enable, enter the password. See "Panel Lock." 3 Tap until Google Cloud Print appears, and then tap Google Cloud Print. 4 Tap Enable OK. 5 Turn off the printer, and then turn it on again to apply the settings. Selecting the Version of the Google Cloud Print Service Select the version of the Google Cloud Print service from either version 1.1 or version Connecting Your Printer to Mobile Devices 67 2.0. Google Cloud Print version 1.1 sends the print data to the printer via Internet. For this version, the printer needs to be connected to the Internet. Google Cloud Print version 2.0 sends the print data to the printer either via Internet or via local network. This version is recommended for the environment where the Internet connection cannot be used. NOTE: • Available options for printing may vary according to your device or the version of the Google Cloud Print service. • You cannot simultaneously use both version 1.1 and version 2.0 of the Google Cloud Print service on a printer. Registering the Printer to Your Google Account For Google Cloud Print Version 1.1 1 Start the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool. See "Starting the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool." 2 Click Print Server Settings the Print Server Settings tab Google Cloud Print Register This Device to Google Cloud Print. A sheet with a URL for the Google Cloud Print printer registration web site is printed. 3 From the web browser of your computer, visit the Google web site and sign in with your Google account. You can visit the Google Cloud Print registration web site by entering the URL on the printout into your web browser or by scanning the QR code with your mobile device. 68 Connecting Your Printer to Mobile Devices 4 On the Google Cloud Print registration web site, click Finish printer registration. 5 Click Manage your printers. The printer is listed in the Printers list and ready for use with the Google Cloud Print service. For Google Cloud Print Version 2.0 1 Open the Google Chrome browser. When you are using the Google Chromebook, start and log in to the Chromebook. 2 Click in the top right corner, and then select Settings. 3 Click Show advanced settings in the bottom of the page. 4 Click Google Cloud Print Manage. NOTE: • If a message is displayed under New Devices to sign in to Chrome, click sign in and sign in to Chrome. 5 Click Register for the printer you want to register. NOTE: • If Bonjour (mDNS) is disabled, the newly added printer is not displayed in New devices. In this case, start the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool. Click Print Server Settings the Print Server Settings tab Port Settings. Select the Bonjour (mDNS) check box. 6 When the window to confirm the registration appears, click Register. 7 Follow the on-screen instruction on the printer. 8 When the printer name appears in the My devices list, the registration is completed. NOTE: • It may take about 5 minutes or more until the printer name appears in the My devices list. Sharing the Printer With the Google Cloud Print Service You can share the printer registered for the Google Cloud Print service with other users. 1 Open the Google Chrome browser. When you are using the Google Chromebook, start and log in to the Chromebook. 2 Click in the top right corner, and then select Settings. 3 Click Show advanced settings in the bottom of the page. 4 Click Google Cloud Print Manage. NOTE: • If a message is displayed to sign in to Chrome, click sign in and sign in to Chrome. 5 Click Manage for the printer you want to share. 6 Click Google Cloud Print Share. Connecting Your Printer to Mobile Devices 69 7 In the window to specify the printer sharing, enter the Google accounts of the users that you want to invite to share the printer, and click Share. NOTE: • When the invited users log in to the Google Cloud Print web page, a message appears to show that the printer owner made the sharing settings. Accept the sharing invitation. Canceling the Registration to Google Cloud Print 1 Start the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool. See "Starting the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool." 2 Click Print Server Settings Cancel Registration. 3 Make sure that Register This Device to Google Cloud Print appears. Printing via Google Cloud Print The printing procedure varies depending on the application or the device you are using. You can see the application list that supports Google Cloud Print service on the Google web site. Printing From an Application on a Mobile Device The following procedure uses the Google Drive application on an Android mobile device as an example. 1 Install the Google Drive application on your mobile device. NOTE: • You can download the application from Google Play. 2 Start the Google Drive application from your mobile device. 3 Tap next to the file name of the file you want to print. 4 Tap Print. If Print is not displayed, tap , and then tap Print. 5 Select a google cloud printer form the list. 6 Specify printer options, and then tap Printing From Google Chrome NOTE: • You are required to register the Google Cloud Print Version 2.0. The following procedure uses the Google Chrome browser on a Windows® PC as an example. 1 Open the Google Chrome browser. 2 Open the web page or e-mail that you want to print. 3 Click or (varies depending on the version of the Google Chrome browser) in the top right corner, and then click Print. 4 In the Destination area, click Change. 5 In the Google Cloud Print area, select the printer. 70 Connecting Your Printer to Mobile Devices 6 Click Print. Printing From Google Chromebook NOTE: • You are required to register the Google Cloud Print Version 2.0. 1 Open the web page or e-mail that you want to print. 2 Click in the top right corner and then click Print. 3 Confirm that your printer is specified in the Destination area. If not, click Change and select your printer. 4 Click Print. Mopria Print Service Mopria-certified mobile devices can connect and print to certify printer. Either connect your mobile devices to the same network as the printer or make a direct connection with Wi-Fi Direct. Works with Mopria-certified smartphones and tablets or Android 4.4 devices with the Mopria Print Service download from Google Play. https://play.google.com/store/apps/ http://www.mopria.org/ NOTE: • Your mobile device and printer need to be connected to the same network. • Mopria Print Service may be preloaded into your smartphone or tablet. If your mobile device does not have the Mopria Print Service, you can easily download it free of charge from Google Play. • Make sure that Mopria is set to Enable in advance using the Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool. See "Mopria." Setting Up Mopria Print Service on Your Printer 1 Make sure that the printer is connected to the network. 2 Start the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool. See "Starting the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool." 3 Click Print Server Settings the Print Server Settings tab Mopria. 4 Click Enable. The printer is ready for Mopria Print Service. Printing via Mopria Print Service 1 Open your e-mail, photo, web page, or document that you want to print. 2 Tap the menu, and then select Print. 3 Tap All printers in the menu. 4 Select the printer, and then set printer options. 5 Tap Print. Connecting Your Printer to Mobile Devices 71 Installing Print Drivers on Linux Computers Using Common UNIX Printing System (CUPS) This section provides information for installing or setting up the print driver with CUPS on Red Hat® Enterprise Linux® 6 Desktop, SUSE® Linux Enterprise Desktop 11, or Ubuntu 12.04 LTS. The following procedure uses Dell H825cdw as an example. Operation on Red Hat Enterprise Linux 6 Desktop Setup Overview Red Hat Enterprise Linux 6 Desktop: 1 Install the print driver. 2 Set up the print queue. 3 Set up the default queue. 4 Specify the printing options. Installing the Print Driver 1 Select Applications System Tools Terminal. 2 Enter the following command in the terminal window. su [administrator password] rpm -ivh [file path] /Dell-Color-MFP-S2825cdn-H825cdw-x.x-x.rpm Setting Up the Print Queue To perform printing, you must set up the print queue on your workstation. 1 Open the URL http://localhost:631 using a web browser. 2 Click Administration Add Printer. 3 Enter root as the user name, enter the administrator password, and then click OK. For network connections: a Select LPD/LPR Host or Printer from the Other Network Printers menu, and then click Continue. b Enter the IP address of the printer in Connection, and then click Continue. Format: lpd:// xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx (the IP address of the printer) For USB connections: a Select Dell Color MFP H825cdw from the Local Printers menu, and then click Continue. 72 Installing Print Drivers on Linux Computers Using Common UNIX Printing System (CUPS) 4 Enter the name of the printer in the Name box in the Add Printer window, and then click Continue. You can optionally specify the location and description of the printer for further information. 5 Select Dell Color MFP H825cdw vxxxx.PS (en) from the Model menu, and then click Add Printer. Printing From the Program When you have finished setting up the queue, you can print from the programs. To print from the program, specify the queue in the print dialog box. However, on programs such as Mozilla, it may only be possible to print from the default queue. In these cases, set the queue that you want to print to as the default queue before you start printing. See "Setting Up the Default Queue." Setting Up the Default Queue 1 Select Applications System Tools Terminal. 2 Enter the following command in the terminal window. su [administrator password] lpadmin -d [queue name] Specifying the Printing Options You can specify the printing options such as color mode. 1 Open the URL http://localhost:631 using a web browser. 2 Click Administration Manage Printers. 3 Click the queue name for which you want to specify the printing options. 4 Select Set Default Options from the Administration menu. 5 Click the desired setting item to specify the required settings, and then click Set Default Options. Installing Print Drivers on Linux Computers Using Common UNIX Printing System (CUPS) 73 Uninstalling the Print Driver 1 Select Applications System Tools Terminal. 2 Enter the following command in the terminal window to delete the print queue. su [administrator password] /usr/sbin/lpadmin -x [queue name] 3 Repeat the command above for all queues for the same model. 4 Enter the following command in the terminal window. su [administrator password] rpm -e Dell-Color-MFP-S2825cdn-H825cdw Operation on SUSE Linux Enterprise Desktop 11 Setup Overview SUSE Linux Enterprise Desktop 11: 1 Install the print driver. 2 Set up the print queue. 3 Set up the default queue. 4 Specify the printing options. Installing the Print Driver 1 Select Computer More Applications..., and then select GNOME Terminal on the Application Browser. 2 Enter the following command in the terminal window. su [administrator password] rpm -ivh [file path] / Dell-Color-MFP-S2825cdn-H825cdw-x.x-x.rpm 74 Installing Print Drivers on Linux Computers Using Common UNIX Printing System (CUPS) Setting Up the Print Queue To perform printing, you must set up the print queue on your workstation. 1 Select Computer More Applications..., and then select YaST on the Application Browser. 2 Enter the administrator password, and then click Continue. 3 Select Hardware Printer. For network connections: a Click Add. b Click Connection Wizard. c Select Line Printer Daemon (LPD) Protocol from Access Network Printer or Printserver Box via. d Enter the IP address of the printer in IP Address or Host Name:. e Select Dell in the Select the printer manufacturer: drop-down list box. f Click OK. g Select your printer from the Assign Driver list. NOTE: • You can specify the printer name in Set Name:. h Check the settings, and then click OK. For USB connections: a Click Add. b Select your printer from the Assign Driver list. NOTE: • You can specify the printer name in Set Name:. c Check the settings, and then click OK. Printing From the Program When you have finished setting up the queue, you can print from the programs. To print from the program, specify the queue in the print dialog box. However, sometimes you can print only from the default queue depending on the program such as Mozilla. In these cases, before you start printing, set queue you want to print to as the default queue. See "Setting Up the Default Queue." Setting Up the Default Queue You can set the default queue when you add the printer. 1 Select Computer More Applications..., and then select YaST on the Application Browser. 2 Enter the administrator password, and then click Continue. 3 Select Hardware Printer. 4 Click Edit. 5 Check that the printer you want to set is selected in the Connection list. 6 Select the Default Printer check box. Installing Print Drivers on Linux Computers Using Common UNIX Printing System (CUPS) 75 7 Check the settings, and then click OK. Specifying the Printing Options You can specify the printing options such as color mode. 1 Open a web browser. 2 Enter http://localhost:631/admin in Location, and then presson the keyboard. 3 Click Manage Printers. 4 Click Set Printer Options of the printer for which you want to specify the printing options. 5 Specify the required settings, and then click Set Printer Options. 6 Enter root as the user name, enter the administrator password, and then click OK. NOTE: • Set the password for authority as the printer administrator before setting the printer queue. If you have not set it, proceed to "Setting the Password for Authority as the Printer Administrator." 7 Execute printing from the program. Setting the Password for Authority as the Printer Administrator You must set the password for authority as the printer administrator to do operations as the printer administrator. 1 Select Computer More Applications... and select GNOME Terminal on the Application Browser. 2 Enter the following command in the terminal window. su [administrator password] lppasswd -g sys -a root 3 Enter the password for authority as the printer administrator. 4 Re-enter the password. Uninstalling the Print Driver 1 Select Computer More Applications... and select GNOME Terminal on the Application Browser. 2 Enter the following command in the terminal window to delete the print queue. su [administrator password] /usr/sbin/lpadmin -x [queue name] 76 Installing Print Drivers on Linux Computers Using Common UNIX Printing System (CUPS) 3 Repeat the command above for all queues for the printer. 4 Enter the following command in the terminal window. su [administrator password] rpm -e Dell-Color-MFP-S2825cdn-H825cdw Operation on Ubuntu 12.04 LTS Setup Overview 1 Install the print driver. 2 Set up the print queue. 3 Set up the default queue. 4 Specify the printing options. Installing the Print Driver 1 Click Dash Home, and then enter the terminal in the Search text box. 2 Click Applications Terminal. 3 Enter the following command in the terminal window. For the 32-bit architecture: sudo lpadmin -d (Enter the queue name) (Type the administrator password) For the 64-bit architecture: sudo dpkg –i (Type the file path)/ dell-color-mfp-s2825cdn-h825cdw-*.*-*_amd6 4.deb (Type the administrator password) Setting Up the Print Queue To execute printing, you must set up the print queue on your workstation. 1 Open the URL http://localhost:631 using a web browser. 2 Click Administration Add Printer. 3 Enter the user name and the administrator password, and then click OK. 4 Select either of the following according to the type of your printer connection. For network connections: Installing Print Drivers on Linux Computers Using Common UNIX Printing System (CUPS) 77 a Select LPD/LPR Host or Printer from the Other Network Printers menu, and then click Continue. b Enter the IP address of the printer in Connection, and then click Continue. Format: lpd://xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx (the IP address of the printer) For USB connections: a Select Dell Color MFP H825cdw from the Local Printers menu, and then click Continue. 5 Select the Add Printer window, and then enter the name of the printer in the Name box. 6 Click Continue. You can optionally specify the location and description of the printer for further information. If you want to share the printer, select the Share This Printer check box. 7 Select Dell from the Make menu, and then click Continue. 8 Select Dell Color MFP H825cdw vxxxx.PS from the Model menu, and then click Add Printer. Printing From Applications When you have finished setting up the print queue, you can print jobs from the applications. Start the print job from the application, and then specify the queue in the print dialog box. However, on programs such as Mozilla, it may only be possible to print from the default queue. In these cases, set the queue that you want to print to as the default queue before you start printing. For information on specifying the default queue, see "Setting Up the Default Queue." Setting Up the Default Queue 1 Click Dash Home, and then enter terminal in the Search text box. 2 Click Terminal in the Applications category of the search results. 3 Enter the following command in the terminal window. sudo lpadmin -d (Enter the queue name) (Type the administrator password) Specifying the Printing Options You can specify the printing options such as 2-sided printing. 1 Open the URL http://localhost:631 using a web browser. 2 Click Administration Manage Printers. 3 Click the queue name for which you want to specify the printing options. 78 Installing Print Drivers on Linux Computers Using Common UNIX Printing System (CUPS) 4 Select Set Default Options from the Administration menu. 5 Click the desired setting item, and then specify the required settings. 6 Click Set Default Options. Uninstalling the Print Driver 1 Click Dash Home, and then enter terminal in the Search text box. 2 Click Terminal in the Applications category of the search results. 3 Enter the following command in the terminal window to delete the print queue. sudo /usr/sbin/lpadmin -x (Type the print queue name) (Type the administrator password) 4 Repeat the command above for all queues for the same model. 5 Enter the following command in the terminal window. sudo dpkg –r Dell-Color-MFP-S2825cdn-H825cdw (Type the administrator password) Installing Print Drivers on Linux Computers Using Common UNIX Printing System (CUPS) 79 Setting the IP Address Assigning an IP Address You can select the IP mode from Dual Stack, IPv4, and IPv6. If your network supports both IPv4 and IPv6, select Dual Stack. Select the IP mode of your environment, and then set IP address, subnet mask (for IPv4 only), and gateway address. NOTE: • Assigning an IP address that is already in use can cause network performance issues. • IP addresses should be assigned by advanced users or system administrators. • When you assign an IP address manually in IPv6 mode, use the Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool. To display the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool, use the link-local address. To check the link-local address, print a system settings report and check the Link-Local Address under Network (Wired) or Network (Wireless). See "Report / List." • Wireless network is available on Dell H625cdw and Dell H825cdw. When Using the Dell Printer Easy Install (Windows® Only) 1 Insert the Software and Documentation disc into your computer. 2 Click Main Menu. 3 Click Change. 80 Setting the IP Address 4 Click Configure the IP address settings Next. 5 Follow the on-screen instructions until the Configure Printer screen appears. 6 Click Advanced. 7 Specify the IP address settings according to your network environment. 8 Click Next, and then follow the on-screen instructions. When Using the Operator Panel 1 Press the (Information) button. 2 Tap the Tools tab Admin Settings Network. If Panel Lock Control is set to Enable, enter the password. See "Panel Lock." 3 Perform either of the following: If the printer is connected to a network with the Ethernet cable: Tap Ethernet. For Dell H625cdw and Dell H825cdw: If the printer is connected to a wireless network: Tap Wi-Fi. 4 Tap IP Mode 5 Tap IPv4 Mode OK. until TCP / IP appears, and then tap TCP / IP Get IP Address. 6 Select how the IP address is assigned. • To set the IP address automatically, select AutoIP, DHCP, BOOTP, RARP, or Panel, and then proceed to step 7. • To set the IP address manually, select Panel, and then perform the following: a Tap IP Address. The cursor is located at the first octet of the IP address. b Use the number pad to enter the first octet of the IP address, and then tap The cursor moves to the next octet. NOTE: • You can only enter one octet at a time and must tap after entering each octet. Enter the rest of the octets, and then tap OK. Tap Subnet Mask. Use the number pad to enter the subnet mask, and then tap OK. Tap Gateway Address. Use the number pad to enter the gateway address, and then tap OK. 7 Turn off the printer, and then turn it on again. Verifying the IP Settings You can check the settings by using the operator panel, or printing the system settings report. Setting the IP Address 81 Verifying the Settings Using Operator Panel 1 Press the (Information) button. 2 Tap About This MFP the Network tab. 3 Verify the IP address displayed in IP(v4) Address. Verifying the Settings Using System Settings Report 1 Print the system settings report. See "Report / List." 2 Verify that the correct IP address, subnet mask, and gateway address are listed in the system settings report under Network (Wired) or Network (Wireless). If the IP address shows 0.0.0.0, an IP address has not been assigned. See "Assigning an IP Address." NOTE: • Wireless network is available on Dell H625cdw and Dell H825cdw. 82 Setting the IP Address 3 Using Your Printer Using the Operator Panel 84 Understanding the System Menus 90 Understanding the Job Menus 125 Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool 139 Print Media Guidelines 187 Loading Print Media 193 Loading Documents 204 83 Using the Operator Panel The operator panel consists of a touch panel, a Ready/Error LED, control buttons, a (Power) button, and a number pad. Use the touch panel and number pad to browse the operator panel menus and enter texts and numbers. For details about names of parts, see "Operator Panel." NOTE: • The screenshots used in this section are those of the Dell H625cdw and Dell H825cdw unless otherwise mentioned. About the Home Screen This section describes the fields and buttons on the Home screen which is displayed by pressing the (Home) button while the user is logged in to the printer. NOTE: • To display the Home screen, register at the portal screen beforehand and log in to the printer, or log in as a Guest without registration. See "User Authentication." • Dell Document Hub is available on Dell H625cdw and Dell H825cdw only. • Wi-Fi Direct Connection Status Icon and Wireless LAN Connection Status Icon are displayed on Dell H625cdw and Dell H825cdw only. Dell H625cdw/Dell H825cdw 45 Home Guest Dell S2825cdn Home Dock Menu Guest (Recent) Button Displays the tiles of the functions you recently used. Up to 8 tiles can be stored. (Copy) Button Displays the tiles of the copy functions. (Print )Button Displays the tiles of the print functions. (Scan) Button Displays the tiles of the scan functions. (Fax) Button Displays the tile of the fax function. (Tools) Button Displays the Information screen. 84 Using the Operator Panel 2 Notification Bar Displays the status of the printer when (Handle) is dragged down. To close the screen, drag (Handle) up. You can adjust the screen brightness, check the toner information, monitor the jobs currently in progress, or check warnings in this area. • To adjust the screen brightness, drag the slider in Screen Brightness. • To see the Toner Information, tap Supplies. The information of the toner is displayed with one toner at a time. To see the information of other toners, swipe the screen. Lock Icon Displays when some functions are limited to access by the Functions Control settings. While the Lock icon is displayed on the upper-right of the tile, you are required to enter the password to enable the function. After the function is enabled, the Lock icon is displayed on the left to the account name, and you can access the password-locked functions without re-entering the password. For details about Functions Control, see "Functions Control" Wi-Fi Direct Connection Status Icon Displays the Wi-Fi Direct connection status. This icon is displayed only when Wi-Fi Direct is enabled. Wireless LAN Connection Status Icon Displays the intensity of wireless signal when the printer is connected to a wireless network. Time/Network Information Displays the current time or the network information such as IPv4 address or host name. Account Name Displays the name of the user currently logged in to the printer. Tiles Displays the tiles of the functions you can select from. When the tile color is pale and disabled, you cannot select the function. Basic Operations on the Touch Panel You can operate the touch panel as with a smartphone or a tablet. Selecting the Item on the Screen Tap the item. Guest Scrolling the Screen or the Listed Items Swipe the screen by dragging your finger on the screen. Using the Operator Panel 85 Home Guest To scroll faster, flick the screen. Home Guest NOTE: • If you cannot swipe or flick on some screens, operate by tapping the tiles or buttons. Moving, Adding or Deleting the Tiles NOTE: • This is available when you select the local authentication. See "User Authentication." To Move the Tiles Tap and hold the tile you want to move, and then drag it to the desired place. The short orange bar appears between the tiles to show the nearest drop point when you are dragging the tile. You can move the tile between pages as well. Home Guest Home Guest NOTE: • You cannot move the tiles in the Recent group screen of the Dock menu. To Add the Tiles Swipe the screen to display the last page of the Home screen or group screen, and then 86 Using the Operator Panel tap Add App. When the Apps List screen appears, tap the tile you want to add to the Home screen. To Delete the Tiles Tap and hold the tile you want to delete. When appears, drag the tile to Home Guest Tap OK to delete the tile. NOTE: • To delete all tiles in the Recent group screen of the Dock Menu, tap screen, and then tap OK. in the Recent group Using the Keyboard Displayed on the Touch Panel During operations, a keyboard for entering text sometimes appears. The following describes how to enter text. Back Done Back Done QWERTY Back AZERTY Done QWERTZ You can enter the following characters: Item Description Entering alphabets To enter uppercase letters, tap . To return to the lowercase letters, tap again. To lock to the uppercase letters, double-tap Entering numbers and symbols Tap Entering a space Tap Deleting characters Tap to delete one character at a time. To Change the Keyboard Layout 1 Press the (Information) button. 2 Tap the Tools tab Language Settings Keyboard Layout. 3 Tap the desired keyboard layout, and then tap OK. Using the Operator Panel 87 Changing the Language 1 Press the (Information) button. 2 Tap the Tools tab 3 Tap Language Settings Panel Language. until the desired language appears, and then tap the desired language. 4 Tap OK. Panel Lock The Panel Lock feature allows some system settings to be kept in a locked state with the password so that unauthorized personnel cannot access to the menu to change the settings. NOTE: • Disabling the operator panel menus does not prevent access to the Stored Print and Tray Settings menus. Enabling the Panel Lock 1 Press the (Information) button. 2 Tap the Tools tab Admin Settings. until Secure Settings appears, and then tap Secure Settings. 3 Tap 4 Tap Panel Lock Panel Lock Control Enable OK. 5 Enter the new password, and then tap OK. 6 Re-enter the password, and then tap OK. CAUTION: • Make sure not to forget the password. If you forget the password, the following procedure allows you to reset the password. However, the settings for the Address Book and Phone Book will be reset as well. 1 Turn off the printer. 2 While holding the (Information) button, turn on the printer. Changing the Panel Lock Password NOTE: • You can change the password only when Panel Lock is set to Enable. 1 Press the (Information) button. 2 Tap the Tools tab Admin Settings. 3 Enter the password. 4 Tap until Secure Settings appears, and then tap Secure Settings. 5 Tap Panel Lock Change Password. 6 Enter the current password, and then tap OK. 7 Enter the new password, and then tap OK. 8 Re-enter the password, and then tap OK. 88 Using the Operator Panel Disabling the Panel Lock 1 Press the (Information) button. 2 Tap the Tools tab Admin Settings. 3 Enter the password. 4 Tap until Secure Settings appears, and then tap Secure Settings. 5 Tap Panel Lock Panel Lock Control Disable OK. 6 Enter the current password, and then tap OK. Setting the Power Saver Timer The printer enters the power saver mode when the printer is not used for a certain period of time. You can set the Power Saver Timer for the printer on the operator panel. 1 Press the (Information) button. 2 Tap the Tools tab Admin Settings System Settings General Power Saver Timer. If Panel Lock Control is set to Enable, enter the password. See "Panel Lock." 3 Tap Sleep or Deep Sleep. 4 Tap – or +, or use the number pad to enter the desired value. You can specify from 1 to 50 minutes for Sleep or 1 to 10 minutes for Deep Sleep. 5 Tap OK. About the Concurrent Jobs Feature This feature enables you to start a concurrent job while a fax job is running. This is done by temporarily displaying the Home screen and switching to a different function that can be run concurrently such as copy or scan. 1 While the printer is sending or receiving a fax, press the (Home) button. 2 Tap Copy. Or Tap Scan. 3 Change the copy or scan settings. For details about the settings, see "Copying" or "Scanning." 4 Tap OK. Using the Operator Panel 89 Understanding the System Menus The system menus are configured by Information, Supplies, and Tools tabs, accessible by pressing the (Information) button on the operator panel. You can limit the access to the some menus by setting the password. This prevents other users from using the operator panel to inadvertently change the settings. See "Panel Lock." Report / List Use the Report / List menu to print various types of reports and lists. To display the Report / List menu, press the (Information) button, and then tap the Information tab. ❚ Report / List > System Settings Prints a list of the current user default values, the installed options, the amount of installed print memory, and the status of printer supplies. ❚ Report / List > Panel Settings Prints a detailed list of all the settings of the printer menus. ❚ Report / List > PCL Fonts List Prints a sample of the available Printer Control Language (PCL) fonts. ❚ Report / List > PCL Macros List Prints the information on the downloaded PCL macro. ❚ Report / List > PS Fonts List Prints a sample of the available PostScript (PS) fonts. ❚ Report / List > PDF Fonts List Prints a sample of the available PDF fonts. ❚ Report / List > Job History Prints a detailed list of the print, copy, fax, or scan jobs that have been processed. This list contains the last 20 jobs. 90 Understanding the System Menus ❚ Report / List > Error History Prints a detailed list of paper jams and fatal errors. ❚ Report / List > Print Meter Prints the reports for the total number of pages printed. ❚ Report / List > Color Test Page Prints a page for testing colors. ❚ Report / List > Protocol Monitor Prints a detailed list of monitored protocols. ❚ Report / List > Speed Dial Prints the list of all members stored as speed dial numbers. ❚ Report / List > Address Book Prints the list of all addresses stored as address book information. ❚ Report / List > Server Address Prints the list of all members stored as server address information. ❚ Report / List > Fax Activity Prints the report of faxes you recently received or sent. ❚ Report / List > Fax Pending Prints the list of status of pending faxes. ❚ Report / List > Stored Documents Prints a list of all files stored for Secure Print, Private Mail Box Print, Public Mail Box Print, and Proof Print in the RAM disk. NOTE: • Stored Documents feature is available only when RAM Disk in General under System Settings is enabled. Understanding the System Menus 91 Printing a Report / List 1 Press the (Information) button. 2 Tap Report / List. 3 Tap until the desired report or list appears, and then select that report or list. 4 Tap Print. Wi-Fi | WPS NOTE: • Wi-Fi Direct is available on Dell H625cdw and Dell H825cdw. Use the Wi-Fi | WPS menu to confirm or specify wireless network settings or connections. To display the Wi-Fi | WPS menu, press the (Information) button, and then tap the Information tab. ❚ Wi-Fi | WPS > Wi-Fi Use the Wi-Fi menu to confirm or specify wireless network settings. For details, see "Wi-Fi.” ❚ Wi-Fi | WPS > Wi-Fi Direct Use the Wi-Fi Direct menu to confirm or specify Wi-Fi Direct network settings. For details, see "Wi-Fi Direct.” ❚ Wi-Fi | WPS > WPS (Connect via PBC) Use WPS (Connect via PBC) menu to start configurations of the Wi-Fi Direct network with WPS-PBC. For details, see "WPS Setup.” ❚ Wi-Fi | WPS > WPS (Connect via PIN) Use WPS (Connect via PIN) menu to start configurations of the Wi-Fi Direct network with WPS-PIN. For details, see "WPS Setup.” Paired Device NOTE: • Wi-Fi Direct is available on Dell H625cdw and Dell H825cdw. Use the Paired Device menu to confirm the device name in the Paired Device list, if there is any device connected to the printer via Wi-Fi Direct. You can disconnect the paired device. For details, see "Disconnecting Wi-Fi Direct Network.” Admin Settings Each feature of the printer is set to the factory default settings. 92 Understanding the System Menus Use the Admin Settings menu to customize the settings in accordance with the setting environment, or your preferences. To display the Admin Settings menu, press the (Information) button, and then tap the Tools tab. ❚ Admin Settings > Phone Book Use the Phone Book menu to configure the speed dial and group dial settings. ❚ Admin Settings > Phone Book > Individuals Stores up to 200 frequently dialed numbers in speed dial locations. ❚ Admin Settings > Phone Book > Groups Creates a group of fax destinations and register it under a two-digit dial code. Up to six group dial codes can be registered. ❚ Admin Settings > PCL Use the PCL menu to change printer settings that only affect jobs using the Printer Control Language (PCL) emulation printer language. ❚ Admin Settings > PCL > Paper Tray Specifies the default paper tray. ❚ Admin Settings > PCL > Paper Size Specifies the default paper size. NOTE: • Selecting a custom size for the paper size prompts you to enter a custom length and width. ❚ Admin Settings > PCL > Orientation Specifies how text and graphics are oriented on the page. Portrait Prints text and graphics parallel to the short edge of the paper. Landscape Prints text and graphics parallel to the long edge of the paper. ❚ Admin Settings > PCL > 2 Sided Print Specifies whether to print on one side or both sides of a sheet of print media. For a two-sided printing, you can specify the printout to be bound by the long edge or short edge. Understanding the System Menus 93 ❚ Admin Settings > PCL > Font Specifies the default font from the fonts registered in the printer. ❚ Admin Settings > PCL > Symbol Set Specifies a symbol set for a specified font. ❚ Admin Settings > PCL > Font Size Specifies the font size for scalable typographic fonts. Font size refers to the height of the characters in the font. One point equals approximately 1/72 of an inch (approximately 0.35 mm). NOTE: • The Font Size menu is only displayed for typographic fonts. ❚ Admin Settings > PCL > Font Pitch Specifies the font pitch for scalable mono spaced fonts. Font pitch refers to the number of fixed-space characters in a horizontal inch of type. For non-scalable mono spaced fonts, the pitch is displayed, but cannot be changed. NOTE: • The Font Pitch menu is only displayed for fixed or mono spaced fonts. ❚ Admin Settings > PCL > Form Line Sets the number of lines in a page. The printer sets the amount of space between two vertical lines based on the Form Line and Orientation menu items. You can select the correct Form Line and Orientation before changing Form Line. ❚ Admin Settings > PCL > Quantity Sets the default print quantity. Set the number of copies required for a specific job from the print driver. Values selected from the print driver always override values selected from the operator panel. ❚ Admin Settings > PCL > Image Enhance Specifies whether to enable the Image Enhance feature, which makes the boundary line between black and white smoother to decrease jagged edges and enhance the visual appearance. ❚ Admin Settings > PCL > Hex Dump Specifies whether to enable the Hex Dump feature, which helps to isolate the source of a print job problem. With Hex Dump selected, all data sent to the printer is printed in hexadecimal and character representation. Control codes are not executed. 94 Understanding the System Menus ❚ Admin Settings > PCL > Draft Mode Specifies whether to enable the Draft Mode feature, which saves toner by printing in the draft mode. The print quality is reduced when printing in the draft mode. ❚ Admin Settings > PCL > Line Termination Adds the line termination commands. Off The line termination command is not added. CR=CR, LF=LF, FF=FF Add-LF The LF command is added. CR=CR-LF, LF=LF, FF=FF Add-CR The CR command is added. CR=CR, LF=CR-LF, FF=CR-FF CR-XX The CR and LF commands are added. CR=CR-LF, LF=CR-LF, FF=CR-FF ❚ Admin Settings > PCL > Default Color Specifies the color mode. This setting is used for a print job that does not specify a print mode. ❚ Admin Settings > PCL > Ignore Form Feed Specifies whether to enable the Ignore Form Feed feature, which ignores blank pages that only contain Form Feed control codes. ❚ Admin Settings > PS Use the PS (PostScript) menu to change printer settings that only affect jobs using the PostScript Level3 Compatible emulation printer language. ❚ Admin Settings > PS > PS Error Report Specifies whether to enable the PS Error Report feature, which specifies the contents of the errors concerning PostScript Level3 Compatible page description language are printed. The change becomes effective after the printer is turned off and then on again. NOTE: • Instructions from the PS driver override the settings specified on the operator panel. ❚ Admin Settings > PS > PS Job Time-out Specifies whether to enable the PS feature, which specifies the execution time for one PostScript Level3 Compatible job. The change becomes effective after the printer is turned off and then on again. Understanding the System Menus 95 ❚ Admin Settings > PS > Paper Select Mode Specifies the way to select the tray for PostScript Level3 Compatible mode. The change becomes effective after the printer is turned off and then on again. Auto The tray is selected as the same setting as in the PCL mode. Select From Tray The tray is selected in a method compatible with regular PostScript Level3 Compatible printers. ❚ Admin Settings > PS > Default Color Specifies the color mode to Color or Black. This setting is used for a print job which does not specify a print mode. ❚ Admin Settings > PDF Use the PDF menu to change printer settings that only affect the PDF jobs. ❚ Admin Settings > PDF > Quantity Specifies the number of copies to print. ❚ Admin Settings > PDF > 2 Sided Print Specifies whether to print on one side or both sides of a sheet of print media. For a two-sided printing, you can specify the printout to be bound by the long edge or short edge. ❚ Admin Settings > PDF > Print Mode Specifies the print mode. Normal For documents with normal sized characters. High Quality For documents with small characters or thin lines, or documents printed using a dot-matrix printer. High Speed Prints with the higher speed than the Normal mode, but the quality is less. ❚ Admin Settings > PDF > PDF Password Specifies the password to print a PDF file secured with a password to open the PDF file. ❚ Admin Settings > PDF > Collation Specifies whether to sort the PDF job. 96 Understanding the System Menus ❚ Admin Settings > PDF > Output Size Specifies the output paper size for the PDF file. ❚ Admin Settings > PDF > Layout Specifies the output layout. Auto % Prints the document in the layout specified by the printer. 100% (No Zoom) Prints in the same size as the document. Booklet Prints on both sides of a sheet of paper bound by the edge. 2 Pages Up Prints two pages on one side of a sheet of paper. 4 Pages Up Prints four pages on one side of a sheet of paper. ❚ Admin Settings > PDF > Default Color Specifies the default output color. ❚ Admin Settings > PDF > Detect Job Separator Specifies whether to detect the end of the job in printing PDF files successively. ❚ Admin Settings > Network Use the Network menu to change the printer settings affecting jobs sent to the printer through the wired or wireless network. ❚ Admin Settings > Network > Wi-Fi NOTE: • When the Ethernet cable is disconnected, the Wi-Fi | WPS menu is available. • Wireless network is available on Dell H625cdw and Dell H825cdw. Checks or specifies network settings. ❚ Admin Settings > Network > Wi-Fi > Wi-Fi NOTE: • Wireless network is available on Dell H625cdw and Dell H825cdw. Specifies whether to enable the Wi-Fi feature. ❚ Admin Settings > Network > Wi-Fi > Wi-Fi Status NOTE: • Wi-Fi Status setting is available only when the printer is connected using the wireless network. • Wireless network is available on Dell H625cdw and Dell H825cdw. Checks the wireless communication status. Status Good Understanding the System Menus 97 Acceptable Low No Reception SSID Displays the name that identifies the wireless network. Encryption Type Displays the encryption type. ❚ Admin Settings > Network > Wi-Fi> Wi-Fi Setup Wizard NOTE: • Wi-Fi Setup Wizard is available only when the printer is connected using the wireless network. • Wireless network is available on Dell H625cdw and Dell H825cdw. Configures the wireless network interface. ❚ Admin Settings > Network > Wi-Fi > Wi-Fi Setup Wizard > Select access point Selects the access point from the list. WEP Key When you select an access point using WEP as the encryption type, enter the WEP key. PassPhrase When you select an access point using WPA, WPA2, or Mixed as the encryption type, enter the passphrase. ❚ Admin Settings > Network > Wi-Fi > Wi-Fi Setup Wizard > Manual SSID Setup Configures the wireless settings using the operator panel manually. ❚ Admin Settings > Network > Wi-Fi > Wi-Fi Setup Wizard > Manual SSID Setup > SSID Specifies a name to identify the wireless network. Up to 32 alphanumeric characters can be entered. ❚ Admin Settings > Network > Wi-Fi > Wi-Fi Setup Wizard > Manual SSID Setup > SSID > Infrastructure Selects when you configure the wireless setting through the access point such as a wireless. No Security Specifies No Security to configure the wireless setting without specifying an encryption type from WEP and WPA-PSK-AES. Mixed mode PSK Selects to configure the wireless setting with the encryption type of Mixed mode PSK. Mixed mode PSK automatically selects the encryption type from either WPA-PSK-AES or WPA2-PSK-AES. Passphrase WPA2-PSK-AES Selects to configure the wireless setting with the encryption type of WPA2-PSK-AES. Passphrase WEP Specifies the passphrase of alphanumeric characters from 8 to 63. (hex: 0-9, a-f, A-F, 16 to 64 characters) Specifies the WEP key to use through the wireless network. For 64bit keys, up to 10 hexadecimal characters can be entered. For 128bit keys, up to 26 hexadecimal characters can be entered. Transmit Key 98 Specifies the passphrase of alphanumeric characters from 8 to 63. Specifies the transmit key from Auto and WEP Key 1 - 4. Understanding the System Menus ❚ Admin Settings > Network > Wi-Fi > Wi-Fi Setup Wizard > Manual SSID Setup > SSID > Ad-hoc Selects to configure the wireless setting without the access point such as a wireless router. No Security Configures the wireless setting without specifying the encryption type from WEP. WEP Specifies the WEP key to use through the wireless network. For 64bit keys, up to 10 hexadecimal characters can be entered. For 128bit keys, up to 26 hexadecimal characters can be entered. Transmit Key Specifies the transmit key from WEP Key 1 - 4. ❚ Admin Settings > Network > Wi-Fi > WPS Setup NOTE: • WPS Setup is available only when the printer is connected using the wireless network. • WPS Setup is available on Dell H625cdw and Dell H825cdw. Configures the wireless network using WPS. Push Button Configuration Configures the wireless setting with Wi-Fi Protected Setup-Push Button Configuration (WPS-PBC) . PIN Code Configures the wireless setting using the PIN code assigned by the printer. You can also print the PIN code. Check it when entering PIN assigned to the printer into your computer. ❚ Admin Settings > Network > Wi-Fi > IP Mode Configures the IP mode. Dual Stack Uses both IPv4 and IPv6 to set the IP address. IPv4 Mode IPv6 Mode ❚ Admin Settings > Network > Wi-Fi > TCP/IP Configures TCP/IP settings. Get IP Address IP Address AutoIP Sets the IP address automatically. A random value in the range of 169.254.1.0 to 169.254.254.255 that is not currently in use on the network is set as the IP address. The subnet mask is set as 255.255.0.0. BOOTP Sets the IP address using BOOTP. RARP Sets the IP address using RARP. DHCP Sets the IP address using DHCP. Panel Use this option when you want to set the IP address manually on the operator panel. When an IP address is being set manually, the IP is allocated to the printer using the format nnn.nnn.nnn.nnn. Each octet that makes up nnn.nnn.nnn.nnn is a value in the range of 0 to 254. 127 and any value in the range of 224 to 254 cannot be specified for the first octet of a gateway address. Understanding the System Menus 99 Subnet Mask When an IP address is being set manually, the subnet mask is specified using the format nnn.nnn.nnn.nnn. Each octet that makes up nnn.nnn.nnn.nnn is a value in the range of 0 to 255.255.255.255.255 cannot be specified as the subnet mask. Gateway Address When an IP address is being set manually, the gateway address is specified using the format nnn.nnn.nnn.nnn. Each octet that makes up nnn.nnn.nnn.nnn is a value in the range of 0 to 254. 127 and any value in the range of 224 to 254 cannot be specified for the first octet of a gateway address. ❚ Admin Settings > Network > Wi-Fi > IPsec NOTE: • IPsec is displayed only when IPsec is enabled on the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool. Disables IPsec. ❚ Admin Settings > Network > Wi-Fi > Reset Wi-Fi NOTE: • Reset Wi-Fi setting is available only when the printer is connected to the wireless network. • Wireless network is available on Dell H625cdw and Dell H825cdw. Initializes wireless network settings. After executing this setting and restarting the printer, all wireless network settings are reset to their default values. ❚ Admin Settings > Network > Wi-Fi Direct NOTE: • When the Ethernet cable is connected, or Wi-Fi is set to Off, Wi-Fi Direct is disabled. • Wi-Fi Direct is available on Dell H625cdw and Dell H825cdw. Configures the Wi-Fi Direct network settings. Wi-Fi Direct Group Role Enables or disables the Wi-Fi Direct network. Auto Automatically resolves the group role for Wi-Fi Direct. Group Owner Sets the printer as the Group Owner when using Wi-Fi Direct. Setting the printer to become the group owner makes it possible for mobile devices to discover the printer. The SSID of the printer is displayed in the list of wireless networks on your mobile device. Device Name Specifies the printer name that identifies the Wi-Fi Direct network with up to 32 alphanumeric characters. Check it when selecting the printer name on your mobile device. Paired Device Displays the status of the Wi-Fi Direct connections between the printer and up to 3 Wi-Fi mobile devices. Disconnect All Disconnect now Disconnects all the Wi-Fi Direct connections right now. Disconnect and Disconnects the Wi-Fi Direct connections and Reset resets the passphrase. Passphrase 100 Understanding the System Menus SSID Displays the name that identifies the Wi-Fi Direct network. You can also specify the name with up to 32 alphanumeric characters. "DIRECT-XX" cannot be changed. Check it when selecting the Wi-Fi Direct network name on your mobile device. Passphrase Displays the passphrase. Check it when entering the passphrase into your mobile device. Print Passphrase Prints the passphrase. Check it when entering the passphrase into your mobile device. Reset Passphrase Resets the passphrase. WPS Setup Configures the Wi-Fi Direct network using WPS. Push Button Configuration Configures the Wi-Fi Direct network with Wi-Fi Protected Setup-Push Button Configuration (WPS-PBC). PIN Code Configures the Wi-Fi Direct network using PIN code assigned by the printer. Print PIN Code Prints the PIN code. Check it when entering PIN assigned to the printer into your mobile device. Reset Code Resets the PIN code. ❚ Admin Settings > Network > Ethernet NOTE: • When using a wired network, the Wi-Fi | WPS menu is not available. Checks or specifies network settings. ❚ Admin Settings > Network > Ethernet > IP Mode Configures the IP mode. Dual Stack Uses both IPv4 and IPv6 to set the IP address. IPv4 Mode IPv6 Mode ❚ Admin Settings > Network > Ethernet > TCP/IP Configures TCP/IP settings. Get IP Address AutoIP Sets the IP address automatically. A random value in the range of 169.254.1.0 to 169.254.254.255 that is not currently in use on the network is set as the IP address. The subnet mask is set as 255.255.0.0. BOOTP Sets the IP address using BOOTP. RARP Sets the IP address using RARP. DHCP Sets the IP address using DHCP. Panel Use this option when you want to set the IP address manually on the operator panel. Understanding the System Menus 101 IP Address When an IP address is being set manually, the IP is allocated to the printer using the format nnn.nnn.nnn.nnn. Each octet that makes up nnn.nnn.nnn.nnn is a value in the range of 0 to 254. 127 and any value in the range of 224 to 254 cannot be specified for the first octet of a gateway address. Subnet Mask When an IP address is being set manually, the subnet mask is specified using the format nnn.nnn.nnn.nnn. Each octet that makes up nnn.nnn.nnn.nnn is a value in the range of 0 to 255.255.255.255.255 cannot be specified as the subnet mask. Gateway Address When an IP address is being set manually, the gateway address is specified using the format nnn.nnn.nnn.nnn. Each octet that makes up nnn.nnn.nnn.nnn is a value in the range of 0 to 254. 127 and any value in the range of 224 to 254 cannot be specified for the first octet of a gateway address. ❚ Admin Settings > Network > Ethernet > IPsec NOTE: • IPsec is displayed only when IPsec is enabled on the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool. Disables IPsec. ❚ Admin Settings > Network > Ethernet > Connection Speed NOTE: • The Connection Speed setting is available only when the printer is connected to the wired network. Specifies the communication speed and the duplex settings of Ethernet. The change becomes effective after the printer is turned off and then on again. Auto 10BASE-T Half 10BASE-T Full 100BASE-TX Half 100BASE-TX Full 1000BASE-T Full ❚ Admin Settings > Network > Protocols Enables or disables each protocol. The change becomes effective after the printer is turned off and then on again. LPD Port9100 FTP IPP SMB TCP/IP WSD Print*1 WSD Scan Network TWAIN SNMP UDP*2 102 Understanding the System Menus E-mail Alert Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool Bonjour(mDNS) Telnet Update Address Book HTTP-SSL/TLS Google Cloud Print Print from Dell Document Hub*3 Scan to Dell Document Hub*3 *1 *2 *3 Stands for Web Services on Devices Stands for Simple Network Management Protocol This is available on Dell H625cdw and Dell H825cdw. ❚ Admin Settings > Network > Advanced Settings Specifies advanced network settings. ❚ Admin Settings > Network > Advanced Settings > IP Filter NOTE: • The IP Filter setting is available only for LPD or Port9100. • Wireless network is available on Dell H625cdw and Dell H825cdw. Specifies whether to block data received through the wired or wireless network. IPv4-Filter Enables or disables IPv4 Filter. IPv6-Filter Enables or disables IPv6 Filter. ❚ Admin Settings > Network > Advanced Settings > IEEE 802.1x NOTE: • IEEE 802.1x is displayed only when the printer is connected using Ethernet cable and it is available only when the IEEE 802.1x authentication is enabled. Disables IEEE 802.1x authentication. The change becomes effective after the printer is turned off and then on again. ❚ Admin Settings > Network > Advanced Settings > PS Data Format Specifies PostScript Level3 Compatible communication protocol for a parallel interface, you can configure the PS Data Format settings for the wired network. The change becomes effective after the printer is turned off and then on again. Auto Used when auto-detecting the PostScript Level3 Compatible communication protocol. Standard Used when the communication protocol is in ASCII interface. BCP Used when the communication protocol is in binary format. TBCP Used when the communication protocol supports both ASCII and binary data to switch between them according to the specified control code. Binary Used when no special processing is required for data. Understanding the System Menus 103 ❚ Admin Settings > Network > Reset LAN Initializes wired network data stored in non-volatile memory (NVM). After executing this setting and restarting the printer, all wired network settings are reset to their default values. ❚ Admin Settings > Network > Delete All Certificates Deletes all certificates of the printer. After executing this setting and restarting the printer, all certificates are deleted. ❚ Admin Settings > Fax Settings Use the Fax Settings menu to configure the basic fax settings. ❚ Admin Settings > Fax Settings > Fax Line Settings Configures basic settings for the fax line. ❚ Admin Settings > Fax Settings > Fax Line Settings > Fax Number Sets the fax number of the printer to be printed on the header of a fax message. NOTE: • Make sure to specify Fax Number before using Junk Fax Setup. ❚ Admin Settings > Fax Settings > Fax Line Settings > Country Selects the country where the printer is used. ❚ Admin Settings > Fax Settings > Fax Line Settings > Fax Header Name Sets the sender name to be printed on the header on faxes. ❚ Admin Settings > Fax Settings > Fax Line Settings > Line Type Specifies the default line type to PSTN or PBX. ❚ Admin Settings > Fax Settings > Fax Line Settings > Line Monitor Specifies whether to enable the Line Monitor setting. Set the volume of the line monitor, which audibly monitors a transmission through the internal speaker until a connection is made. ❚ Admin Settings > Fax Settings > Fax Line Settings > DRPD Pattern Provides a separate number for faxing with a distinctive ring pattern. 104 Understanding the System Menus Pattern1–7 Distinctive Ring Pattern Detection (DRPD) is a service provided by some telephone companies. DRPD Patterns are specified by your telephone company. The following shows the patterns provided with the printer. Pattern1 Pattern2 Pattern3 Pattern4 Pattern5 Pattern6 Pattern7 Ask your telephone company which pattern you need to select to use this service. For example, Pattern7 is the New Zealand FaxAbility distinctive ringing pattern: rings for 400 ms, stops for 800 ms, rings for 400 ms and stops for 1400 ms. This pattern is repeated over and over again. This printer only responds to Distinctive Alert cadence(s) DA4 in New Zealand. ❚ Admin Settings > Fax Settings > Incoming Defaults Configures settings for incoming fax. ❚ Admin Settings > Fax Settings > Incoming Defaults > Receive Mode Selects the default fax receiving mode. Telephone Automatic fax reception is turned off. You can receive a fax by picking up the handset of the external telephone and then pressing the remote receive code, or by tapping Manual Receive in On Hook and then tapping Receive. Fax Automatically receives faxes. Telephone / Fax When the printer receives an incoming fax, the external telephone rings for the time specified in Auto Receive Tel/Fax, and then the printer starts receiving the fax. If an incoming call is not a fax, the printer beeps from the internal speaker indicating that the call is a telephone call. Understanding the System Menus 105 Ans Machine/Fax This mode is intended for use with an answering machine. When the answering machine receives the call, the printer monitors the call for fax tones. When the printer detects fax tones, the printer automatically receives the fax. When the answering machine is off, the printer goes into the Fax mode after the ring tone sounds for a predefined time. If the phone communication in your country is serial, this mode is not supported. DRPD Before using the Distinctive Ring Pattern Detection (DRPD) option, a distinctive ring service must be installed on your telephone line by the telephone company. After the telephone company has provided a separate number for faxing with a distinctive ring pattern, configure the fax setup to monitor for that specific ring pattern. ❚ Admin Settings > Fax Settings > Incoming Defaults > Ring Tone Volume Specifies whether to enable the Ring Tone Volume setting. Set the volume of the ring tone, which indicates that an incoming call is a telephone call through the internal speaker when Receive Mode is set to Telephone / Fax. ❚ Admin Settings > Fax Settings > Incoming Defaults > Auto Receive Setup Configures settings for automatic fax reception. Auto Receive Fax Sets the interval at which the printer goes into the fax receive mode after receiving an incoming call. Auto Receive Tel/Fax Sets the interval at which the printer goes into the fax receive mode after the external telephone receives an incoming call. Auto Receive Ans/Fax Sets the interval at which the printer goes into the fax receive mode after the external answering machine receives an incoming call. ❚ Admin Settings > Fax Settings > Incoming Defaults > Junk Fax Setup Specifies whether to enable the Junk Fax Setup feature, which rejects unwanted faxes by accepting faxes only from the fax numbers registered in the Phone Book. ❚ Admin Settings > Fax Settings > Incoming Defaults > Secure Receive NOTE: • The Secure Receive feature is available only when Panel Lock Control is set to Enable. Specifies whether to require a password to print received faxes, and to set or change the password. Secure Receive Set Change Password Sets to require a password to print received faxes. Sets or changes the four-digit password required to print received faxes. This item is available only when Secure Receive Set is set to Enable. ❚ Admin Settings > Fax Settings > Incoming Defaults > Received Fax Forward Sets whether to forward incoming faxes to a specified destination. Off 106 Understanding the System Menus Forward Forwards incoming faxes to a specified destination. Prints incoming faxes if an error occurs during the transfer. Forwarding Number Print and Forward Specifies the fax number of the destination to which incoming faxes are forwarded. Prints incoming faxes and also forwards them to a specified destination. Forwarding Number Specifies the fax number of the destination to which incoming faxes are forwarded. Forward to Email *1,2,3 Forwards incoming faxes to specified e-mail addresses. Prints incoming faxes if an error occurs during the transfer. Print and Forward to E-mail*2,3 Prints incoming faxes and also forwards them to a specified e-mail address. Forward to Server Forwards incoming faxes to a specified server address. Prints incoming faxes if an error occurs during the transfer. Print and Forward to Server Prints incoming faxes and also forwards them to a specified server address. *1 *2 *3 Depending on the e-mail server settings, the printer may not get an error which occurs during the transfer. This item is available only when the E-Mail Server information is registered. See "E-Mail Server." This item is available only when Forwarding E-mail Address is registered. See "Fax Settings." ❚ Admin Settings > Fax Settings > Incoming Defaults > 2 Sided Print Specifies whether to enable the 2 Sided Print feature, which sets the duplex printing for fax. NOTE: • Duplex print may not be done depending on the size of the received faxes or settings of the trays, etc. ❚ Admin Settings > Fax Settings > Incoming Defaults > Remote Receive Specifies whether to enable the Remote Receive feature, which receives a fax by pressing a remote receive code on the external telephone after picking up the handset of the telephone. You can specify the tone in two digits to start Remote Receive. ❚ Admin Settings > Fax Settings > Incoming Defaults > Discard Size Specifies whether to enable the Discard Size feature, which sets the printer to discard images or any text at the bottom of a fax page when the entire page does not fit the output paper. You can also set to automatically reduce a fax page to fit it onto the appropriate paper size. ❚ Admin Settings > Fax Settings > Transmission Defaults Configures settings for transmitting fax. ❚ Admin Settings > Fax Settings > Transmission Defaults > Auto Redial Setup Configures settings for automatic redial. Understanding the System Menus 107 Redial Attempts Sets the number of redial attempts to make when the destination fax number is busy. If you enter 0, the printer does not redial. Interval of Redial Sets the interval between redial attempts. Resend Delay Sets the interval between re-send attempts. ❚ Admin Settings > Fax Settings > Transmission Defaults > Tone / Pulse Selects the dialing type. Tone Uses tone dialing. Pulse(10PPS) Sets Dial Pulse, 10 Pulse Per Second as the dial type. Pulse(20PPS) Sets Dial Pulse, 20 Pulse Per Second as the dial type. ❚ Admin Settings > Fax Settings > Transmission Defaults > Prefix Dial Specifies whether to enable the Prefix Dial feature, which sets a prefix dial number. You can set a prefix dial number of up to five digits. This number dials before any auto dial number is started. It is useful for accessing the Private Automatic Branch Exchange (PABX). ❚ Admin Settings > Fax Settings > Transmission Defaults > Fax Cover Page Specifies whether to enable the Fax Cover Page feature, which sets to attach a cover page to faxes. ❚ Admin Settings > Fax Settings > Transmission Defaults > Fax Header Specifies whether to enable the Fax Header feature, which prints the sender information on the header of the faxes. NOTE: • If United States is selected for the setting of Country, this option does not appear on the menu. The setting is fixed to On and cannot be changed. See "Specifying the Fax Initial Settings Using the Operator Panel.” ❚ Admin Settings > Fax Settings > Transmission Defaults > ECM Specifies whether to enable the ECM (Error Correction Mode) feature. To use the ECM, the remote machines must also support the ECM. ❚ Admin Settings > Fax Settings > Transmission Defaults > Modem Speed Adjusts the fax modem speed when a fax transmission or reception error occurs. ❚ Admin Settings > Fax Settings > Transmission Defaults > Display Manual Fax Recipients Specifies whether to enable the Display Manual Fax Recipients feature, which displays the fax number of the recipient on the Sending Fax screen when manually sending a fax. 108 Understanding the System Menus ❚ Admin Settings > Fax Settings > Fax Reports Configures settings for fax reports. ❚ Admin Settings > Fax Settings > Fax Reports > Fax Activity Sets whether to automatically print a fax activity report after every 50 incoming and outgoing fax communications. Auto Print No Auto Print ❚ Admin Settings > Fax Settings > Fax Reports > Fax Transmit Sets whether to print a transmission result after a fax transmission. Print Always Prints a transmission report after every fax transmission. Print On Error Prints a transmission report only when an error occurs. Print Disable Does not print a transmission report after a fax transmission. ❚ Admin Settings > Fax Settings > Fax Reports > Fax Broadcast Sets whether to print a transmission result after a fax transmission to multiple destinations. Print Always Prints a transmission report after every fax transmission. Print On Error Prints a transmission report only when an error occurs. Print Disable Does not print a transmission report after a fax transmission to multiple destinations. ❚ Admin Settings > Fax Settings > Fax Reports > Fax Protocol Sets whether to print the protocol monitor report, which helps you identify the cause of a communication problem. Print Always Prints a protocol monitor report after every fax transmission. Print On Error Prints the protocol monitor report only when an error occurs. Print Disable Does not print the protocol monitor report. ❚ Admin Settings > System Settings Use System Settings to configure the power saving mode, warning tones, time-out duration, display language, and job log auto print settings. ❚ Admin Settings > System Settings > General Configures general settings for the printer. Understanding the System Menus 109 ❚ Admin Settings > System Settings > General > Power Saver Timer Specifies the time for transition to power saver mode. Sleep Specifies the time taken by the printer to enter the Sleep mode after it finishes a job. Deep Sleep Specifies the time taken by the printer to enter the Deep Sleep mode after it has entered Sleep mode. Power Off Timer Specifies whether to enable the Power Off Timer and the time taken by the printer to enter the Power Off Timer mode after it has entered the Deep Sleep mode. When you specify 1 minute for Sleep, the printer enters power saver mode 1 minute after it finishes a job. This uses much less energy, but requires more warm-up time for the printer. Specify 1 minute if the printer shares an electrical circuit with room lighting and you notice lights flickering. Select a high value if the printer is in constant use. In most circumstances, this keeps the printer ready to operate with minimum warm-up time. Select a medium value if you want a balance between energy consumption and a shorter warm-up period. The printer returns to the standby mode from the power saver mode when it receives data from the computer or remote fax machine. You can also change the status of the printer to the standby mode by pressing any button on the operator panel. ❚ Admin Settings > System Settings > General > Date & Time Specifies the date and time formats. Time Zone Sets the time zone. Date Sets the date depending on the Format settings. Format Time Sets the date format. Sets the time. Format Sets the time format. ❚ Admin Settings > System Settings > General > mm / inch Specifies the default measurement unit displayed after the numeric value on the touch panel. NOTE: • The default for mm / inch varies depending on other settings, such as Country and Document Size. ❚ Admin Settings > System Settings > General > Screen Brightness Adjusts the screen brightness of the touch panel. ❚ Admin Settings > System Settings > General > Audio Tone Specifies whether to enable the Audio Tone feature, which emits a tone during operation or when a warning message appears. 110 Understanding the System Menus Control Panel Selects the volume for a tone when the operator panel input is correct. Invalid Key Selects the volume for a tone when the operator panel input is incorrect. Machine Ready Selects the volume for a tone when the printer is ready to process a job. Copy Completed Selects the volume for a tone when a copy job is complete. Job Completed Selects the volume for a tone when a job other than a copy job is complete. Fault Tone Selects the volume for a tone when a job ends abnormally. Alert Tone Selects the volume for a tone when a problem occurs. Out of Paper Selects the volume for a tone when the printer runs out of paper. Low Toner Alert Selects the volume for a tone when a toner is low. Auto Clear Alert Selects the volume for a tone 5 seconds before the printer performs auto clear. NFC Authentication* Selects the volume for a tone when an NFC card is placed on the NFC reader for authentication. All Tones Selects the volume for all the alert tones. This is available on Dell H625cdw and Dell H825cdw. ❚ Admin Settings > System Settings > General > Low Toner Alert Message Specifies whether to enable the Low Toner Alert Message feature, which shows the alert message when the toner is low. ❚ Admin Settings > System Settings > General > OffHook Wake Up Specifies whether to enable the OffHook Wake Up feature, which wakes up from the Sleep or Deep Sleep mode when you pick up the handset of the external telephone. ❚ Admin Settings > System Settings > General > Auto Log Print Specifies whether to enable the Auto Log Print feature, which automatically prints a job history report after every 20 jobs. Print logs can also be printed using the Report / List menu. ❚ Admin Settings > System Settings > General > RAM Disk Specifies whether to enable the RAM Disk feature, which allocates memory to the RAM disk file system for the Secure Print, Private MailBox Print, Public Mail Box Print, and Proof Print features. The change becomes effective after the printer is turned off and then on again. NOTE: • Turn off the printer, and then turn it on again to apply the settings for the RAM Disk menu. ❚ Admin Settings > System Settings > General > Fax Server Phone Book Specifies whether to enable the Fax Server Phone Book feature, which searches the Understanding the System Menus 111 phone numbers from the Phone Book for the LDAP server. NOTE: • You can search the phone numbers only from the local Phone Book when Fax Server Phone Book is set to Off. ❚ Admin Settings > System Settings > General > E-mail Server Address Book Specifies whether to enable the E-mail Server Address Book feature, which searches the e-mail addresses from the Address Book for the LDAP server. NOTE: • You can search the e-mail addresses only from the local Address Book when E-mail Server Address Book is set to Off. ❚ Admin Settings > System Settings > General > Power On Wizard Performs initial setup for the printer. ❚ Admin Settings > System Settings > General > Max E-mail Size Specifies the maximum size of e-mail that can be sent. ❚ Admin Settings > System Settings > Timers Configures timer settings. ❚ Admin Settings > System Settings > Timers > Auto Reset Automatically resets the settings for Copy, Scan, Fax, E-mail, or Print to the default settings and return to the standby mode after you do not specify any settings for the specified time. ❚ Admin Settings > System Settings > Timers > Fault Time-out Specifies whether to enable the Fault Time-out feature, which specifies the amount of time the printer waits before canceling a job that stops abnormally. The print job is canceled if the time-out time is exceeded. ❚ Admin Settings > System Settings > Output Settings Configures settings concerning output from the printer. ❚ Admin Settings > System Settings > Output Settings > Default Paper Size Specifies the default paper size. ❚ Admin Settings > System Settings > Output Settings > Print ID Specifies whether to enable the Print ID feature, which specifies a location where the 112 Understanding the System Menus user ID is printed. NOTE: • When printing on DL size paper, a part of the user ID may not be printed correctly. ❚ Admin Settings > System Settings > Output Settings > Print Text Specifies whether to enable the Print Text feature. This feature outputs Page Description Language (PDL) data, which is not supported by the printer, as text when the printer receives it. Text data is printed on A4 or Letter size paper. ❚ Admin Settings > System Settings > Output Settings > Banner Sheet Specifies the position of banner sheet, and also specify the tray in which the banner sheet is loaded. Insert Position Specify Tray Off Does not print the banner sheet. Front Inserted before the first page of every copy. Back Inserted after the last page of every copy. Front & Back Inserted before the first page of every copy and after the last page of every copy. The banner sheet is loaded in the Multipurpose Feeder (MPF)/tray1/optional 550-sheet feeder. ❚ Admin Settings > System Settings > Output Settings > Substitute Tray Specifies whether to use paper of a different size when the paper that is loaded in the specified tray does not match the paper size settings for the current job. Off No tray size substitute accepted. Larger Size Substitutes paper of next largest size. When there is no larger paper size, the printer substitutes paper of nearest size. Nearest Size Substitutes paper of nearest size. Use MPF Substitutes paper from the Multipurpose Feeder (MPF). ❚ Admin Settings > System Settings > Output Settings > Letterhead 2 Sided Specifies whether to enable the Letterhead 2 Sided feature, which prints on both sides when using letterhead. ❚ Admin Settings > System Settings > Output Settings > A4<>Letter Switch Specifies whether to enable the A4<>Letter Switch feature. This feature prints A4 size jobs on Letter size paper if A4 size paper is not available or to print Letter size jobs on A4 size paper if Letter size paper is not available. ❚ Admin Settings > System Settings > Output Settings > A5<>Statement Switch Specifies whether to enable the A5<>Statement Switch feature. This feature prints A5 size jobs on Statement size paper if A5 size paper is not available or to print Statement size jobs on A5 size paper if Statement size paper is not available. Understanding the System Menus 113 ❚ Admin Settings > System Settings > Output Settings > Report 2 Sided Print Specifies whether to print reports on one side or both sides of a sheet of print media. ❚ Admin Settings > System Settings > Output Settings > Use Another Tray Specifies whether to enable the Use Another Tray feature, which changes to another paper tray when paper runs out in the specified paper tray. NOTE: • The size of image to print is not adjusted automatically. If you select another paper tray with paper size smaller than the paper size specified in the job, the parts that are larger than the print media are not printed. ❚ Admin Settings > System Settings > Output Settings > Resume Printing After Jam Recovery Specifies whether to enable the Resume Printing After Jam Recovery feature. This feature deletes print job after recovering from paper jam. ❚ Admin Settings > System Settings > Set Available Time Sets the available time for the Copy, Scan, Fax, and Print functions. Copy/Scan/Fax/ Set Available Print Time Specifies whether to set the time when function is available. Start Time End Time Recurrence Sets the day of the week to repeat the setting. NOTE: • Set Available Time can be configured when Print, Copy, Scan, or Fax is set to On. ❚ Admin Settings > System Settings > Secure Job Expiration NOTE: • Secure Job Expiration feature is available only when RAM Disk is set to On. Specifies the date and time to delete the files stored as Secure Print in the RAM disk. Expiration Mode Sets whether to enable or disable the Secure Job Expiration feature. Expiration Time Sets the time to delete the files stored as Secure Print in the RAM disk. Recurrence Sets the recurrence to delete the files stored as Secure Print in the RAM disk. Weekly Setting Sets the day of the week to delete the files stored as Secure Print in the RAM disk. Monthly Setting Sets the day of the month to delete the files stored as Secure Print in the RAM disk. ❚ Admin Settings > System Settings > ColorTrack Mode Specifies whether to enable the ColorTrack Mode feature, which limits access to color printing. 114 Understanding the System Menus ❚ Admin Settings > System Settings > Non Registered User Specifies whether to enable the Non Registered User feature, which permits the printing of data without authentication information. ❚ Admin Settings > System Settings > Auto Color To Mono Print NOTE: • The Auto Color To Mono Print feature is available when Dell ColorTrack is disabled. Specifies whether to enable the Auto Color To Mono Print feature, which prints all print jobs in black and white even when color print is specified. ❚ Admin Settings > System Settings > ColorTrack Error Report Specifies whether to enable the ColorTrack Error Report feature, which prints error-related information if printing with ColorTrack results in an error. ❚ Admin Settings > System Settings > NFC - Tap to Print Specifies whether to add the printer to a mobile device such as a tablet or a notebook computer by tapping the device to the (NFC) reader. NOTE: • This is available on Dell H625cdw and Dell H825cdw. ❚ Admin Settings > System Settings > Calibration Specifies tray to calibrate the machine regularly. This feature corrects consistency of printing colors over time, environment and print media. ❚ Admin Settings > Maintenance Use the Maintenance menu to initialize the non-volatile (NV) memory, configure the plain paper quality adjustment settings, and configure the security settings. ❚ Admin Settings > Maintenance > Paper Density Specifies paper density settings. ❚ Admin Settings > Maintenance > Adjust Transfer Belt Unit Adjusts the transfer bias when the faint image of the previous page, a part of the page currently printing, etc. appear on the output. K Offset If faint black colored ghosts appear, try to decrease the value. YMC Offset If faint ghosts in color (yellow, magenta, or cyan) appear, try to decrease the value. Understanding the System Menus 115 ❚ Admin Settings > Maintenance > Adjust 2nd BTR NOTE: • The print quality changes depending on the setting values you select for this item. Specifies the transfer roller voltage adjustment for each paper type. If you see mottles on the print output, try to increase the voltage. If you see white spots on the print output, try to decrease the voltage. ❚ Admin Settings > Maintenance > Adjust Fusing Unit NOTE: • The print quality changes depending on the setting values you select for this item. Adjusts the temperature setting of the fusing unit for each paper type. When the printouts are curled, try to lower the temperature. When the toner does not fuse on the paper properly, try to increase the temperature. ❚ Admin Settings > Maintenance > Color Reg Adjust Auto Correct Automatically performs color registration correction. ❚ Admin Settings > Maintenance > Clean Developer Stirs the developer in the drum cartridge. ❚ Admin Settings > Maintenance > Toner Refresh Cleans the toner in the drum cartridge. NOTE: • The Toner Refresh feature uses the toner, and shorten the life of the toner cartridge and the drum cartridge. ❚ Admin Settings > Maintenance > Reset Defaults Initializes the non-volatile (NV) memory. After executing this setting and restarting the printer, all the menu parameters are reset to their default values. User Fax Section Initializes the fax number entries in the Address Book. User Scan Section Initializes the e-mail and server address entries in the Address Book. User Account Section Initializes the user registration information. User App Section Initializes the widget application information. System Section Initializes the system parameters. ❚ Admin Settings > Maintenance > Initialize Print Meter Initializes the print meter of the printer. When the print meter is initialized, the meter count is reset to zero. 116 Understanding the System Menus ❚ Admin Settings > Maintenance > Clear Stored Jobs NOTE: • The Clear Stored Jobs feature is available only when RAM Disk is set to On. Clears all files stored as Secure Print, Private Mail Box Print, Public Mail box Print, Proof Print, and Stored Print in the RAM disk. All Deletes all files stored as Secure Print, Private Mail Box Print, Public Mail Box Print, and Proof Print in the RAM disk. Secure Document Deletes all files stored as Secure Print in the RAM disk. Stored Document Deletes all files stored as Stored Print in the RAM disk. ❚ Admin Settings > Maintenance > Non-Dell Toner Specifies whether to enable the Non-Dell Toner feature, which uses toner cartridge of another manufacturer. CAUTION: • Using a non-Dell™ toner cartridge may severely damage the printer. The warranty does not cover damages caused by using non-Dell toner cartridges. ❚ Admin Settings > Maintenance > Adjust Altitude Specifies the altitude of the location where the printer is installed. The discharge phenomenon for charging the photo conductor varies with barometric pressure. Adjustments are performed by specifying the altitude of the location where the printer is being used. NOTE: • An incorrect altitude adjustment setting leads to poor printing quality, incorrect indication of remaining toner, etc. ❚ Admin Settings > Maintenance > Decrease Ghosting Reduces negative ghost. ❚ Admin Settings > Maintenance > Clear Job History Clears the job history of all finished jobs. ❚ Admin Settings > Maintenance > Fax Line Test NOTE: • The Fax Line Test feature is not available when the Fax function is disabled. Tests if the voltage supply from the fax line is sufficient. ❚ Admin Settings > Secure Settings Use the Secure Settings menu to set a password to limit access to the menus. This Understanding the System Menus 117 prevents items from being changed accidentally. ❚ Admin Settings > Secure Settings > Panel Lock Specifies whether to enable the Panel Lock feature, which sets a limited access to Admin Settings with a password, and to set or change the password. Panel Lock Control Change Password Sets password protection for Admin Settings. Sets or changes the four-digit password required to access Admin Settings. This item is available only when Panel Lock Control is set to Enable. ❚ Admin Settings > Secure Settings > Functions Control NOTE: • The Functions Control setting is available only when Panel Lock Control is set to Enable. Specifies whether to enable or disable each of the printer functions, or to restrict the use of a function with a password. For Copy and USB Direct Print, you can restrict just the color printing and color copying features with a password. Copy Enables or disables the Copy function. You can also restrict the function with a password by setting to On (Password) or On (Color Password). Scan to E-mail Enables or disables the Scan to E-mail feature. You can also restrict the feature with a password using On (Password). Fax Enables or disables the Fax function. You can also restrict the function with a password using On (Password). Fax Driver Enables or disables the Fax Driver function. Scan to Network Folder Enables or disables the Scan to Network Folder feature. Scan to Computer Enables or disables the Scan to Computer feature. PC Scan Enables or disables the PC Scan feature. You can also restrict the feature with a password using On (Password). You can also restrict the feature with a password using On(Password). You can also restrict the feature with a password using On (Password). Scan to USB Enables or disables the Scan to USB feature. You can also restrict the feature with a password using On (Password). USB Direct Print Enables or disables the USB Direct Print feature. You can also restrict the feature with a password using On (Password) or On (Color Password). ID Copy Enables or disables the ID Copy feature. USB Service 118 Show When Inserted Enables or disables this setting to show the USB Drive Detected screen when a USB memory is inserted in to the printer. Understanding the System Menus Automatic Doc Detected Menu Enables or disables this feature for the printer to detect document loaded in the DADF and show DADF related menus on the touch panel. Change Password* Changes the four-digit password that is set under the Functions Control menu. This item is available only when On (Password) or On (Color Password) is enabled. ❚ Admin Settings > Secure Settings > Desktop Authentication Specifies the Desktop Authentication method. NOTE: • Desktop Authentication is displayed on Dell S2825cdn only. Local Authentication Use the local authentication method. Remote Authentication Use the remote authentication method. ❚ Admin Settings > Secure Settings > Edit E-mail From Fields Specifies whether to enable the Edit E-mail From Fields feature, which enables editing of the transmission source when you use Scan to Email. ❚ Admin Settings > Secure Settings > Reconfirm Recipient Specifies whether to reconfirm the recipient before sending a fax or scan. NOTE: • If the Reconfirm Recipient menu is set to Reconfirm Recipient, recipients can only be selected from the phone book or the address book. You cannot directly enter an address or fax number. No Confirmation Does not display a screen to reconfirm the recipient before the job is actually sent. Reconfirm Recipient Displays a screen to reconfirm the recipient before the job is actually sent. ❚ Admin Settings > Secure Settings > Domain Filtering Specifies whether to enable the Domain Filtering feature, which sends e-mails to specified domains. NOTE: • Set the domains from SMTP Domain Filtering on the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool. ❚ Admin Settings > Secure Settings > Software Download Specifies whether to enable the Software Download feature, which enables download of firmware updates. ❚ Admin Settings > Secure Settings > Display of Network Information Shows or hides network information in the message field of the Home screen. Understanding the System Menus 119 Show IPv4 Address Show Host Name Hide Network Information ❚ Admin Settings > Secure Settings > Login Error NOTE: • Login Error feature is available only when Panel Lock Control is set to Enable. Specifies whether to enable the Login Error feature, which specifies the number of error entry attempts allowed when you log in as an administrator in Admin Settings and the Report / List menu. ❚ Admin Settings > Secure Settings > NFC Authentication Specifies whether to enable the NFC Authentication setting, which enables the authentication using the NFC authentication card. NOTE: • This is available on Dell H625cdw and Dell H825cdw. ❚ Admin Settings > USB Settings Use the USB Settings menu to change printer settings affecting a USB port. ❚ Admin Settings > USB Settings > USB Port NOTE: • USB Port setting is available only for the USB port on the rear of the printer. Specifies whether to enable the USB Port setting, which enables the USB Port. The change becomes effective after the printer is turned off and then on again. ❚ Admin Settings > USB Settings > PS Data Format Specifies PostScript Level3 Compatible communication protocol for a parallel interface. You can configure the PS Data Format settings for the wired network. The change becomes effective after the printer is turned off and then on again. Auto Used when auto-detecting the PostScript Level3 Compatible communication protocol. Standard Used when the communication protocol is in ASCII interface. BCP Used when the communication protocol is in binary format. TBCP Used when the communication protocol supports both ASCII and binary data to switch between them according to the specified control code. Binary Used when no special processing is required for data. 120 Understanding the System Menus ❚ Admin Settings > USB Settings > Job Time-out Specifies whether to enable the Job Time-out feature, which specifies the amount of time the printer waits for data to arrive from the computer. The print job is canceled if the time-out time is exceeded. Default Settings Use Default Settings menu to modify the Copy, Scan, or Fax menu defaults. To display the Default Settings menu, press the (Information) button, and then tap the Tools tab. ❚ Default Settings > Copy Defaults Modifies the Copy menu defaults. Copy Defaults allows you to configure the following items in addition to the items under the Copy menu. See "Copy." ❚ Default Settings > Copy Defaults > Auto Exposure Level Sets the default background suppression level to Normal/High/Highest. ❚ Default Settings > Copy Defaults > Color Balance Sets the color balance level of low/medium/high density for each color. ❚ Default Settings > Fax Defaults Modifies the Fax menu defaults. Fax Defaults allows you to configure the items under the Fax menu. See "Fax.” ❚ Default Settings > Scan Defaults Modifies the Scan menu defaults. Scan Defaults allows you to configure the following items in addition to the items under the Scan menu. See "Scan Settings." ❚ Default Settings > Scan Defaults > Auto Exposure Level Sets the default background suppression level. ❚ Default Settings > Scan Defaults > TIFF File Format Specifies the default TIFF file format to TIFF V6 or TTN2. ❚ Default Settings > Scan Defaults > Image Compression Sets the image compression level. Understanding the System Menus 121 ❚ Default Settings > Direct Print Defaults/USB Direct Print Defaults Modifies the defaults for the Direct Print Defaults/USB Direct Print Defaults menu. See "Print PDF/TIFF.” NOTE: • For Dell H625cdw and Dell H825cdw, Direct Print Defaults is displayed. For Dell S2825cdn, USB Direct Print Defaults is displayed. Tray Management Use the Tray Management menu to define the print media loaded in tray1 and the optional 550-sheet feeder. To display the Tray Management menu, press the (Information) button, and then tap the Tools tab. ❚ Tray Management > Tray Settings Configures tray settings. ❚ Tray Management > Tray Settings > MPF Specifies the paper loaded in the Multipurpose Feeder (MPF). Display Tray Prompt MPF Mode Select the checkbox to display a popup message that prompts to set paper type and paper size when paper is loaded in the MPF. The factory default is on (selected). Use Panel Settings Uses the paper size and type specified on the operator panel. Use Printer Driver Settings Uses the paper size and type specified on the print driver. Manual When the print job is started, the printer pauses the job and shows the screen to prompt the user to load the paper of the specified size and type. To continue the job, check that the specified paper is loaded, and then tap Continue in the screen on the touch panel. Size Specifies the paper size. Type Specifies the paper type. ❚ Tray Management > Tray Settings > Tray1 Specifies the paper loaded in tray1. Display Tray Prompt Select the checkbox to display a popup message that prompts to set Paper Type and Paper Size when paper is loaded in tray1. The factory default is on (selected). Size Specifies the paper size. Type Specifies the paper type. NOTE: • For details about supported paper sizes, see "Supported Print Media.” 122 Understanding the System Menus ❚ Tray Management > Tray Settings > Tray2 NOTE: • The Tray2 setting is available only when the optional 550-sheet feeder is installed. Specifies the paper loaded in the optional 550-sheet feeder. Display Tray Prompt Select the checkbox to display a popup message that prompts to set Paper Type and Paper Size when paper is loaded in the optional 550-sheet feeder. The factory default is on (selected). Size Sets whether to specify the paper size automatically or manually. Type Specifies the paper type. ❚ Tray Management > Tray Priority Sets the priority order of the paper trays for automatic tray selection. If paper trays loaded with the same paper size and type exists, the paper tray is selected according to this priority order. Language Settings Use the Language Settings menu to configure Panel Language, or Keyboard Layout. To display the Language Settings menu, press the (Information) button, and then tap the Tools tab. ❚ Language Settings > Panel Language Determines the language of the text on the touch panel. ❚ Language Settings > Keyboard Layout Selects the keyboard layout on the touch panel. Resetting Defaults After executing this setting and restarting the printer, the phone book, address book, or menu parameters are reset to their default values. The following menu parameters are exceptions and are not reset. • Network settings • Panel Lock settings and password • Functions Control settings for Copy, Scan to E-mail, Fax, Scan to Network Folder, Scan to Computer, PC Scan, Scan to USB, USB Direct Print and saved passwords • Secure Receive settings and saved password • Login Error settings • Set Available Time settings • Secure Job Expiration settings • USB Port settings Understanding the System Menus 123 • ColorTrack Mode settings • ColorTrack Error Report settings • Non Registered User settings • NFC Authentication settings • Tap to Print settings To reset the settings, perform the following procedure: 1 Press the (Information) button. 2 Tap the Tools tab Admin Settings Maintenance. If Panel Lock Control is set to Enable, enter the password. See "Panel Lock." 3 Tap until Reset Defaults appears, and then tap Reset Defaults. 4 Tap the desired setting, and then tap Initialize. User Fax Section Resets the phone book data. User Scan Section Resets the address book data. User Account Section Resets the user registration information. User App Section Resets the widget application information. System Section Resets the system parameters. 5 Tap Yes, Reset. The printer restarts. 124 Understanding the System Menus Understanding the Job Menus Print Use the Print menus to configure various settings for the Secure Print, Private Mail Box Print, Public Mail Box Print, and Proof Print features. To display the Print job menu, press the (Home) button, tap , and then select the Print tile. ❚ Print > Secure Print NOTE: • Secure Print feature is available only when RAM Disk is set to On. Specifies whether and how to print the job stored as the Secure Print. Select User ID Enters the password you specified on the print driver. Select a Job Selects a job to print. Select All Selects all the documents stored for this User ID. Print and Delete Prints the selected job, and then deletes the document from print memory. Delete Deletes the specified document from print memory. ❚ Print > Private Mailbox NOTE: • Private Mailbox feature is available only when RAM Disk is set to On. Specifies whether and how to print the job stored as the Private Mailbox. Select User ID Enters the password you specified on the print driver. Select a Job Selects a job to print. Select All Selects all the documents stored for this User ID. Quantity Specifies the quantity of printout. Use Driver Settings Print Sets the quantity of prints specified on the print driver. Prints the selected job. Print and Delete Deletes the document after it is printed. Delete Deletes the specified document from print memory. ❚ Print > Public Mailbox NOTE: • Public Mailbox feature is available only when RAM Disk is set to On. Specifies whether and how to print the job stored as the Public Mailbox. Select User ID Enters the password you specified on the print driver. Select a Job Selects a job to print. Understanding the Job Menus 125 Select All Selects all the documents stored for this User ID. Quantity Specifies the quantity of printout. Use Driver Settings Print Sets the quantity of prints specified on the print driver. Prints the selected job. Print and Delete Deletes the document after it is printed. Delete Deletes the specified document from print memory. ❚ Print > Proof Print NOTE: • Proof Print feature is available only when RAM Disk is set to On. Specifies whether and how to print the job stored as the Proof Print. Select User ID Enters the password you specified on the print driver. Select a Job Selects a job to print. Select All Selects all the documents stored for this User ID. Quantity Specifies the quantity of printout. Use Driver Settings Print Sets the quantity of prints specified on the print driver. Prints the selected job. Print and Delete Deletes the document after it is printed. Delete Deletes the specified document from print memory. ❚ Print > Secure Fax Receive Prints confidential faxes. The printer can hold the job in memory until you arrive at the printer and type the password on the operator panel. ❚ Print > Tile Settings Use the tile settings to create and edit custom tile for the Print menus. Copy Use the Copy menus to configure various settings for the copy function. To display the Copy job menu, press the (Home) button, tap , and then select the Copy tile. ❚ Copy > Quantity Specifies the number of copies from 1 to 99. ❚ Copy > Darken/Lighten Makes the copy darker or lighter. 126 Understanding the Job Menus ❚ Copy > Output Color Selects color or black and white copying. ❚ Copy > Select Tray Specifies the input tray. The paper is fed from the Multipurpose Feeder (MPF). When Use Printer Driver Settings is set in MPF Configuration of Tray Settings, Any is displayed for Size and Type. If you start the copy job with Any as the paper size and type, A4 or Letter is selected as the paper size and plain is selected as the paper type. If you want to specify the size and type of paper in the MPF, select MPF and specify the paper size and type. MPF Paper Size Specifies the paper size. Paper Type Specifies the paper type. Tray1 Tray2* This item is available only when the optional 550-sheet feeder is installed. ❚ Copy > 2 Sided Copying Specifies whether to make duplex copy and select the binding position. 1 Sided Copies one-sided documents into one-sided printouts. 2 Sided Copies one-sided documents into two-sided printouts. You can specify whether the printout is bound by the long edge or short edge. 1 Sided Copies two-sided documents into one-sided printouts. Before starting the copy, you need to specify whether the document is bound by the long edge or short edge. 2 Sided Copies two-sided documents into two-sided printouts. Before starting the copy, you need to specify whether the document is bound by the long edge or short edge. ❚ Copy > Sharpness Adjusts the sharpness to make the copy sharper or softer. ❚ Copy > Reduce/Enlarge Reduces or enlarges the size of a copied image. You can also enter a custom ratio. ❚ Copy > Original Size Specifies the default document size. NOTE: • When Auto is selected, the printer assumes that the document size is the size of the print media loaded in tray1 or the MPF. Understanding the Job Menus 127 ❚ Copy > Original Type Improves the image quality by selecting the type of the document. ❚ Copy > Collation Specifies whether to sort the copy job. For example, if you make two copies of three-page document, one complete set of three-page document is printed one by one. You can also automatically sort a copy job only when you use the Duplex Automatic Document Feeder (DADF). ❚ Copy > 2-Up Prints every two pages of documents to fit onto one sheet of paper. Off Auto Automatically reduces to fit onto one sheet of paper. Manual Specify the reduce/enlarge ratio in Reduce/Enlarge. ❚ Copy > Color Saturation Adjusts the amount of colors to make the colors darker or lighter. ❚ Copy > Margin Specifies the top, bottom, right, left, and middle margins of the copy. ❚ Copy > Auto Exposure Specifies whether to enable the Auto Exposure feature, which suppresses the background of the original to enhance text on the copy. ❚ Copy > Save Settings Use the save settings to save a variety of copy features. And also use to create and edit custom tiles for copying. ID Copy Use the ID Copy menus to configure various settings for ID Copy features. To display the ID Copy job menu, press the (Home) button, tap , and then select the ID Copy tile. 128 Understanding the Job Menus Quantity See "Copy." Darken/Lighten Output Color Select Tray Sharpness Color Saturation Auto Exposure Reduce/Enlarge ❚ ID Copy > Save Settings Use the save settings to save various settings for ID Copy features. And also use to create and edit custom tiles for ID Copy. Scan to Email Use the Scan to Email menus to use the e-mail to send the scanned data. See "Scan Settings." To display the Scan to Email job menu, press the (Home) button, tap , and then select the Scan to Email tile. Enter Recipient's Address Address Book Sender Enters the e-mail address of the recipient using the keyboard. Individuals Selects an e-mail address from the local address book. Groups Selects an e-mail group from the local address book. Network Address Book Searches an e-mail address from the server address book. Keyboard Enters the e-mail address of the sender using the keyboard. Address Book Selects an e-mail address of the sender from the local address book. Network Address Book Searches an e-mail address of the sender from the server address book. Scan to Network Folder Use the Scan to Network Folder menus to store the scanned data on a network server or a computer. See "Scan Settings." To display the Scan to Network job menu, press the (Home) button, tap , and then select the Scan to Network tile. Address Book Selects an FTP address or Server Message Block (SMB) protocol address from the local address book. Scan to USB Use the Scan to USB menus to save the scanned data to a USB flash drive attached to the printer. See "Scan Settings." To display the Scan to USB job menu, press the (Home) button, tap , and then select the Scan to USB tile. Folder Name Selects which folder the scanned data is saved to. Understanding the Job Menus 129 Scan to Computer Use the Scan to Computer to save scanned data on a computer. To display the Scan to Computer job menu, press the (Home) button, tap and then select the Scan to Computer tile. NOTE: • This feature is available when the operating system of the client computer is Windows Vista® SP2 or later, Windows® 7, Windows® 8, Windows® 8.1, or Windows® 10. Computer (via USB) Saves scanned data on a computer connected via USB cable. Computer Name Selects which computer the scanned data is saved to. Up to 20 computers can be listed. Scan Scan for Print Scan for Email Sends the scanned data to the computer according to the chosen event. The program associated with depends on the setting on the computer. Scan for Fax Scan for OCR ❚ Scan to Computer > Tile Settings Use the tile settings to create and edit custom tiles for Scan to Computer. ❚ Scan to Email / Scan to Network Folder / Scan to USB / Scan to Computer > Scan Settings NOTE: • The scan settings are common for Scan to Email, Scan to Network Folder, Scan to USB, and Scan to Computer features. ❚ Scan to Email / Scan to Network Folder / Scan to USB / Scan to Computer > Scan Settings > Output Color Selects color or black and white scanning. Color Black & White Works well for documents with texts. Gray Scale Works well for documents with texts and photos. ❚ Scan to Email / Scan to Network Folder / Scan to USB / Scan to Computer > Scan Settings > Resolution Specifies the resolution of the scanned data. ❚ Scan to Email / Scan to Network Folder / Scan to USB / Scan to Computer > Scan Settings > File Format Specifies the file format to save the scanned data. ❚ Scan to Email / Scan to Network Folder / Scan to USB / Scan to Computer > Scan Settings > 2 Sided Scanning Specifies whether to scan one side or both sides of a document. For a two-sided document, specify whether the document is bound by the long edge or short edge. 130 Understanding the Job Menus ❚ Scan to Email / Scan to Network Folder / Scan to USB / Scan to Computer > Scan Settings > Darken/Lighten Adjusts the density to make the scanned data darker or lighter. ❚ Scan to Email / Scan to Network Folder / Scan to USB / Scan to Computer > Scan Settings > Contrast Adjusts the contrast of scanned data. Higher contrast makes the colors darker and lower contrast makes the colors lighter than the original. ❚ Scan to Email / Scan to Network Folder / Scan to USB / Scan to Computer > Scan Settings > Sharpness Adjusts the sharpness to make the scanned data sharper or softer. ❚ Scan to Email / Scan to Network Folder / Scan to USB / Scan to Computer > Scan Settings > Auto Exposure Specifies whether to enable the Auto Exposure feature, which suppresses the background of the original to enhance text on the scanned data. ❚ Scan to Email / Scan to Network Folder / Scan to USB / Scan to Computer > Scan Settings > Original Size Specifies the default paper size. ❚ Scan to Email / Scan to Network Folder / Scan to USB / Scan to Computer > Scan Settings > Margin Specifies the top, bottom, right, left, and middle margins of the scanned data. ❚ Scan to Email / Scan to Network Folder / Scan to USB / Scan to Computer > Scan Settings > Create Folder NOTE: • Create Folder feature is available only for Scan to USB or Scan to Network Folder. Specifies whether to enable the Create Folder feature, which creates a folder when saving scanned data. ❚ Scan to Email / Scan to Network Folder / Scan to USB / Scan to Computer > Scan Settings > File Naming Mode Specifies the detailed setting of File Naming Mode. Auto Sets the default file name. Add Prefix Adds texts in front of the file name. Prefix/Suffix String Add Suffix Specifies the texts that are added when Add Prefix is selected. Adds texts after the file name. Prefix/Suffix String Specifies the texts that are added when Add Suffix is selected. Understanding the Job Menus 131 ❚ Scan to Email / Scan to Network Folder / Scan to USB / Scan to Computer > Save Settings Use the save settings to save various settings for the scan function when using Scan to Email, Scan to USB, Scan to Network Folder, or Scan to Computer. And also use to create and edit custom tiles for scanning. Fax Use the Fax menus to configure various settings for the fax function. To display the Fax job menu, press the (Home) button, tap , and then select the Fax tile. NOTE: • The Fax function cannot be used unless you set up a country code under Country. If Country is not set up, a message Set the Country Code appears on the touch panel. Enter Number Enters the fax number using the keyboard. Speed Dial Enters the speed dial number stored in the printer. Phone Book Individuals Selects a fax number from the local address book. Groups Selects a group dial number from the local address book. Network Phone Searches a fax number from the server address book. Book On Hook Send Sends faxes manually. Receive Receives faxes manually. Polling Manually retrieves information from a remote machine. ❚ Fax > Fax Settings Use the fax settings to configure various settings for the fax function. ❚ Fax > Fax Settings > Darken/Lighten Adjusts the density to make the fax darker or lighter. ❚ Fax > Fax Settings > 2 Sided Scanning Specifies whether to scan one side or both sides of a document. For a two-sided document, specify whether the document is bound by the long edge or short edge. ❚ Fax > Fax Settings > Polling Receive Specifies whether to enable the Polling Receive feature, which retrieves faxes from the remote fax machine when you want to receive it. ❚ Fax > Fax Settings > Resolution Specifies the scan resolution to improve the output quality. Standard 132 Suitable for documents with normal sized characters. Understanding the Job Menus Fine Suitable for documents containing small characters or thin lines or documents printed using a dot-matrix printer. Super Fine Suitable for documents containing extremely fine detail. The Super Fine mode is enabled only if the remote machine also supports the Super Fine mode. See the following note. Photo Suitable for documents containing photographic images. NOTE: • Data scanned in the Super Fine mode is transmitted at the highest resolution supported by the remote machine. ❚ Fax > Fax Settings > Fax Cover Page Specifies whether to enable the Fax Cover Page feature, which attaches a cover page to faxes. ❚ Fax > Fax Settings > Delayed Send Specifies whether to enable the Delayed Send feature, which sends a fax at a later time. NOTE: • A maximum of 19 delayed fax jobs can be stored. ❚ Fax > Fax Settings > Save Settings Use the save settings to save various settings for the fax function. And also use to create and edit custom tiles for faxing. NOTE: • Up to 30 addresses can be stored on the printer. Print PDF/TIFF NOTE: • Print PDF/TIFF feature is available only when a USB flash drive is inserted in the front USB port. Use the Print PDF/TIFF menus to specify the document stored in the root, file, or folder in a USB flash drive. See "Print Settings." To display the Print PDF/TIFF job menu, press the (Home) button, tap , and then select the Print PDF/TIFF tile. Print JPEG NOTE: • Print JPEG feature is available only when a USB flash drive is inserted in the front USB port. Use the Print JPEG menus to specify the photos stored in the root, file, or folder in a USB flash drive. See "Print Settings." To display the Print JPEG job menu, press the (Home) button, tap , and then select the Print JPEG tile. Understanding the Job Menus 133 ❚ Print PDF/TIFF / Print JPEG > Print Settings Use the print settings to configure various settings for the print function when using Print PDF/TIFF, Print JPEG. ❚ Print PDF/TIFF / Print JPEG > Print Settings > Quantity Specifies the number of copies from 1 to 99. ❚ Print PDF/TIFF / Print JPEG > Print Settings > Output Color Selects color or black and white printing. ❚ Print PDF/TIFF / Print JPEG > Print Settings > Select Tray Specifies the input tray. The paper is fed from the Multipurpose Feeder (MPF). When Use Printer Driver Settings is set in MPF Configuration of Tray Settings, Any is displayed for Size and Type. If you start the print job with Any as the paper size and type, A4 or Letter is selected as the paper size and plain is selected as the paper type. If you want to specify the size and type of paper in the MPF, select MPF and specify the paper size and type. MPF Size Specifies the paper size. Tray1 Tray2* This item is available only when the optional 550-sheet feeder is installed. ❚ Print PDF/TIFF / Print JPEG > Print Settings > 2 Sided Printing Specifies whether to print on one side or both sides of a sheet of print media. For a two-sided printing, you can specify the printout to be bound by the long edge or short edge. ❚ Print PDF/TIFF / Print JPEG > Print Settings > Layout Specifies the output layout. Select whether to print one, two, or four pages on one side of a sheet of print media. If you select Off(No Scaling), the parts that do not fit are not printed (print size is not adjusted automatically). ❚ Print PDF/TIFF / Print JPEG > Print Settings > Image Types Sets the print image quality. Auto Prints PDF/TIFF files in the Text mode and JPEG files in the Photos (Standard Quality) mode. Photos (Standard Quality) Prints the photographic images at the standard quality. Photos (High Quality) Prints the photographic images at the high quality. 134 Understanding the Job Menus Text Prints the text document at the standard quality. ❚ Print PDF/TIFF / Print JPEG > Print Settings > Collation Specifies whether to sort the job. ❚ Print PDF/TIFF > Print Settings > PDF Password Enters the password when you print a PDF file secured with password to open the PDF file. ❚ Print PDF/TIFF / Print JPEG > Save Settings Use the save settings to save a variety of USB Direct Print features. And also use to create and edit custom tiles for USB Direct Print. Dell Document Hub Use the Dell Document Hub menus to configure various settings for Dell Document Hub. To display the Dell Document Hub job menu, press the (Home) button, and then tap the Dell Document Hub tile. NOTE: • Dell Document Hub is available on Dell H625cdw and Dell H825cdw. ❚ Dell Document Hub > Search for Files Searches the files saved in the cloud services, and print them from the printer. Text Box Enters the keywords, such as the words including the file name. Sorts the searching results by selecting the sorting order. Sets the settings of the Print Settings. Displays the selected files. The first three pages of each file are displayed in the small previews. ❚ Dell Document Hub > Browse for Files Browses and prints the files saved in the selected cloud services. Text Box Enters the keywords, such as the words including the file name. Searches for the files in the current location or the selected cloud services. Sets the settings of the Print Settings. Displays the selected files. The first three pages of each file are displayed in the small previews. Sorts the searching results by selecting the sorting order. Saves the settings of the Print Settings as Favorite. Understanding the Job Menus 135 ❚ Dell Document Hub > Scan Scans the document and saves the scanned data in the cloud service. File Name Enters the file name you want to use. File Format Selects the file format from the list to save the scanned data. Tag Enters the tag you want to use. Searches for the location to save the scanned data. You can search for the location across the cloud services. Sets the settings of the Scan Settings. Sorts the searching results by selecting the sorting order. Saves the settings of the Scan Settings as Favorite. ❚ Dell Document Hub > Scan > PDF Password Enters the password when you print a PDF file secured with password to open the PDF file. ❚ Dell Document Hub > Scan > File Name Option Specifies the way to name the scanned data. Off Add Prefix Adds texts in front of the file name. Prefix/Suffix String Add Suffix Specifies the texts that are added when Add Prefix is selected. Adds texts after the file name. Prefix/Suffix String Specifies the texts that are added when Add Suffix is selected. For details about other settings, see "Scan Settings." ❚ Dell Document Hub > Smart OCR Scan Scans the document using Optical Character Recognition (OCR) and saves it in the cloud service. File Name Enters the file name you want to use. File Format Selects the file format from the list to save the scanned data. Tag Enters the tag you want to use. Searches for the location to save the scanned data. You can search for the location across the cloud services. Sets the settings of the Scan Settings. Saves the settings of the Scan Settings as Favorite. ❚ Dell Document Hub > Smart OCR Scan > File Format Specifies the file format to save the scanned data. 136 Understanding the Job Menus ❚ Dell Document Hub > Smart OCR Scan > OCR Language Specifies the language for the OCR. ❚ Dell Document Hub > Smart OCR Scan > PDF Password Enters the password when you print a PDF file secured with password to open the PDF file. ❚ Dell Document Hub > Smart OCR Scan > Blank Page Removable Specifies whether to enable the Blank Page Removable feature, which removes the blank pages. ❚ Dell Document Hub > Smart OCR Scan > Image Enhancement Sets whether to enable the Image Enhancement feature. ❚ Dell Document Hub > Smart OCR Scan > File Name Option Specifies the way to name the scanned data. Off Add Prefix Adds texts in front of the file name. Prefix/Suffix String Add Suffix Specifies the texts that are added when Add Prefix is selected. Adds texts after the file name. Prefix/Suffix String Specifies the texts that are added when Add Suffix is selected. For details about other settings, see "Scan Settings." ❚ Dell Document Hub > E-mail Me Scans the document and send to you as an attached file of an e-mail. File Format Selects the file format from the list to save the scanned data. Subject Enters the subject you want to use. Sets the settings of the Scan Settings. Saves the settings of the Scan Settings as Favorite. ❚ Dell Document Hub > E-mail Me > File Format Specifies the file format to save the scanned data. ❚ Dell Document Hub > E-mail Me > OCR Language Specifies the language for the OCR. Understanding the Job Menus 137 ❚ Dell Document Hub > E-mail Me > PDF Password Enters the password when you print a PDF file secured with password to open the PDF file. ❚ Dell Document Hub > E-mail Me > Black Page Removable Specifies whether to enable the Black Page Removable feature, which removes the blank pages. For details about other settings, see "Scan Settings." ❚ Dell Document Hub > Business Card Reader Scans the business card and send vCard format data to you as an attached file of an e-mail. Subject Enters the subject you want to use. Sets the settings of the Scan Settings. Saves the settings of the Scan Settings as Favorite. ❚ Dell Document Hub > Business Card Reader > File Format Specifies the file format to save the scanned data. ❚ Dell Document Hub > Business Card Reader > OCR Language Specifies the language for the OCR. Add App Use the Add App menus to add a variety of tiles on the Home screen. 138 Understanding the Job Menus Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool Use the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool to monitor the status of your network printer without leaving your desk. You can view and/or change the printer settings, monitor toner level, and acknowledge the timing of ordering replacement consumables. If you are a network administrator, you can copy the printer settings to one or all printers on the network using your web browser. NOTE: • This web tool is available only when the printer is connected to a network. Preparing to Use the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool Make sure that you activate JavaScript in your browser before using the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool. Perform the following procedure to configure both the environment settings of your web browser and the operator panel before using the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool. NOTE: • The Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool pages may be displayed with unreadable characters if the pages were configured by the language different from the language of your web browser. Setting Up Internet Explorer® Setting Up the Display Language 1 Select Internet Options from Tools on the menu bar. 2 Select Languages in the General tab. 3 Specify the display language in order of preference in the Language list. Setting the IP Address of the Printer to Non-Proxy 1 Select Internet Options from Tools on the menu bar. 2 Click LAN Settings under Local Area Network (LAN) Settings in the Connections tab. 3 Perform either of the following: • • Clear the Use a proxy server for your LAN check box under Proxy server. Click Advanced, and then specify the IP address of the printer in the Do not use proxy server for addresses beginning with text box under Exceptions. Confirming the Menu on the Operator Panel You can start the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool only when Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool is set to Enable on the operator panel. Check the operator panel setting if you cannot start the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool. See "Protocols." Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool 139 Starting the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool To start the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool, enter the IP address of the printer in your web browser. If you do not know the IP address of the printer, verify the IP address by using the operator panel, printing the system settings report, or using the ping command. See "Verifying the IP Settings." Page Display Format Top Frame The top frame is located at the top of all pages. When the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool is activated, the current status and specifications of the printer are displayed in the top frame on every page. 2 34 Model Name Displays the model name of the printer. IPv4 Displays the IP address of the printer. IPv6 Location Displays location of the printer. The location can be changed in the Basic Information section on the Print Server Settings page. Contact Person Displays the name of the printer administrator. The name can be changed in the Basic Information section on the Print Server Settings page. Event Panel Displays the indicator for the condition of the printer. Machine image Shows the bitmap image of the printer. The Printer Status menu appears in the right frame when you click on the image. 140 Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool Left Frame The left frame is located on the left side of all the pages. The menu titles displayed in the left frame are linked to corresponding menus and pages. You can proceed to the corresponding page by clicking their characters. 10 11 12 13 14 15 Printer Status Provides immediate feedback on the printer supply status. When a toner cartridge is running low, click the order supplies link on the first screen to order a new toner cartridge. Printer Jobs Contains information on the details of the status regarding each protocol or job. Printer Settings Displays the printer settings of the operator panel to configure the settings from the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool. Print Server Settings Configures the type of printer interface and the necessary conditions for communications. Copy Printer Settings Copies the printer settings to another printer or printers on the network. NOTE: • You must log in as an administrator to use this setting. Print Volume Displays the printing history such as paper usage and restrictions of color mode usage. Address Book Displays or edits the e-mail address, server address, and fax number entries in the Address Book, or registers new entries. NOTE: • You must log in as an administrator to use this setting. Printer Information Provides information on service calls, inventory reports, or the status of current memory and engine code levels. Tray Management Provides information about the paper type and size for each tray. 10 E-Mail Server Settings Overview Opens the E-Mail Server menu in the Printer Server Settings menu to configure E-Mail Server settings for Scan to Email, e-mail alert and forwarding fax to email features. Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool 141 11 Set Password Locks the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool with a password so that the printer settings are not changed inadvertently. NOTE: • You must log in as an administrator to use this setting. 12 Online Help Links to the Dell Support website. 13 Order Supplies at: Links to the Dell website for ordering supplies. 14 Contact Dell Support at: 15 Dell Document Hub at: Links to the Dell Support website. Links to the Dell Document Hub website. This is available on Dell H625cdw and Dell H825cdw. Right Frame The right frame is located on the right side of all the pages. The contents of the right frame correspond to the menu that you select in the left frame. See "Details of the Menu Items." Buttons in the Right Frame 1 Refresh Button Receives the current printer configuration and updates the latest information in the right frame. 2 Apply New Settings Button Submits new settings made on the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool to the printer. The new settings replace the old settings of the printer. 3 Restore Settings Button Restores the old settings that existed before any changes were made. New settings are not submitted to the printer. Changing the Settings of the Menu Items Some menus allow you to change the printer settings through the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool. When you access these menus, the authentication window appears on the screen. Enter a user name and password for the printer administrator by 142 Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool following the prompts displayed in the dialog box. The default user name is admin, and the default password is left blank (NULL). You can change only the password in the Set Password page in the Security menu. The user name cannot be changed. See "Set Password." Details of the Menu Items Left Frame Tab Menu Item "Printer Status" "Printer Status" "Printer Status" "Printer Events" "Printer Information" "Printer Jobs" "Printer Jobs" "Job List" "Completed Jobs" "Printer Settings" "Printer Settings Report" "Menu Settings" "Reports" "Printer Settings" "System Settings" "Network Settings" "USB Settings" "PCL Settings" "PS Settings" "PDF Settings" "Secure Settings" "Copy Defaults" "Copy Color Balance" "Copy Settings" "Fax Defaults" "Fax Settings" "Scan Defaults" "Direct Print Defaults / USB Direct Print Defaults" "MIFARE Customized Card" "Printer Maintenance" "Paper Density" "Adjust Transfer Belt Unit" "Adjust 2nd BTR" "Adjust Fusing Unit" "Color Registration Adjustments" “Clean Developer” "Reset Defaults" "Initialize Print Meter" "Clear Stored Jobs"*1 "Non-Dell Toner" "Adjust Altitude" "Decrease Ghosting" "Clock Settings" "Web Link Customization" "Print Server Settings" "Print Server Reports" "Print Server Setup Page" Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool 143 Left Frame Tab Menu Item "E-Mail Server Setup Page" "Print Server Settings" "Basic Information" "Port Settings" "TCP/IP" "SMB" "E-Mail Server" "Bonjour (mDNS)" "SNMP" "Scan to Network Folder" "SNTP" "AirPrint" "Mopria" “Google Cloud Print” "Dell Document Hub"*5 "Proxy Server" "Wi-Fi"*2 "Wi-Fi Direct"*4 "Reset Print Server" "Security" "Set Password" "Authentication System" "Kerberos Server" "LDAP Server" "LDAP Authentication" "LDAP User Mapping" "SSL/TLS" "IPsec" "802.1x"*3 "IP Filter" "SMTP Domain Filtering" "Copy Printer Settings" "Copy Printer Settings" "Copy Printer Settings" "Copy Printer Settings Report" "Print Volume" "Print Volume" "Print Volume" "Dell ColorTrack" "Address Book" "E-Mail Address" "E-Mail Address" "E-Mail Group" "Default Setup" "Server Address" "Server Address" "Phone Book" "FAX Speed Dial" "FAX Group" "Tray Management" *1 *2 *3 "Tray Management" This item is available only when RAM Disk is enabled. This item is available only when the printer is connected using the wireless network. Wireless network is available on Dell H625cdw and Dell H825cdw. This item is available only when the printer is connected using an Ethernet cable. 144 Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool *4 *5 Wi-Fi Direct is available on Dell H625cdw and Dell H825cdw. Dell Document Hub is available on Dell H625cdw and Dell H825cdw. Printer Status Use the Printer Status menu to check the status of consumables, hardware, and specifications of the printer. Printer Status The Printer Status tab includes the Printer Status, Printer Events and Printer Information pages. Printer Status Displays the status of the consumables, trays, and covers. Cyan Toner Cartridge Indicates whether the toner, drum cartridge and/or waste toner box is OK for use, or the toner, drum cartridge and/or waste toner box needs to be replaced soon or now. Magenta Toner Cartridge Yellow Toner Cartridge Black Toner Cartridge Consumables Cyan Drum Cartridge Magenta Drum Cartridge Yellow Drum Cartridge Black Drum Cartridge Waste Toner Box Paper Trays Output Tray Cover Printer Type Status OK Indicates that there is some paper in the tray but the quantity is unknown. Add Paper Indicates that there is no paper in the tray. Capacity Displays the maximum capacity of the paper tray. Size Displays the size of paper in the tray. Status Indicates that the tray is available when OK is displayed. Capacity Displays the maximum capacity of the paper tray. Status Indicates whether the cover is closed or open. Color Laser is displayed normally. Printing Speed Printer Events When faults occur, the details of all alerts or indications of faults are displayed in the Printer Events page. Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool 145 Printer Information Displays the printer details such as the hardware version and Service Tag Number. This page can also be displayed by clicking Printer Information in the left frame. Printer Jobs The Printer Jobs menu contains information on the Job List and Completed Jobs pages. These pages show the details of the status regarding each protocol or job. Printer Jobs The Printer Jobs tab includes the Job List and Completed Jobs pages. Job List Displays the jobs that are being processed. Click the Refresh button to update the screen. ID Displays the job ID. Job Name Displays the file name of the job being processed. Owner Displays the name of the job owner. Host Name Displays the name of the host computer. Job Status Job Type Host I/F Displays the status of the host interface. Job Submitted Time Displays the date when the job was submitted. Completed Jobs Displays the completed jobs. Up to the last 20 jobs are displayed. Click the Refresh button to update the screen. Clear Job History Deletes job history. ID Displays the job ID. Job Name Displays the file name of the completed job. Owner Displays the name of the job owner. Host Name Displays the name of the host computer. Output Result Displays the status of the completed job. Job Type Impression Number Displays the total number of pages for the job. No. of Sheets Displays the total number of sheets for the job. Host I/F Displays the status of the host interface. Job Submitted Time Displays the date when the job was submitted. Printer Settings Use the Printer Settings menu to display the Printer Settings Report, Printer Settings, and Printer Maintenance tabs and to configure the printer settings. Printer Settings Report The Printer Settings Report tab includes the Menu Settings and Reports pages. 146 Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool Menu Settings Displays the current settings of the printer menus. Reports Prints various types of reports and lists. Click Start to print each report. System Settings Panel Settings PCL Fonts List PCL Macros List PS Fonts List PDF Fonts List Job History Error History Print Meter Color Test Page Protocol Monitor Speed Dial Address Book Server Address Fax Activity Fax Pending Stored Documents* This item is available only when RAM Disk is enabled. Printer Settings The Printer Settings tab includes System Settings, Network Settings, USB Settings, PCL Settings, PS Settings, PDF Settings, Secure Settings, Copy Defaults, Copy Color Balance, Copy Settings, Fax Defaults, Fax Settings, Scan Defaults, Direct Print Defaults/USB Direct Print Defaults, and MIFARE Customized Card pages. System Settings Configures the basic printer settings. Power Saver Time - Sleep Sets the time taken by the printer to enter Sleep mode after it finishes a job. Power Saver Time - Deep Sleep Sets the time taken by the printer to enter Deep Sleep mode after it has entered Sleep mode. Power Saver Time - Power Off Timer*1 Sets the time taken by the printer to enter Power Off mode after it has entered Deep Sleep mode. mm / inch Sets the measurement unit to be used on the touch panel as either mm or inches. Screen Brightness Sets the brightness level of the touch panel. Control Panel Tone Sets the volume of the tone that is emitted when the operator panel input is correct, or disables the tone. Invalid Key Tone Sets the volume of the tone that is emitted when the operator panel input is incorrect, or disables the tone. Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool 147 Machine Ready Tone Sets the volume of the tone that is emitted when the printer becomes ready, or disables the tone. Copy Completed Tone Sets the volume of the tone that is emitted when a copy job is complete, or disables the tone. Job Completed Tone Sets the volume of the tone that is emitted when a job other than a copy job is complete, or disables the tone. Fault Tone Sets the volume of the tone that is emitted when a job ends abnormally, or disables the tone. Alert Tone Sets the volume of the tone that is emitted when a problem occurs, or disables the tone. Out of Paper Tone Sets the volume of the tone that is emitted when the printer runs out of paper, or disables the tone. Low Toner Alert Tone Sets the volume of the tone that is emitted when the toner is low, or disables the tone. Auto Clear Alert Tone Sets the volume of the tone that is emitted 5 seconds before the printer performs auto clear, or disables the tone. NFC Authentication Tone*1 Sets the volume of the tone that is emitted when an NFC card is placed on the NFC reader for authentication, or disables the tone. All Tones Sets the volume of all the alert tones, or disables all the tones. Low Toner Alert Message Alerts you if the toner is low. OffHook Wake Up Sets whether to wake up from Sleep or Deep Sleep mode when you pick up the handset of the external telephone. Auto Log Print Sets if a job history needs to be printed after every 20 jobs. RAM Disk Sets whether to allocate RAM for the file system for the Secure Print, Proof Print, Private Mail Box Print, and Public Mail Box Print features. Panel Language Used to set the language on the touch panel. Max E-mail Size Sets the maximum size of e-mail that can be sent. Auto Reset Sets the amount of time before the printer automatically resets its settings to the defaults when no additional settings are made. Fault Time-out Sets the amount of time the printer waits before canceling a job that stops abnormally. Default Paper Size Sets the default print paper size. Print ID Sets where to print the user ID on the output paper. Print Text Sets whether the printer outputs Page Description Language (PDL) data which is not supported by the printer as text when the printer receives it. Banner Sheet Insert Position Sets where to insert a banner sheet in the output. Banner Sheet Specify Tray Sets from which tray a banner sheet is fed. Substitute Tray Sets whether to use another size paper when the paper that is loaded in the specified tray does not match the paper size settings for the current job. Letterhead 2 Sided Sets whether to print on both sides of letterhead. A4<>Letter Switch Sets whether to print A4 size jobs on Letter size paper if A4 is not available in the paper trays and vice versa. A5<>Statement Switch Sets whether to print A5 size jobs on Statement size paper if A5 is not available in the paper trays and vice versa. Report 2 Sided Print Sets whether to print reports on both sides a sheet of paper. Use Another Tray Sets whether to show a message to select another tray when the specified paper is not available in the paper tray. 148 Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool Resume Printing After Jam Recovery*2 Sets whether to delete print job after recovering from paper jam. Tap To Print Sets whether to add the printer to a mobile device such as a tablet or a notebook computer by tapping the device to the (NFC) reader. *1 *2 This is available on Dell H625cdw and Dell H825cdw. This setting does not affect fax job. Network Settings Specifies the PostScript Level3 Compatible communication protocol for the printer. PS Data Format Sets PostScript Level3 Compatible communication protocol for each interface. USB Settings Specifies USB settings of the printer. USB Port Sets whether to enable the USB interface on the printer. PS Data Format Sets PostScript Level3 Compatible communication protocol for each interface. Job Time-out Sets the amount of time the printer waits for data to arrive from the computer. PCL Settings Specifies the Printer Control Language (PCL) settings. Paper Tray Sets the paper input tray. Paper Size Sets the paper size. Custom Paper Size - Y Sets the length of custom size paper. Custom Paper Size - X Sets the width of custom size paper. Orientation Sets how text and graphics are oriented on the page. 2 Sided Print Sets duplex setting as the default for all print jobs. Font Sets the font from the list of registered fonts. Symbol Set Sets a symbol set for the specified font. Font Size Sets the font size for scalable typographic fonts. Font Pitch Sets the font pitch for scalable mono spaced fonts. Form Line Sets the number of lines in a page. Quantity Sets the number of copies to print. Image Enhance Sets whether to enable the Image Enhancement feature. Hex Dump Sets whether to help isolate the source of a print job problem. With Hex Dump selected, all data sent to the printer is printed in hexadecimal and character representation. Control codes are not executed. Draft Mode Sets whether to print in the draft mode. Line Termination Sets how to handle line terminations. Default Color Sets the print color mode as Color or Black. This setting is used for print jobs without a specified color print mode. Ignore Form Feed Sets whether to ignore blank pages that only contain Form Feed control codes. Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool 149 PS Settings Specifies printer settings that only affect jobs using the PostScript Level3 Compatible emulation printer language. PS Error Report Sets whether the contents of the errors concerning PostScript Level3 Compatible page description language are printed. PS Job Time-out Sets the execution time for one PostScript Level3 Compatible job. Paper Select Mode Sets the way to select the tray for the PostScript Level3 Compatible mode. Default Color Sets the default color mode for the PostScript Level3 Compatible mode. PDF Settings Specifies the PDF settings. Quantity 2 Sided Print Sets whether to print on both sides of a sheet of paper. Print Mode PDF Password Sets a password. Re-enter PDF Password Confirms the set password. Collation Sets whether to sort the output. Output Size Layout Default Color Detect Job Separator Sets whether to detect the end of the job in printing PDF files successively from the USB memory. Secure Settings Panel Lock Sets a limited access to Admin Settings with a password, and to set or change the password. Panel Lock Control* Sets whether to enable/disable password protection for the Admin Settings. New Password Sets a password that is required to access the Admin Settings. Re-enter Password Confirms the set password. Some setting items in the Secure Settings are displayed only when this setting item is enabled. NOTE: • You can set the password for the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool from Set Password in Print Server Settings. Functions Control Specifies whether to lock the Copy, Scan, Fax, and Print functions with a password, and to set or change the password. Copy Sets whether to lock the Copy function with a password. Scan to E-mail Sets whether to lock the Scan to Email feature with a password. Fax Sets whether to lock the Fax function with a password. Fax Driver Sets whether to enable or disable the Fax Driver function. 150 Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool Scan to Network Folder Sets whether to lock the Scan to Network Folder feature with a password. Scan to Computer Sets whether to lock the Scan to Computer feature with a password. PC Scan Sets whether to lock the PC Scan feature with a password. Scan to USB Sets whether to lock the Scan to USB feature with a password. USB Direct Print Sets whether to lock the USB Direct Print feature with a password. ID Copy Sets whether to enable or disable the ID Copy feature. USB Service - Show When Inserted Sets whether to show the USB Drive Detected screen when a USB flash drive is inserted into the printer. Automatic Document Detected Menu Sets whether to enable or disable to detect document loaded in the DADF and show DADF related menus on the touch panel. New Password Sets a password that is required to access the Copy, Scan, Fax, and Print functions. Re-enter Password Confirms the set password. NOTE: • You can set the password for the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool from Set Password in Print Server Settings. Secure Receive Allows you to password protect all the incoming faxes. When the Secure Receive feature is enabled, the printer stores incoming faxes and prints them when the correct password is entered on the touch panel. Secure Receive Set Sets whether to enable/disable password protection for all incoming faxes. New Password Sets a password for incoming faxes. Re-enter Password Confirms the set password. NOTE: • You can set the password for the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool from Set Password in Print Server Settings. Desktop Login Select the user authentication method from either local authentication or remote authentication. To use the remote authentication method, the LDAP server or the Kerberos server is required to authenticate the user. NOTE: • This is available on Dell S2825cdn. Desktop Authentication Sets the authentication method. Authentication System Click to display the Authentication System page and to specify the authentication system settings. User Login History Select the check box to enable the User Login History feature. Edit E-mail From Fields Sets whether to enable editing of the transmission source when you use the Scan to Email feature. Reconfirm Recipients Sets whether to reconfirm before sending fax or scan jobs. Software Download Sets whether to enable download of firmware updates. Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool 151 Display of Network Information Sets whether to show network information in the message field of the Home screen. Login Error Specifies how many times an administrator can attempt to log in to Panel Lock, Functions Control, and Secure Receive. Login Error Displays how many times an administrator can attempt to log in to Panel Lock, Functions Control, and Secure Receive. NFC Authentication Sets whether to enable the authentication using the NFC authentication card. NOTE: • This is available on Dell H625cdw and Dell H825cdw. Set Available Time - Copy/Scan/Fax/Print Specifies the time to enable the secure setting for the Copy, Scan, Fax, and Print functions. Set Available Time Start Time End Time Recurrence Secure Job Expiration NOTE: • Secure Job Expiration feature is available only when RAM Disk is enabled. Specifies the date and time to delete the files stored as Secure Print in the RAM disk. Expiration Mode Allows you to set the date to delete the files stored as Secure Print in the RAM disk. Expiration Time Sets the time to delete the files stored as Secure Print in the RAM disk. Recurrence Sets the period to repeat the setting. Weekly Settings Sets the day of the week to repeat the setting. Monthly Settings Sets the day of the month to repeat the setting. Copy Defaults Creates your own default Copy settings. Output Color Sets whether to print in color or in black and white. Select Tray Sets the default input tray. Collation Sets whether to sort a copy job. Reduce/Enlarge Sets the default reduction/enlargement ratio. Custom Reduce/Enlarge Sets the custom reduction/enlargement ratio. Original Size Sets the document paper size. Original Type Sets the document paper type. Darken/Lighten Sets the default copy density. Sharpness Sets the default sharpness level. Color Saturation Adjusts the saturation of colors to make the colors lighter or darker. Auto Exposure Sets whether to suppress the background to enhance text on the copy. 152 Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool Auto Exposure Level Sets the background suppression level. Copy Color Balance Specifies the copy color balance. Copy Settings Configures the Copy settings. 2 Sided Copying Sets whether to print on both sides of a sheet of paper. Binding of Original Sets the binding position for the two-sided copying. 2-Up Off Does not perform multiple-up printing. Auto Automatically reduces to fit onto one sheet of paper. Manual Specify the reduce/enlarge ratio in Reduce/Enlarge. Margin Top/Bottom Sets the value of the top and bottom margins. Margin Left/Right Sets the value of the left and right margins. Margin Middle Sets the value of the middle margin. Fax Defaults Creates your own default Fax settings. Resolution Standard Suitable for documents with normal sized characters. Fine Suitable for documents containing small characters or thin lines or documents printed using a dot-matrix printer. Super Fine Suitable for documents containing extremely fine detail. The super fine mode is enabled only if the remote machine also supports the Super Fine resolution. Photo Suitable for documents containing photographic images. 2 Sided Scanning Sets whether to scan both sides of a document. Binding of Original Sets the binding position for the two-sided scanning. Darken/Lighten Sets the default density to fax your documents lighter or darker. Delayed Send Sets the fax transmission start time when sending a fax at a specified time. Fax Settings Configures the Fax settings. NOTE: • You cannot set up the items on the Fax Settings page unless you set up the country code under Country. Fax Number Allows you to enter the fax number of the printer to be printed on the header of faxes. Country Sets the country where the printer is used. Fax Header Name Allows you to enter a name to be printed on the header of faxes. Line Type Sets the default line type; Public Switched Telephone Network (PSTN) or Private Branch Exchange (PBX). Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool 153 Line Monitor Sets the volume of the line monitor, which audibly monitors a transmission through the internal speaker until a connection is made. DRPD Pattern Sets the Distinctive Ring Pattern Detection (DRPD) setting from Pattern1 to Pattern7. DRPD is a service provided by some telephone companies. Receive Mode Telephone Automatic fax reception is turned off. You can receive a fax by picking up the handset of the external telephone and then pressing a remote receive code, or by tapping Manual Receive in On Hook and then tapping Receive. For details about Manual Receive, see "Receiving a Fax Manually." Fax Automatically receives faxes. Telephone/Fax When the printer receives an incoming fax, the external telephone rings for the time specified in Auto Receive Tel/Fax, and then the printer receives a fax. If an incoming call is not a fax, the printer beeps from the internal speaker indicating that the call is a telephone call. Ans Machine/Fax The printer can share a telephone line with an answering machine. In this mode, the printer monitors the fax signal and pick up the line if there are fax tones. If the telephone communication in your country is serial, this mode is not supported. DRPD Before using the Distinctive Ring Pattern Detection (DRPD) option, a distinctive ring service must be installed on your telephone line by the telephone company. After the telephone company has provided a separate number for faxing with a distinctive ring pattern, configure the fax setup to monitor for that specific ring pattern. Ring Tone Volume Sets the volume of the ring tone, which indicates that an incoming call is a telephone call through the internal speaker when Receive Mode is set to Telephone/Fax. Auto Receive Fax Sets the interval at which the printer goes into the fax receive mode after answering an incoming call. Auto Receive Tel/Fax Sets the interval at which the printer goes into the fax receive mode after the external telephone receives an incoming call. Auto Receive Answer/Fax Sets the interval at which the printer goes into the fax receive mode after the external answering machine receives an incoming call. Junk Fax Setup Sets whether to reject unwanted faxes by accepting only the faxes from the numbers registered in the Phone Book. 2 Sided Printing Sets whether to print on both sides of a sheet of paper. Remote Receive Sets whether to receive a fax by pressing a remote receive code on the external telephone. Remote Receive Tone Sets a 2-digit remote receive code when Remote Receive is On. Discard Size Sets whether to delete text or images at the bottom of a fax page when the entire page does not fit onto the output paper. Selecting Auto Reduction automatically reduces the fax page to fit it onto the output paper, and does not discard any images or text at the bottom of the page. Received Fax Forward Sets your printer to forward incoming faxes to another fax number, to e-mail addresses, or to a server. Forwarding Number Allows you to enter the fax number of the destination to which incoming faxes are forwarded. Forwarding E-mail Address 1 Allows you to enter the e-mail address to which incoming faxes are to be forwarded. Forwarding E-mail Address 2 154 Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool Forwarding E-mail Address 3 Forwarding E-mail Address 4 Forwarding E-mail Address 5 Server Type Sets the server type. Server Address Sets the server address registered under the server ID. Server Port Number Sets the server port number. Login Name Sets the login name. Login Password Sets the login password. Re-enter Password Enter the password again to check it. Share Name Sets the shared name. Server Path Sets the server path. Redial Attempts Sets the number of redial attempts to make if the destination fax number is busy. If you enter 0, the printer does not redial. Interval of Redial Sets the interval between redial attempts. Resend Delay Sets the interval between re-send attempts. Tone/Pulse Sets whether to use tone or pulse dialing. Prefix Dial Sets whether to set a prefix dial number. Prefix Dial Number Sets a prefix dial number of up to five digits. This number dials before any auto dial number is started. It is useful for accessing the Private Automatic Branch Exchange (PABX). Fax Cover Page Sets whether to attach a cover page to faxes. Fax Header Sets whether to print the information of the sender on the header of faxes. ECM Sets whether to enable the Error Correction Mode (ECM). To use the ECM, the remote machines must also support the ECM. Modem Speed Allows you to adjust the fax modem speed when a fax transmission or reception error occurs. Display Manual Fax Recipients Sets whether to show the fax number of the recipient on the Sending Fax screen when manually sending a fax. Fax Activity Sets whether to automatically print a fax activity report after every 50 incoming and outgoing fax communications. Fax Transmit Sets whether to print a transmission report after every fax transmission or only when an error occurs. Fax Broadcast Sets whether to print a transmission report after every fax transmission to multiple destinations or only when an error occurs. Fax Protocol Sets whether to print the protocol monitor report after every fax transmission or only when an error occurs. Scan Defaults Creates your own default Scan settings. File Format Sets the file format in which scanned data is to be saved. Output Color Sets whether to scan in color or in black and white. Resolution Sets the default scan resolution. Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool 155 Original Size Sets the document paper size. 2 Sided Scanning Sets whether to scan both sides of a document. Binding of Original Sets the binding position for the two-sided scanning. Darken/Lighten Sets the default scan density. Sharpness Sets the default sharpness level. Contrast Sets the default contrast level. Auto Exposure Sets whether to suppress the background to enhance text on the scanned data. Auto Exposure Level Sets the default background suppression level. Margin Top/Bottom Sets the value of the top and bottom margins. Margin Left/Right Sets the value of the left and right margins. Margin Middle Sets the value of the middle margin. TIFF File Format Sets the TIFF file format to TIFF V6 or TTN2. Image Compression Sets the image compression level. File Naming Mode Sets the detailed settings of File Naming Mode to Auto, Add Prefix or Add Suffix. Prefix/Suffix String Sets the texts that are added when Add Prefix or Add Suffix are selected. Create Folder Sets whether to create a folder when saving scanned data. Direct Print Defaults / USB Direct Print Defaults NOTE: • For Dell H625cdw and Dell H825cdw, Direct Print Defaults is displayed. For Dell S2825cdn, USB Direct Print Defaults is displayed. Creates your own Direct Print Defaults / USB Direct Print Defaults setting. Output Color Sets whether to print in color or in black and white. Select Tray Sets the default input tray. 2 Sided Printing Sets whether to print on both sides of a sheet of paper. Layout Sets Displays the default paper layout when Layout is selected. Image Types Sets the print image quality when printing documents. Collation Sets whether to sort the output. PDF Password Sets a password. Re-enter PDF Password Confirms the set password. MIFARE Customized Card Registers SSFC formatted NFC ID cards. User ID Block 1 Allows you to register the MIFARE Customized Card. User ID Block 2 Allows you to register the MIFARE Customized Card. User ID Block 3 Allows you to register the MIFARE Customized Card. NOTE: • This is available on Dell H625cdw and Dell H825cdw. Printer Maintenance The Printer Maintenance tab includes the Paper Density, Adjust Transfer Belt Unit, Adjust 2nd BTR, Adjust Fusing Unit, Color Registration Adjustments, Clean Developer, 156 Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool Reset Defaults, Initialize Print Meter, Clear Stored Jobs, Non-Dell Toner, Adjust Altitude, Decrease Ghosting, Clock Settings, and Web Link Customization pages. Paper Density Specifies the paper density for the plain paper and labels. Adjust Transfer Belt Unit Adjusts the transfer bias when the faint image of the previous page, a part of the page currently printing, etc. appear on the output. K Offset If faint black colored ghosts appear, try to decrease the value. YMC Offset If faint ghosts in color (yellow, magenta, or cyan) appear, try to decrease the value. Adjust 2nd BTR Specifies the optimum voltage settings for printing for the 2nd Belt Transfer Roller (2nd BTR). To lower the voltage, set negative values. To increase, set positive values. If you see mottles on the print output, try to increase the voltage. If you see white spots on the print output, try to decrease the voltage. NOTE: • The print quality changes depending on the setting values you select for this item. Plain(60-90g/m2) Sets the reference voltage setting for the transfer roller for each paper type. Plain Thick(91-105g/m2) Covers(106-176g/m2) Covers Thick(177-220g/m2) Coated(106-176g/m2) Coated Thick(177-220g/m2) Label Envelope Recycled Adjust Fusing Unit Specifies the optimum temperature settings for printing for the fusing unit. To lower the temperature, set negative values. To increase, set positive values. When the printouts are curled, try to lower the temperature. When the toner does not fuse on the paper properly, try to increase the temperature. NOTE: • The print quality changes depending on the setting values you select for this item. Plain(60-90g/m2) Sets the temperature settings for the fusing unit for each paper type. Plain Thick(91-105g/m ) Covers(106-176g/m2) Covers Thick(177-220g/m2) Coated(106-176g/m2) Coated Thick(177-220g/m2) Label Envelope Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool 157 Recycled Color Registration Adjustments Specifies whether to automatically perform color registration adjustment. Clean Developer Stirs the developer in the drum cartridge. Clean Developer Click Start to stir the developer in the drum cartridge. Toner Refresh Expels the toner in the drum cartridge, and supplies the fresh toner from the toner cartridge. Reset Defaults Initializes the non-volatile (NV) memory. After executing this setting and restarting the printer, all the menu parameters are reset to their default values. Reset Defaults User Fax Section and restart printer. Click Start to reset the fax number entries in the Address Book. Reset Defaults User Scan Section and restart printer. Click Start to reset the e-mail and server address entries in the Address Book. Reset Defaults User Account Section and restart printer.* Click Start to reset the user account entries. Reset Defaults User App Section and restart printer.* Click Start to reset the user application entries. Reset Defaults System Section and restart printer. Click Start to reset the system parameters. Power On Wizard Click Start to perform the initial setup for the printer. This is available on Dell H625cdw and Dell H825cdw. Initialize Print Meter Initializes the print meter of the printer. When the print meter is initialized, the meter count is reset to 0. Clear Stored Jobs NOTE: • Clear Stored Jobs feature is available only when RAM Disk is enabled. Clears all files stored in the RAM disk. All 158 Click Start to clear all files stored as Secure Print, Proof Print, Private Mail Box Print, and Public Mail Box Print in the RAM disk. Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool Secure Document Click Start to clear all files stored as Secure Print, Proof Print, Private Mail Box Print, and Public Mail Box Print in the RAM disk. Stored Document Click Start to clear all files stored in the RAM disk. Non-Dell Toner Uses toner cartridge of another manufacturer. CAUTION: • Using a non-Dell toner cartridge may severely damage the printer. The warranty does not cover damages caused by using non-Dell toner cartridges. Adjust Altitude Specifies the altitude of the location where the printer is installed. The discharge phenomenon for charging the photo conductor varies with barometric pressure. Adjustments are performed by specifying the altitude of the location where the printer is being used. Decrease Ghosting Reduces negative ghost. Clock Settings Specifies the clock settings. Date Format Time Format Time Zone Set Date Set Time Web Link Customization Specifies a link used for ordering consumables, which can be accessed from Order Supplies at: in the left frame. Select Reorder URL Sets a URL to be linked to Order Supplies at: Regular Displays the regular URL (http://accessories.us.dell.com/sna) that can be linked to Order Supplies at:. Premier Displays the premier URL (http://premier.dell.com) that can be linked to Order Supplies at:. Print Server Settings Use the Print Server Settings menu to set the type of printer interface and the necessary conditions for communication. Print Server Reports The Print Server Reports tab includes the Print Server Setup Page and the E-Mail Server Setup Page. Print Server Setup Page Displays the current settings of the print server. Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool 159 E-Mail Server Setup Page Displays the current settings of the e-mail server. Print Server Settings The Print Server Settings tab includes the Basic Information, Port Settings, TCP/IP, SMB, E-Mail Server, Bonjour (mDNS), SNMP, Scan to Network Folder, SNTP, AirPrint, Mopria, Google Cloud Print, Dell Document Hub, Proxy Server, Wi-Fi, Wi-Fi Direct, and Reset Print Server pages. Basic Information Configures basic information of the printer. System Settings Printer Name Location Sets the location of the printer. Contact Person Sets the contact name, number, and other information of the printer administrator and service center. Administrator E-Mail Address Sets the contact address of the printer administrator and service center. Asset Tag Number Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool Settings Auto Refresh Automatically refreshes the contents of the status display pages. Auto Refresh Interval Sets the time interval for refreshing the contents of the status display pages automatically. NOTE: • The Auto Refresh feature is effective for the contents of the top frame, Printer Status page, Job List page, and Completed Jobs page. Port Settings Enables or disables printing ports and management protocol features. Ethernet*1 Ethernet Settings Auto Detects the Ethernet transmission rate and the duplex mode. 10Base-T Half-Duplex Specifies as the default value. 10Base-T Full-Duplex 100Base-TX Half-Duplex 100Base-TX Full-Duplex 1000Base-T Full-Duplex Current Ethernet Settings MAC Address Port Status 160 Energy Efficient Ethernet Select the check box to enable the Energy Efficient Ethernet feature. LPD Sets whether to enable each item. Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool Port9100 IPP WSD Print WSD Scan Network TWAIN FTP SMB Bonjour (mDNS) E-Mail Alert Telnet SNMP Update Address Book SNTP Google Cloud Print Print from Dell Document Hub*2 Scan to Dell Document Hub*2 *1 *2 This item is available only when the printer is connected using an Ethernet cable. This is available on Dell H625cdw and Dell H825cdw. NOTE: • The settings in the Port Settings page become valid only when the printer is restarted. When you change or configure the settings, click the Apply New Settings button to apply the new settings. TCP/IP Configures the IP address, subnet mask, and gateway address of the printer. TCP/IP Settings IP Mode Host Name IPv4 IP Address Mode Sets the method for acquiring the IP address. Manual IP Address When an IP address is being set manually, the IP is allocated to the printer using the format nnn.nnn.nnn.nnn. Each octet that makes up nnn.nnn.nnn.nnn is a value in the range of 0 to 254. 127 and any value in the range of 224 to 254 cannot be specified for the first octet of a gateway address. Manual Subnet When an IP address is being set manually, the Mask subnet mask is specified using the format nnn.nnn.nnn.nnn. Each octet that makes up nnn.nnn.nnn.nnn is a value in the range of 0 to 255. 255.255.255.255 cannot be specified as the subnet mask. Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool 161 Manual Gateway Address IPv6 When an IP address is being set manually, the gateway address is specified using the format nnn.nnn.nnn.nnn. Each octet that makes up nnn.nnn.nnn.nnn is a value in the range of 0 to 254. 127 and any value in the range of 224 to 254 cannot be specified for the first octet of a gateway address. Enable Stateless Select the check box to enable the stateless Address address. Use Manual Address Select the check box to set the IP address manually. Get IP Address from DHCP Allows you to enable or disable the automatic setting of the IP address via DHCP. Manual Address Sets the IP address. To specify an IPv6 address, enter the address followed by a slash (/) and then "64." For details, contact your system administrator. Manual Gateway Address DNS DNS Domain Name IPv4 Get DNS Server Allows you to enable or disable the automatic setting of the DNS server address via DHCP. Address from DHCP Manual DNS Server Address IPv6 WINS Manually sets the DNS server address in xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx format when Get DNS Server Address from DHCP is not selected. Get DNS Server Select the check box to get the DNS server address Address from automatically from the DHCPv6-lite server. DHCPv6-lite Manual DNS Server Address 162 Sets the gateway address. Sets the DNS server address. DNS Dynamic Update (IPv4) Select the check box to enable dynamic updates to DNS. DNS Dynamic Update (IPv6) Select the check box to enable dynamic updates to DNS. Auto Generate Search List Select the check box to automatically generate the search list. Search Domain Name Sets the search domain name. Up to 255 alphanumeric characters, periods, and hyphens can be used. If you need to specify more than one domain name, separate them using a comma or semicolon. Time-out Sets the time-out period. Priority to IPv6 DNS Name Resolution Select the check box to enable the DNS Name Resolution feature. WINS Mode Allows you to enable or disable the automatic setting of the primary and secondary WINS server addresses via DHCP. WINS Primary Server Manually sets the primary WINS server address in xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx format when WINS Mode is not selected. Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool WINS Secondary Server Manually sets the secondary WINS server address in xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx format when WINS Mode is not selected. LPD Connection Time-Out Sets the connection time-out period. Port9100 Port Number Sets the port number from 9000 to 9999. Connection Time-Out Sets the connection time-out period. Printer URI Displays the printer URI. Connection Time-Out Sets the connection time-out period. Port Number Displays the port number for receiving requests from the client. Maximum Sessions Displays the maximum number of connections received simultaneously by the client. Port Number Sets the port number to 80 or from 8000 to 9999. Receive Time-Out Sets the receive time-out period. Notification Time-Out Sets the notification time-out period. Maximum Number of TTL Sets the maximum number of TTL from 1 to 10. Maximum Number of Notification Sets the maximum number of notifications from 10 to 20. IPP WSD Network TWAIN Connection Time-Out Sets the connection time-out period. FTP Password Sets the password for FTP. Re-enter Password Enter the password again to check it. Connection Time-Out Sets the connection time-out period. Port Number Sets the port number to 80 or from 8000 to 9999. Simultaneous Connections Displays the maximum number of simultaneous connections. CSRF Protection Select the check box to enable the CSRF Protection. Connection Time-Out Sets the connection time-out period. Password Sets the password for Telnet. Re-enter Password Confirms the set password. Connection Time-Out Sets the connection time-out period. Update Address Connection Book Time-Out Sets the connection time-out period. HTTP Telnet To configure the IP Filter feature, enter an IP address to be filtered in the Address text box and the subnet mask in the Address Mask text box. Enter a numeric value between 0 and 255 in each text box. "*" is appended to the current value. Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool 163 IP Filter Setup Procedure You can set up to a maximum of five items and the first item set takes priority. When setting multiple filters, enter the shortest address first followed by a slightly longer address, a longer address and so on. Enabling Printing From a Specified User The following describes the procedure to enable printing only from the "192.0.2.1" IP address. 1 Click the first column of the Access List row 1. 2 Enter "192.0.2.1" in the Address text box and "255.255.255.255" in the Address Mask text box. 3 Select Accept. 4 Click Apply New Settings. Disabling Printing From a Specified User The following describes the procedure to disable printing only from the "192.0.2.1" IP address. 1 Click the first column of the Access List row 1. 2 Enter "192.0.2.1" in the Address text box and "255.255.255.255" in the Address Mask text box. 3 Select Reject. 4 Click the first column of the Access List row 2. 5 Enter "0.0.0.0" in the Address text box and "0.0.0.0" in the Address Mask text box. 6 Select Accept. 7 Click Apply New Settings. Enabling and Disabling Printing from Network Addresses You can enable printing from the "192.168" network address and disable printing from the "192.0.2" network address. The following example describes how to enable printing from the "192.0.2.1" IP address. 1 Click the first column of the Access List row 1. 2 Enter "192.0.2.1" in the Address text box and "255.255.255.255" in the Address Mask text box. 3 Select Accept. 4 Click the first column of the Access List row 2. 5 Enter "192.0.2.0" in the Address text box and "255.255.255.0" in the Address Mask text box. 6 Select Reject. 164 Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool 7 Click the first column of the Access List row 3. 8 Enter "192.0.0.0" in the Address text box and "255.255.0.0" in the Address Mask text box. 9 Select Accept. 10 Click Apply New Settings. SMB Specifies the setting of the Server Message Block (SMB) protocol. Host Name Sets the host name of the server computer. Workgroup Sets the workgroup. Maximum Sessions Sets the maximum number of sessions. Unicode Support Sets whether to notify the host name and workgroup name in Unicode characters during SMB transmission. Auto Master Mode Sets whether to enable the Auto Master Mode. Encrypt Password Sets whether to encrypt the password. Job Time-Out Sets the job time-out period. Connection Time-Out Sets the connection time-out period. E-Mail Server Configures detailed settings of E-Mail Server, E-Mail Alert and E-Mail Report. This page can also be displayed by clicking E-Mail Server Settings Overview in the left frame. E-Mail Server Settings Primary SMTP Gateway Sets the primary SMTP gateway. SMTP Port Number Sets the SMTP port number. This must be 25, 587 or between 5000 and 65535. E-Mail Send Authentication Sets the authentication method for outgoing e-mail. SMTP Login User Sets the SMTP login user. Up to 63 alphanumeric characters, periods, hyphens, underscores, and at symbols (@) can be used. If specifying more than one address, separate them using commas. SMTP Login Password Sets the SMTP account password using up to 31 alphanumeric characters. Re-enter SMTP Login Password Confirms the set SMTP account password. POP3 Server Address* Sets the POP3 server address in IP address format of aaa.bbb.ccc.ddd or as a DNS host name using up to 63 characters. POP3 Port Number* Sets the POP3 server port number. This must be 110 or between 5000 and 65535. POP User Name* Sets the POP3 account user name. Up to 63 alphanumeric characters, periods, hyphens, underscores, and at symbols (@) can be used. If specifying more than one address, separate them using commas. POP User Password* Sets the POP3 account password using up to 31 alphanumeric characters. Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool 165 E-Mail Alert Settings Re-enter POP User Password* Confirms the set password. Reply Address Designates the reply e-mail address sent with each E-mail Alert. SMTP Server Connection Displays the status of the SMTP server connection. E-Mail List 1 Sets acceptable e-mail addresses for the E-Mail Alert feature using up to 255 alphanumeric characters. Select Alerts for Supplies Alerts List 1 Select the check box to receive an E-Mail Alert for consumables. Paper Handling Select the check box to receive an E-Mail Alert for Alerts paper handling. Service Call Select the check box to receive an E-Mail Alert for Service Calls. E-Mail List 2 Sets acceptable e-mail addresses for the E-Mail Alert feature using up to 255 alphanumeric characters. Select Alerts for Supplies Alerts List 2 Select the check box to receive an E-Mail Alert for consumables. Paper Handling Select the check box to receive an E-Mail Alert for Alerts paper handling. Service Call E-Mail Report Settings Select the check box to receive an E-Mail Alert for Service Calls. History Report Sets whether to receive the job history report by e-mail after every 20 print, copy, scan, and fax jobs. Statistics Report Sets whether to receive the statistic report by e-mail on the use of print, copy, scan, and fax. Volume Report Sets whether to receive the print volume report by e-mail. Transmission Time Sets what time the reports are sent. Recurrence Sets at what recurrence the reports are sent. Weekly Settings (for Weekly only) Sets the day of the week the reports are sent. Monthly Settings (for Monthly only) Sets the day of the month the reports are sent. Destination E-Mail Address Allows you to enter the e-mail address to which the reports are sent to. Destination E-Mail Address Allows you to enter the e-mail address to which the reports are sent to. This item is available only when POP before SMTP (Plain) or POP before SMTP (APOP) for E-Mail Send Authentication is selected. Bonjour (mDNS) Configures the detailed settings of Bonjour. 166 Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool LAN1* LAN2* Host Name Sets the host name up to 63 alphanumeric characters and "-" (hyphen). The original setting remains valid if no input is made. Printer Name Sets the printer name up to 63 alphanumeric characters and symbol sets. The original setting remains valid if no input is made. Wide-Area Bonjour Select the check box to enable the Wide-Area Bonjour protocol. Host Name Sets the printer name up to 63 alphanumeric characters and symbol sets. The original setting remains valid if no input is made. Printer Name Sets the printer name up to 63 alphanumeric characters and symbol sets. The original setting remains valid if no input is made. This is available on Dell H625cdw and Dell H825cdw. SNMP Configures the detailed settings of SNMP. SNMP Configuration*1 Enable SNMP Select the check box to enable the SNMP v1/v2c protocol. v1/v2c Protocol Edit SNMP v1/v2c Properties Click to display the SNMP v1/v2c page and to edit the setting of SNMP v1/v2c protocol from the page. Enable SNMP v3 Select the check box to enable the SNMP v3 protocol. Protocol Edit SNMP v3 Properties Click to display the SNMP v3 page and to edit the setting of SNMP v3 protocol from the page. You can click this item only when SSL communication is enabled. Community Name Community Name (Read only)*2 Sets the community name to access (read only) data using up to 31 alphanumeric characters. The original setting remains valid if no input is made. Characters entered for community name in the previous settings are not displayed on the screen. The default Read Community is public. Re-enter Community Name (Read only)*2 Enters the community name to access (read only) data again to check it. Community Name (Read/Write)*2 Sets the community name to access (read and write) data using up to 31 alphanumeric characters. The original setting remains valid if no input is made. Characters entered for community name in the previous settings are not displayed on the screen. The default Read/Write Community is private. Re-enter Community Name (Read/Write)*2 Enters the community name to access (read and write) data again to check it. Community Name (Trap)*2 Sets the community name used for trap up to 31 alphanumeric characters. The original setting remains valid if no input is made. Characters entered for Community Name (Trap) in the previous settings are not displayed on the screen. The default Trap Community is " " (NULL). Re-enter Community Name (Trap)*2 Enters the community name used for trap again to check it. Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool 167 Trap Trap Address Notification 1-4 Type Select the check boxes to notify trap occurrence. In this case, specify the IP address and IP socket in the following format: Trap Address IPv4 Port Number Specify the IP address and IP socket in the nnn.nnn.nnn.nnn:mmmmm format. Each section of nnn is a variable value between 0 and 255. Note that values 127 and 224-254 are not valid for the first three-digits only. IP socket mmmmm is a variable value between 0 and 65,535. Notify Network*3 IPv6 Specify the IP address and IP socket in the xxxx:xxxx:xxxx:xxxx:xxxx:xxxx:xxxx:xxxx:mmmmm format. Each section of XXXX is a hexadecimal variable value between 0 and ffff. IP socket mmmmm is a variable value between 0 and 65,535. Authenticate Error Trap *1 *2 *3 Select the check box to notify Authenticate Error Trap. This is available on Dell H625cdw and Dell H825cdw. The default value can be changed by using Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool. This item is available only when Wi-Fi Direct is set to Enable. The Wi-Fi Direct feature is available on Dell H625cdw and Dell H825cdw. SNMP v3 * Edits the detailed settings of SNMP v3 protocol. To enter this page, click Edit SNMP v3 Properties in the SNMP page. Administrator Account Account Enabled Select the check box to enable the administrator account. User Name Enters the user name of the administrator account. Authentication Sets the authentication password of the administrator account using Password 8 to 32 alphanumeric characters. Re-enter Confirms the set password. Authentication Password Print Drivers / Remote Client Account Privacy Password Sets the privacy password of the administrator account using 8 to 32 alphanumeric characters. Re-enter Privacy Password Confirms the set password. Account Enabled Select the check box to enable the print drivers and remote client account. Reset to default Click to reset the password for the print drivers and remote client Password account to default. This is available on Dell H625cdw and Dell H825cdw. Scan to Network Folder Specifies the client when scanning data. FTP Client 168 Connection Time-Out Sets the connection time-out period. FTP Passive Sets whether to enable the FTP Passive mode. Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool SMB Client Connection Time-Out Sets the connection time-out period. SMB Protocol Sets the SMB protocol. SNTP Configures the SNTP server settings in order to perform time synchronization through SNTP. SNTP IP Address / Host Name Sets the IP address or the host name of the SNTP server. Connection Time-Out Sets the connection time-out period. Time Sets the interval for performing time synchronization using SNTP. Synchronization Interval Last Connection Time Displays the last date and time when the printer was connected to the SNTP server. Connection Status Displays the status of the connections between the SNTP server and the printer. AirPrint Configures the detailed setting of AirPrint. AirPrint Bonjour IPP Authentication Enable AirPrint Select the check box to enable the printer for AirPrint. Enable USB Select the check box to enable IPP over USB. When you disable Enable AirPrint, this setting will be disabled automatically. Name Enter the name that is to be displayed as an AirPrint printer. Location Enter the location of the printer. Geo-Location Enter the physical location of the printer. Basic Select the check box to enable the basic authentication scheme. Authentication User Name Enter the user name. Password Enter the user password. Re-enter Password Re-enter the user password for confirmation. Scan Connection Time-Out Sets the time duration until the connection becomes time-out. SSL/TLS* SSL/TLS Click Settings to display the SSL/TLS page. Supply Levels Cyan Toner Cartridge Displays the toner level. Magenta Toner Cartridge Yellow Toner Cartridge Black Toner Cartridge This item is displayed only when Wi-Fi Direct is set to Enable. Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool 169 Mopria Enable to use Mopria Print Service. NOTE: • The Enable button is disabled, when both Bonjour(mDNS) and IPP are enabled. Google Cloud Print Registers the printer to Google Cloud Print. Google Cloud Print* (Registration state) Displays the Google Cloud Print registration state. Register This Device to Google Cloud Print Click to register the printer to Google Cloud Print. Google Cloud Print can only be used when the printer is using IPv4. Dell Document Hub Configures the connections to the Dell Document Hub Server. NOTE: • Dell Document Hub is available on Dell H625cdw and Dell H825cdw. Dell Document Hub Connection Time-Out Sets the time duration until the connection becomes time-out. Polling Interval Sets the interval time for polling. Proxy Server Configures the Proxy Server settings. Proxy Server Use Proxy Server Sets whether to enable the use of a proxy server. Address to Bypass Proxy Server Sets the address to bypass proxy server. Server Name Sets the name of the proxy server. Port Number Sets the port number from 1 to 65535. Authentication Sets whether to enable authentication. Login Name Sets the login name for the proxy server. Password Sets the login password for the proxy server. Re-enter Password Confirms the set password. Wi-Fi NOTE: • Wi-Fi feature is available only when the printer is connected using the wireless network. • Wireless network is available on Dell H625cdw and Dell H825cdw. Configures the detailed setting for the wireless network. To use the wireless network, make sure to disconnect the Ethernet cable. NOTE: • Once Wi-Fi is activated, wired LAN protocol is disabled. 170 Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool Wi-Fi Settings Security Settings Wi-Fi Sets whether to enable the Wi-Fi connection. SSID Sets the name that identifies the wireless network. Up to 32 alphanumeric characters can be entered. Network Type Sets the network type from either Ad-Hoc or Infrastructure. MAC Address Displays the MAC address of the printer. Link Channel Displays the channel number of the wireless connection for the printer. Link Quality Displays the quality of the wireless network connection for the printer. Encryption Select the encryption type from the list. No Security Sets No Security to configure the wireless setting without specifying an encryption type from WEP, WPA-PSK, and WPA-Enterprise. WEP Sets the WEP to use through the wireless network. WPA-PSK Sets the WPA-PSK AES/WPA2-PSK AES to use AES/WPA2-PSK through the wireless network. AES*1, 2 WPA-Enterprise Sets the WPA-Enterprise AES/WPA2-Enterprise AES -AES/WPA2to use through the wireless network. Enterprise-AES* 2, 3 WEP Mixed Mode PSK*1, 2 Sets the Mixed Mode PSK to use through the wireless network. Mixed Mode PSK automatically selects the encryption type from either WPA-PSK AES or WPA2-PSK AES. Mixed Mode Enterprise*2, 3 Sets the Mixed Mode Enterprise to use through the wireless network. Mixed Mode Enterprise automatically selects the encryption type from either WPA-Enterprise AES or WPA2-Enterprise AES. Encryption Select the WEP key code from either Hex or Ascii. WEP Key 1 Sets the WEP key set used through the wireless network only when WEP 128bit or WEP 64bit is selected for Encryption. Re-enter WEP Key 1 Enters the WEP key 1 again to check it. WEP Key 2 Sets the WEP key set used through the wireless network only when WEP 128bit or WEP 64bit is selected for Encryption. Re-enter WEP Key 2 Enters the WEP key 2 again to check it. WEP Key 3 Sets the WEP key set used through the wireless network only when WEP 128bit or WEP 64bit is selected for Encryption. Re-enter WEP Key 3 Enters the WEP key 3 again to check it. WEP Key 4 Sets the WEP key set used through the wireless network only when WEP 128bit or WEP 64bit is selected for Encryption. Re-enter WEP Key 4 Enters the WEP key 4 again to check it. Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool 171 WPA-PSK Transmit Key*5 Sets the transmit key type from the list. Passphrase Sets the passphrase. Re-enter Passphrase/Key Enters the passphrase again to check it. WPA-Enterprise EAP-Identity Sets the EAP-Identity for the authentication. *4 *1 *2 *3 *4 *5 Authentication Method Shows the authentication method. Login Name Sets the login name for the authentication. Password Sets the password. Re-enter Password Enters the password again to check it. For encryption, AES method is used. This item is available only when Infrastructure is selected for Network Type. For authentication and encryption by digital certificate, AES method is used. To activate the setting, import a certificate which supports wireless LAN (server/client) on the SSL/TLS pages, and enable the relevant certificate in advance. When Auto is selected for Transmit Key, the key set specified for WEP Key 1 is used. Wi-Fi Direct Configures the detailed setting of the Wi-Fi Direct connection. NOTE: • Wi-Fi Direct is available on Dell H625cdw and Dell H825cdw. Wi-Fi Direct Group Owner Status Wi-Fi Direct Sets whether to enable the Wi-Fi Direct connection. Group Role Sets the group role of the printer. Device Name Specifies the printer name that identifies the Wi-Fi Direct network with up to 32 alphanumeric characters. Check it when selecting the printer name on your mobile device. WPS Setup Configures the Wi-Fi Direct network using Wi-Fi Protected Setup (WPS). SSID (Character Specifies a name to identify the Wi-Fi Direct network. Up to 32 string following alphanumeric characters can be entered. "DIRECT-" cannot be changed. "DIRECT-**") Passphrase Displays the passphrase. Check it when entering the passphrase into your mobile device. IP Address Displays the IP address of the Wi-Fi Direct adapter. Subnet Mask Displays the subnet mask. Paired Device Displays the mobile name currently connected. Current Role Displays the current group role of the printer. Current SSID Displays the current SSID. Check it selecting the Wi-Fi Direct network name on your mobile device. Reset Print Server Initializes NVRAM (non-volatile RAM) for the network feature and restarts the printer. You can also initialize NVRAM of the printer from Reset Defaults in the Printer Settings menu. Initialize NIC NVRAM Memory and restart printer. 172 Click Start to initialize NVRAM, revert network settings to the factory default settings, and restart the network capability. Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool Restart Printer Click Start to restart the printer. Security The Security tab includes Set Password, Authentication System, Kerberos Server, LDAP Server, LDAP Authentication, LDAP User Mapping, SSL/TLS, IPsec, 802.1x, IP Filter, and SMTP Domain Filtering pages. Set Password Specifies the password that is required to access the setup parameters of the printer from the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool. This page can also be displayed by clicking Set Password in the left frame. NOTE: • To restore the password to the default (NULL), initialize the non-volatile memory (NVM). • You can set the password for access to Admin Settings. Administrator Password Sets the password using up to 128 alphanumeric characters. Re-enter Administrator Password Confirms the set password. Access denial by the authentication failure of the Administrator Sets the amount of time the administrator should wait for the access to the printer setup from Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool. The access is denied if the time-out time is exceeded. If you set 0, this mode is disabled. Authentication System Specifies the server authentication type, the server response time-out, or the search time-out. Authentication Type Authentication Select the authentication system from the list. System Settings Authentication Type (for ColorTrack PRO)* Authentication Select the authentication system from the list. When the server you System Settings are accessing uses the Kerberos authentication, select Kerberos (Windows) as the authentication method and specify the server settings in "Kerberos Server." Optional Information Server Response Time-Out Sets the amount of time the printer should wait for response from the server. Search Time-Out Sets the amount of time the printer should wait for searching for the server. This is available on Dell S2825cdn. Kerberos Server Specifies the settings for the Kerberos server. Kerberos Server IP Address / Host Name & Port Domain Name Kerberos Server IP Address / (for ColorTrack Host Name & PRO)* Port Domain Name Sets the IP address or host name, and the port address. The port address must be 88 or between 5000 and 65535. Specifies each information. Sets the IP address or host name, and the port address. The port address must be 88 or between 5000 and 65535. Enter the domain name. This is available on Dell S2825cdn. Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool 173 LDAP Server Specifies the settings of the LDAP server. Server Information Optional Information IP Address / Host Name & Port Sets IP address or the host name, and the port address. The port address must be 389, 3268, or between 5000 and 65535. LDAP Server Displays the current software information of the LDAP server. Search Enters the search directory root. Directory Root Login Credentials to Access LDAP Server Select credential used to access the LDAP server. Login Name Enters the login name. Password Enters the login password using 1 to 127 alphanumeric characters. If the password is left blank (NULL), you cannot log in to a server. Re-enter Password Enters the login password again to check it. Search Time-Out Select Wait LDAP Server Limit to follow the time specified by the LDAP server. Select Wait to specify the time. Search Name Order Sets the search order. Server Address Book Select the check box to enable the server address book. Server Phone Book Select the check box to enable the server phone book. Server IP Address / Information (for Host Name & ColorTrack Port PRO)* LDAP Server Sets IP address or the host name, and the port address. The port address must be 389, 636, 3268, 3269, or between 5000 and 65535. When LDAPS communication is required, set the port number to 636, and when you use the global catalog, set the port number to 3269. Displays the current software information of the LDAP server. Optional Search Enter the search directory root. Information (for Directory Root ColorTrack PRO)* Login Name Enter the login name. Password Enter the login password using 1 to 127 alphanumeric characters. Re-enter Password Enter the login password again to confirm it. Search Time-Out Select Wait LDAP Server Limit to follow the time specified by the LDAP server. Select Wait to specify the time. This is available on Dell S2825cdn. NOTE: • Server Address Book must be set to On before you can use the server address book for the Scan to Email feature. • Server Phone Book must be set to On before you can use the server phone book for the Fax function. LDAP Authentication Specifies the LDAP server authentication method. 174 Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool LDAP Authentication Authentication Shows the authentication method. Method Use Added Text Select whether to use the added text string from the list. String Text String Added to User Name LDAP Authentication (for ColorTrack PRO)* Enter the added text string. Specifies the LDAP server authentication method. Authentication Shows the authentication method. Method Use Added Text Select whether to use the added text string from the list. String Text String Added to User Name Enter the added text string. This is available on Dell S2825cdn. LDAP User Mapping Specifies the settings of the LDAP user mapping. Common Name Sets the attribute type of the common name set for the LDAP server. Surname Sets the attribute type of the surname set for the LDAP server. Given Name Sets the attribute type of the given name set for the LDAP server. E-mail Address Sets the attribute type of the e-mail address set for the LDAP server. Fax Phone Sets the attribute type of the fax phone number set for the LDAP server. SSL/TLS Specifies the settings for the SSL encryption communication to the printer, and set/delete the certificate used for IPsec, LDAPS, or Wi-Fi. NOTE: • Wireless network is available on Dell H625cdw and Dell H825cdw. SSL/TLS HTTP - SSL/TLS Select the check box to enable the HTTP-SSL/TLS Communication. Communication *1 HTTP - SSL/TLS Sets the port number, which is not identical with that of HTTP for Communication SSL/TLS. This must be 443 or between 8000 and 9999. Port Number LDAP - SSL/TLS Select the check box to enable the LDAP, and access is established Communication using SSL/TLS communication. *1 SMTP - SSL/TLS Sets the type of SSL/TLS used to communicate with the SMTP server. Communication MD5 Generate Self-Signed Certificate*2 Select the check box to enable the MD5. Click to display the Generate Self-Signed Certificate page and to create a security certification from the page. The Generate Self-Signed Certificate button is available only when the self-signed certificate is not generated. Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool 175 Public Key Method Select the public key method of the self-signed certificate. Size of Public Key Select the size of public key. Issuer Sets the issuer of SSL self-signed certificate. Validity Enters the valid days from 1 to 9999 days. Generate Signed Click to generate the SSL self-signed certificate. Certificate Certificate Signing Request (CSR) Click to display the Certificate Signing Request (CSR) page and to create a certificate signing request from the page. Digital Signature Select the digital signature algorithm. Algorithm Public Key Size Select the public key size. 2 Letter Country Enter the 2-letter country code. Code (Required) State / Province Enter the state or province name up to 16 bytes. Name Locality Name Enter the locality name up to 32 bytes. Organization Name (Required) Enter the organization name up to 32 bytes. Organization Unit (Required) Enter the organization unit up to 32 bytes. Common Name Enter the common name. E-mail Address Upload Signed Certificate*2 Click to display the Upload Signed Certificate page and to upload the certificate file to the device from the page. Password Enter the password to upload the certificate file. Re-enter Password Enter the password again for confirmation. File Name Click Browse to browse the file name to upload to the device. Import Click Import to upload the certificate file to the device. Click to display the Certificate Management page and to manage a security certification from the page. Certificate Management*2 Delete All Certificates Category Select the device to certificate. Certificate Purpose Select the connection to certificate. Certificate Order Select the order to certificate. Display the List Click to display the Certificate List page. Delete Click to delete all the certificates. Certificate List*2 Category 176 Enter the e-mail address. Displays the device to certificate selected at the Certificate Management page. Certificate Purpose Displays the connection to certificate selected at the Certificate Management page. Issued To Displays the list of certificate order. Validity Displays whether certificate is valid or not. Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool Certificate Details*2 Certificate Details Click to display the Certificate Details page. The SSL/TLS page is displayed when no item in the Issued To column is selected. Category Displays the device to certificate selected at the Certificate Management page or SSL/TLS page. Issued To Displays the device to certificate. Issuer Displays the issuer to certificate. Serial Number Displays the serial number of the device. Public Key Method Displays the public key method. Size of Public Key Displays the size of public key. Valid From Displays the time the certificate is valid. Valid Until Displays the time the certificate is invalid. Status Displays whether certificate is valid or not. Certificate Purpose Displays the purpose of certificate. Certificate Displays the type of device certificate you selected. Selection Status Certificate Signing Request (CSR) Details E-mail Address Displayed only when an e-mail address is specified in the certificate. Use this certificate Click to apply this certificate to the device. Delete Click to delete this certificate. Export This Certificate Click to export the certificate to the other device. 2 Letter Country Displays the details of the Certificate Signing Request (CSR). Code (Required) State / Province Name Locality Name Organization Name (Required) Organization Unit (Required) Common Name E-mail Address *1 *2 This item is available only when the self-signed certificate has been generated. This item is effective only when connected via SSL/TLS (https). Only the administrator is allowed to display the pages. IPsec Specifies the Security Architecture settings for Internet Protocol (IPsec) for encrypted communication to the printer. IPsec Settings Protocol Select the check box to enable the protocol. IKE Pre-Shared Key is displayed for IKE. Pre-Shared Key Sets a shared key. Up to 255 alphanumeric characters, periods, and hyphens can be used. Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool 177 Re-enter Enters the shared key again to check it. Pre-Shared Key IKE SA Lifetime Sets the lifetime for IKE SA from 5 to 28,800 minutes. IPsec SA Lifetime Sets the lifetime for IPsec SA from 5 to 2,880 minutes. DH Group Sets the DH group. PFS Select the check box to enable the PFS setting. Remote peers IPv4 address Sets the IP address to connect to. Remote peers IPv6 address Sets the IP address to connect to. Non IPsec Allows communication with a device which does not support IPsec. communication policy NOTE: • If IPsec is enabled with incorrect settings, you must disable it using the IPsec menu on the operator panel. 802.1x Specifies the settings for IEEE 802.1x authentication for encrypted communication to the printer. Configure 802.1x Enable IEEE 802.1x Select the check box to enable IEEE 802.1x authentication. Authentication EAP-MD5 Method Selects the authentication method to use for IEEE 802.1x authentication. EAP-MS-CHAPv PEAP/MS-CHAP v2 Login Name: (Device Name) Sets the login name (device name) for IEEE 802.1x authentication using up to 128 alphanumeric characters. Password Sets the login password for IEEE 802.1x authentication using up to 128 alphanumeric characters. Re-enter Password Confirms the set login password. NOTE: • This is available on Dell H625cdw and Dell H825cdw. IP Filter Specifies whether to enable IP filter feature, which allows to make settings of the IP filter feature used for LPD and Port9100. IPv4 Filter Enables or disables IPv4 Filter. IP Filter Rule List Add, edit, or delete IP filter rule. Up to 20 rules can be registered. IPv6 Filter Enables or disables IPv6 Filter. IP Filter Rule List Add, edit, or delete IP filter rule. Up to 20 rules can be registered. 178 Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool SMTP Domain Filtering Specifies whether to limit e-mail destination domains. NOTE: • This feature does not restrict sending e-mails through the E-Mail Alert feature. SMTP Domain Filtering Domain Filtering Select the check box to enable Domain Filtering. Allow Domain List Allows you to register up to five domains allowed for sending e-mails. Copy Printer Settings Copy Printer Settings The Copy Printer Settings tab includes the Copy Printer Settings and Copy Printer Settings Report pages. Copy Printer Settings Copies the printer settings to the printers of the same configuration model on the same network environment. NOTE: • Printer settings can be simultaneously copied to printers of up to 10 IP addresses. • You cannot copy the Address Book when the destination printer has a fax job. 1 Enter the IP address and password of the destination printer in the IP Address text box and Password text box. 2 Click the Copy the settings to the Host in the above list. button. Copying the settings is complete. NOTE: • The connection time-out period is 60 seconds. 3 Check the Copy the settings to the Host in the above list and reboot the printer menu of the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool in the destination printer to verify if the settings were successfully copied. NOTE: • If the destination printer settings are different, the settings of only the same items are copied. Copy Printer Settings Report Displays whether the printer setting is successfully copied to the destination printers. NOTE: • The history is cleared by turning off the printer. Print Volume Print Volume The Print Volume tab includes the Print Volume and Dell ColorTrack pages. Print Volume Displays the number of printed pages. This page can also be displayed by clicking Print Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool 179 Volume in the left frame. Printer Page Count Displays the total number of pages printed since the printer was shipped from the factory. Paper Used Displays the number of pages printed for each paper size. Dell ColorTrack Specifies which users have access to color printing and to limit print volume per user. ColorTrack Mode Off Enables to print the data with no authentication information. On Restricts printing based on the print user information registered in the internal server. Non Registered User Sets whether to permit the printing of data with no authentication information. To permit the printing for non-account user, select the check box. Auto Color To Mono Print Sets whether to print all print jobs in black and white even when color print is specified. ColorTrack Error Report Sets whether to automatically print error-related information if printing using ColorTrack results in an error. User Registration* Click Edit User Registration to display the Edit Print User Registration page. To register a user, click Create to open the Print User Settings page. To delete a user, click Delete to open the Delete User page. Clicking Back returns the screen to the status prior to deleting the user. To check or change the registered user, click Confirm / Change to open the Print User Settings page. User Registration No. Displays the user registration number. The Delete User button is displayed when the user is already registered. User Name Sets the user name. Password Sets the user password using 4 to 12 alphanumeric characters. Re-enter password Enter the password again to check it. Color Mode Limitation Sets whether to limit color printing. Upper Limit for Color Print Sets the maximum number of pages allowed for color printing. Cumulative Color Page Count Displays the cumulative number of pages printed for color printing. Upper Limit for Monochrome Print Sets the maximum number of pages allowed for monochrome printing. Cumulative Monochrome Page Count Displays the cumulative number of pages printed for monochrome printing. This item is displayed only when ColorTrack Mode is On. 180 Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool Address Book E-Mail Address The E-Mail Address tab includes the E-Mail Address, E-Mail Group and Default Setup pages. E-Mail Address Displays the e-mail address entries registered on the E-Mail Address page. Address List to: Selecting each button displays a list of entries for the group of user IDs indicated on the button. ID Displays the user ID. Name Displays the user name. (Not in Use) is displayed when there is no registration. Address Displays the e-mail address of the user. Delete Deletes the entry for the selected user ID. Confirm / Change Displays a dialog box where you can edit the entry of the selected user ID. Create Displays a dialog box where you can create a new entry under the selected user ID. E-Mail Address (Confirm/Change, Create) Displays or edits the e-mail address entries on the E-Mail Address page, or create a new entry. The following items are in the dialog box that appears when you click Confirm / Change or Create on the E-Mail Address top page. ID Displays the selected user ID. Name Allows you to view or edit the name of the user registered under the user ID, or enter a name for the new entry. Address Allows you to view or edit the e-mail address of the user, or enter an e-mail address for the new entry. Delete* This item is available only when you click Confirm / Change. E-Mail Address (Delete) Deletes the e-mail address entries registered on the E-Mail Address page. The following items are in the dialog box that appears when you click Delete on the E-Mail Address top page. E-Mail Group Displays the e-mail address entries registered on the E-Mail Group page. GroupID Displays the group ID. Name Displays the assigned group name. (Not in Use) is displayed when there is no registration. Delete Deletes the entry for the selected group ID. Confirm / Change Displays a dialog box where you can edit the entry for the selected group ID. Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool 181 Create Displays a dialog box where you can create a new entry under the selected group ID. E-Mail Group (Confirm/Change, Create) Displays or edits the e-mail address group entries on the E-Mail Group page, or create a new entry. The following items are in the dialog box that appears when you click Confirm / Change or Create on the E-Mail Group top page. E-Mail Group ID Displays the selected group ID. Name Allows you to view or edit the name assigned for the group ID, or enter a new group name. Delete* E-Mail Address Address List to: Selecting each button displays a list of entries for the group of IDs indicated on the button. ID Displays the user ID. Select the check box on the left to create the group. Name Displays the user name. (Not in Use) is displayed when there is no registration. Address Allows you to view or edit the e-mail address of an entry registered under the selected user ID, or enter an e-mail address for the new entry. This item is available only when you click Confirm / Change. E-Mail Group (Delete) Deletes the e-mail group entries registered on the E-Mail Group page. The following items are in the dialog box that appears when you click Delete on the E-Mail Group top page. Default Setup Sets the default e-mail subject and message. Default Subject Allows you to enter the default e-mail subject. Body Text Allows you to enter the default e-mail message. Server Address The Server Address tab includes the Server Address page. Server Address Displays the server address entries registered on the Server Address page. Address List to: Selecting each button displays a list of entries for the group of IDs indicated on the button. ID Displays the server ID. Name Displays the file directory name. (Not in Use) is displayed when there is no registration. Server Address Displays the address of the file directory. Delete Deletes the entry for the selected server ID. Confirm / Change Displays a dialog box where you can edit the entry for the selected server ID. 182 Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool Create Displays a dialog box where you can create a new entry under the selected server ID. Server Address (Confirm/Change, Create) Displays or edits the server address entries on the Server Address page, or create a new entry. The following items are in the dialog box that appears when you click Confirm / Change or Create on the Server Address top page. ID Displays the selected server ID. Name Allows you to view or change the server name assigned to the server ID, or enter a new server name. Server Type Allows you to view the server type if you click Confirm / Change. Allows you to edit the server type if you click Create. FTP*1 SMB *1 Select this to store scanned data on a server via the FTP protocol. Select this to store scanned data on a computer via the Server Message Block (SMB) protocol. Server Address Allows you to view or edit the server address registered under the server ID, or enter a new server address. Share Name*2 Allows you to view or edit the assigned shared name, or enter a new shared name, when Server Type is set to SMB. Server Path Allows you to view or edit the assigned server path, or enter a new path. Server Port Number Allows you to view or edit the assigned server port number, or enter a new port number. If you leave the text box blank, the default port number (FTP: 21, SMB: 139) is used. Login Name Allows you to view or edit the login name that is required to access the selected protocol, or enter a new login name. Login Password Allows you to view or edit the password that is required to access the selected protocol, or enter a new password. Re-enter Password Confirms the set password. Delete*3 *1 *2 *3 You can edit this item only when you click Create. This item is available only when Server Type is set to SMB. This item is available only when you click Confirm / Change. Server Address (Delete) Deletes the server address entries registered on the Server Address page. The following items are in the dialog box that appears when you click Delete on the Server Address top page. Phone Book The Phone Book tab includes the FAX Speed Dial and FAX Group pages. FAX Speed Dial Displays the fax number entries registered on the FAX Speed Dial page. Speed Dial List to: Selecting each button displays a list of entries for the group of speed dial codes indicated on the button. Speed Dial Displays the speed dial ID. Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool 183 Name Displays the assigned name for a speed dial ID. Phone Number Displays the speed dial code. (Not in Use) is displayed when there is no registration. Delete Deletes the entry for the selected speed dial code. Confirm / Change Displays a dialog box where you can edit the entry for the selected speed dial code. Create Displays a dialog box where you can create a new entry under the selected speed dial code. FAX Speed Dial (Confirm/Change, Create) Displays or edits the speed dial entries on the FAX Speed Dial page, or create a new entry. The following items are in the dialog box that appears when you click Confirm / Change or Create on the FAX Speed Dial top page. Speed Dial Displays the selected speed dial code. Name Allows you to view or edit the name of an entry registered under the speed dial code, or enter a name for the new entry. Phone Number Allows you to view or edit the fax number of an entry registered under the speed dial code, or enter a fax number for the new entry. Delete* Deletes the entry for the speed dial code. This button is available only on the dialog box for editing an existing entry. This item is available only when you click Confirm / Change. FAX Speed Dial (Delete) Deletes the speed dial entries registered on the FAX Speed Dial page. The following items are in the dialog box that appears when you click Delete on the FAX Speed Dial top page. FAX Group Displays the fax group entries registered on the FAX Group page. ID Displays a fax group ID. Name Displays the assigned group name. (Not in Use) is displayed when there is no registration. Delete Deletes the entry for the selected group ID. Confirm / Change Displays a dialog box where you can edit the entry for the selected group ID. Create Displays a dialog box where you can create a new entry under the selected group ID. FAX Group (Confirm/Change, Create) Displays or edits the fax number group entries on the FAX Group page, or create a new entry. The following items are in the dialog box that appears when you click Confirm / Change or Create on the FAX Group top page. FAX Group 184 ID Displays the selected group ID. Name Allows you to view or edit the name assigned for the group ID, or enter a new group name. Delete* Deletes the current entry. Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool FAX Speed Dial Speed Dial List to: Selecting each button displays a list of entries for the group of speed dial codes indicated on the button. Speed Dial Displays the speed dial code. Select the check box on the left to add the speed dial code in the group. Name Displays the name registered for the speed dial code. (Not in Use) is displayed when there is no registration. Phone Number Allows you to view or edit the fax number of an entry registered under the selected speed dial code, or enter a fax number for the new entry. This item is available only when you click Confirm / Change. FAX Group (Delete) Deletes the fax number group entries registered on the FAX Group page. The following items are in the dialog box that appears when you click Delete on the FAX Group top page. Tray Management Use the Tray Management menu to set the paper size and type of paper loaded in tray1 and the optional 550-sheet feeder. Tray Management Tray Settings MPF Mode Sets whether to use the print driver settings for the size and type of paper loaded in the Multipurpose Feeder (MPF). MPF Paper Size*1 Sets the size of paper loaded in the MPF. MPF Paper Type*1 Sets the type of paper loaded in the MPF. Sets the length of custom size paper loaded in the MPF. MPF Custom Paper Size - Y*1 MPF Custom Sets the width of custom size paper loaded in the MPF. Paper Size - X*1 MPF Display Tray Prompt*1 Sets whether to display a popup message that prompts the user to set the paper size and type when the paper is loaded in the MPF. Tray 1 Paper Size Sets the size of paper loaded in tray1. Tray 1 Paper Type Sets the type of paper loaded in tray1. Tray 1 Custom Paper Size - Y Sets the length of custom size paper loaded in tray1. Tray 1 Custom Paper Size - X Sets the width of custom size paper loaded in tray1. Tray 1 Display Tray Prompt Sets whether to display a popup message that prompts the user to set the paper size and type when the paper is loaded in tray1. Tray 2 Paper Size*2 Sets the size of paper loaded in the optional 550-sheet feeder. Tray 2 Paper Type*2 Sets the type of paper loaded in the optional 550-sheet feeder. Tray 2 Custom Sets the length of custom size paper loaded in the optional 550-sheet Paper Size - Y*2 feeder. Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool 185 Tray 2 Custom Sets the width of custom size paper loaded in the optional 550-sheet Paper Size - X*2 feeder. Tray Priority Tray 2 Display Tray Prompt*2 Sets whether to display a popup message that prompts the user to set the paper size and type when the paper is loaded in the optional 550-sheet feeder. 1st Priority Sets the paper source to be used as the first priority. 2nd Priority 3rd Priority *1 *2 *2 Sets the paper source to be used as the second priority. Sets the paper source to be used as the third priority. This item is available only when Use Panel Settings in MPF Mode is selected. This item is available only when the optional 550-sheet feeder is installed. 186 Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool Print Media Guidelines This section describes selecting and caring for print media. The printer provides high-quality printing on a variety of print media. Selecting the appropriate print media for the printer helps to avoid printing troubles. NOTE: • Use only laser print media. Do not use ink jet print media in the printer. To help avoiding jam, see "Before Loading." Supported Print Media Multipurpose Feeder (MPF) Paper Size A4 (210 × 297 mm) B5 (182 × 257 mm) A5 (148 × 210 mm) B6 (128 × 182 mm) A6 (105 × 148 mm) Letter (8.5 × 11 inches) Folio (8.5 × 13 inches) Legal (8.5 × 14 inches) Executive (7.25 × 10.5 inches) Statement (5.5 × 8.5 inches) Envelope #10 (104.8 × 241.3 mm) Monarch (98.4 × 190.5 mm) DL (110 × 220 mm) C5 (162 × 229 mm) Custom*1: Width: 76.2 – 215.9 mm (3 – 8.5 inches) Length: 127 – 355.6 mm (5 – 14 inches) Print Media Guidelines 187 Paper Type Plain (Light) Plain (Normal) Plain (Thick) Covers (Thin)*2 Covers (Thick)*2 Rough Surface*2 Coated (Normal)*2 Coated (Thick)*2 Label (Light)*2 Label (Normal)*2 Envelope*2 Recycled Letterhead*2 Preprinted*2 Prepunched*2 Color Loading Capacity *1 *2 50 sheets of the standard paper XML Paper Specification (XPS) driver does not support custom size paper. Paper type that does not support printing on the back side of printed paper. Tray1 Paper Size A4 (210 × 297 mm) B5 (182 × 257 mm) A5 (148 × 210 mm) B6 (128 × 182 mm) A6 (105 × 148 mm) Letter (8.5 × 11 inches) Folio (8.5 × 13 inches) Legal (8.5 × 14 inches) Executive (7.25 × 10.5 inches) Statement (5.5 × 8.5 inches) Envelope #10 (104.8 × 241.3 mm) Monarch (98.4 × 190.5 mm) DL (110 × 220 mm) C5 (162 × 229 mm) Custom*1: Width: 76.2 – 215.9 mm (3 – 8.5 inches) Length: 148 – 355.6 mm (5.8 – 14 inches) 188 Print Media Guidelines Paper Type Plain (Light) Plain (Normal) Plain (Thick) Covers (Thin)*2 Covers (Thick)*2 Coated (Normal)*2 Coated (Thick)*2 Labels (Light)*2 Labels (Normal)*2 Envelope*2 Recycled Letterhead*2 Preprinted*2 Prepunched*2 Color Loading Capacity *1 *2 250 sheets of the standard paper XML Paper Specification (XPS) driver does not support custom size paper. Paper type that does not support printing on the back side of printed paper. Optional 550-Sheet Feeder Paper Size A4 (210 × 297 mm) B5 (182 × 257 mm) A5 (148 × 210 mm) Letter (8.5 × 11 inches) Folio (8.5 × 13 inches) Legal (8.5 × 14 inches) Executive (7.25 × 10.5 inches) Custom*1: Width: 76.2 – 215.9 mm (3 – 8.5 inches) Length: 190.5 – 355.6 mm (7.5 – 14 inches) Paper Type Plain (Light) Plain (Normal) Plain (Thick) Covers (Thin)*2 Covers (Thick)*2 Coated (Normal)*2 Labels (Light)*2 Labels (Normal)*2 Recycled Letterhead*2 Preprinted*2 Prepunched*2 Color Loading Capacity 550 sheets of the standard paper Print Media Guidelines 189 *1 *2 XML Paper Specification (XPS) driver does not support custom size paper. Paper type that does not support printing on the back side of printed paper. NOTE: • For Plain and Label paper, you can preset the paper density by selecting the Paper Density (Light or Normal) under Maintenance from the operator panel, Tool Box, or Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool. Once you set the Paper Density settings, the printer uses the settings for Plain and Label paper. Supported Paper Weight Paper type Weight (g/m2) Plain 60 – 90 Plain Thick 91 – 105 Recycled 60 – 90 Labels – Covers 106 – 176 Covers Thick 177 – 220 Envelope – Coated 106 – 176 Coated Thick 177 – 220 Letterhead 60 – 90 Preprinted 60 – 90 Prepunched 60 – 90 Color 60 – 90 Unacceptable Print Media • • • • • • • • • Chemically treated paper used to make copies without carbon paper, also known as carbonless paper, carbonless copy paper (CCP), or no carbon required (NCR) paper Pre-printed paper with chemicals that may contaminate the printer Pre-printed paper that can be affected by the temperature in the fusing unit Pre-printed paper that requires a registration (the precise print location on the page) greater than ±0.09 inch, such as Optical Character Recognition (OCR) forms. In some cases, you can adjust registration with your software program to successfully print on these forms. Erasable bond, synthetic paper, and thermal paper Rough-edged, rough or heavily textured surface paper, or curled paper Recycled paper containing more than 25% post-consumer waste that does not meet DIN 19309 Multiple-part forms or documents Talc or acid paper that may deteriorate print quality (blank spaces or blotches may appear in the text) Recommended Print Media Proper print media selection helps prevent jams and ensures trouble-free printing. • For the best print quality and feed reliability, use 75 g/m2 (20 lb) xerographic paper. 190 Print Media Guidelines • • • For the best print quality in black and white, use 90 g/m2 (24 lb) xerographic, grain long paper. Print media designed for general business use also provides acceptable print quality. Laser printing process heats print media to high temperatures. Only use paper able to withstand high temperatures without discoloring, bleeding, or releasing hazardous emissions. Check with the manufacturer or vendor to determine whether the paper you have chosen is acceptable for laser printers. Recommended Pre-Printed Media and Letterheads • • • • • • Use grain long paper for best results. Use only forms and letterheads printed using an offset lithographic or engraved printing process. Use print media that absorb ink, but does not bleed. Avoid print media with rough or heavily textured surfaces. Use print media printed with heat-resistant inks designed for use in xerographic copying machines. The ink must withstand temperatures of 225°C (437°F) without melting or releasing hazardous emissions. Use print media printed with inks that are not affected by the resin in the toner or the silicone in the fusing unit. Inks that are oxidation-set or oil-based should meet these requirements; latex inks might not. If you are in doubt, contact your paper supplier. Recommended Pre-Punched Print Media • • • • Use only pre-punched paper made at the paper manufacturer. Do not drill print media which are already packaged in a ream. Using them may result in paper jams. Pre-punched print media can include more paper dust than standard print media. The printer may require more frequent cleaning, and feed reliability may not be as good as standard print media. Weight guidelines for pre-punched print media are the same as non-punched print media. Recommended Envelopes Depending on the envelopes, it is possible to expect variable levels of wrinkling. • Use only high-quality envelopes that are designed for use in laser printers. • Use envelopes made from 75 g/m2 (20 lb bond) paper. You can use up to 105 g/m2 (28 lb bond) weight for the envelope feeder as long as the cotton content is 25% or less. Envelopes with 100% cotton content must not exceed 90 g/m2 (24 lb bond) weight. • Use envelopes that can withstand temperatures of 205°C (401°F) without sealing, excessive curling, wrinkling, or releasing hazardous emissions. If you are in doubt, contact your envelope supplier. • Check for high humidity. High humidity (higher than 60%) and high printing temperature may seal the envelopes. • Do not use envelopes that: – Have excessive curl or twist Print Media Guidelines 191 – Are stuck together or damaged in any way – Contain windows, coated linings, self-stick adhesives, holes, perforations, cutouts, or embossing – Use metal clasps, string ties, or metal folding bars – Have an interlocking design – Have postage stamps attached – Have any exposed adhesive when the flap is in the sealed or closed position – Have nicked edges or bent corners – Have rough, cockle, or laid finishes Recommended Labels • • • • • Label adhesives, face sheet, and topcoats must be able to withstand temperatures of 205°C (401°F) and pressure of 25 pounds per square inch (psi) without sealing, excessive curling, wrinkling, or releasing hazardous emissions. Use labels without sealing, excessive curling, wrinkling, or releasing hazardous emissions. Do not use label sheets with a slick backing material. Do not use labels that have exposed adhesive. Do not use label sheets that have adhesive to the edge of the sheet. It is recommended that zone coating of the adhesive is done at least 1 mm (0.04 inch) away from edges. Otherwise, a jam may occur in the printer, and adhesive material may contaminate the printer and cartridges. WARNING: • Contaminating the printer and cartridges with adhesive could void your printer and cartridge warranties. Print Media Storage Guidelines For proper print media storage, the following guidelines help you to avoid print media feeding problems and uneven print quality. • Store print media in an environment where the temperature is approximately 21°C (70°F) and the relative humidity is 40%. • Store print media on a flat surface so that the edges do not buckle or curl. • Print media should be stored on pallets, cartons, shelves, or in cabinets, rather than directly on the floor. • Do not place anything on top of the print media packages. 192 Print Media Guidelines Loading Print Media Loading print media properly helps prevent jams and ensures trouble-free printing. Before loading any print media, identify the recommended print side of the print media. This information is usually indicated on the print media package. Before Loading The following instructions describe how to avoid paper jams: • Use only laser print media. Do not use ink jet paper in the printer. • Use only recommended print media. See "Print Media Guidelines." • Keep print media stored in an acceptable environment. See "Print Media Storage Guidelines." • Do not overload the print media sources. Make sure that the print media stack height does not exceed the maximum height indicated by the load-line labels in the tray. • Do not load wrinkled, creased, damp, or curled print media. • Flex, fan, and straighten the print media before loading. • Do not use print media that you have cut or trimmed. • Do not mix different print media sizes, weights, or types in the same print media source. • Make sure that the recommended print side is facing up when you load the print media. • Do not remove the feeding tray during printing. • Make sure that all cables that connect to the printer are attached correctly. • Overtightening the guides may cause jams. • If jams caused by misfeeding paper occur frequently, wipe the retard rollers in the tray or Multipurpose Feeder (MPF) with a cloth moistened with water. Loading Print Media in Tray1 and the Optional 550-Sheet Feeder NOTE: • To avoid paper jams, do not remove the tray while printing is in progress. 1 For the optional 550-sheet feeder, pull the tray halfway out of the printer. For Tray1, proceed to step 2. Loading Print Media 193 2 Hold the tray with both hands, and then remove it from the printer. 3 Adjust the paper guides according to the paper size that you want to load. NOTE: • When you load Legal-size paper, extend the tray while pushing the lever located on the front part of the tray. 194 Loading Print Media 4 Before loading the print media, flex and fan the sheets. Straighten the edges of the stack on a level surface. 5 Load the print media into the tray with the recommended print side facing up. NOTE: • Do not exceed the maximum fill line in the tray. Overfilling the tray may cause paper jams. • When loading coated paper, load one sheet at a time. • When loading letterhead, pre-printed, or pre-punched paper, see "Loading Letterhead, Pre-Printed, and Pre-Punched Paper." 6 Make sure that paper guides rest lightly against the edge of the print media stack. NOTE: • Overtightening the guides may cause jams. NOTE: • When loading user-specified print media, adjust the width guides and slide the extendable part of the tray by pinching the length guide and sliding it until it rests lightly against the edge of the paper. 7 Insert the tray into the printer and push until it stops. Loading Print Media 195 NOTE: • If the front side of the tray is extended, the tray protrudes when it is inserted into the printer. 8 When the Tray Configuration screen appears, tap Size. The following shows the Tray1 screen as an example. NOTE: • Set the same paper size and type as the actual paper being loaded. An error may occur if the paper size or type setting is different from the loaded paper. 9 Select or paper size. until the desired paper size appears, and then select the desired 10 Tap Type. 11 Select or paper type. 196 until the desired paper type appears, and then select the desired Loading Print Media 12 Tap OK. Loading Envelopes in the Tray1 NOTE: • Use only recommended envelopes. See "Recommended Envelopes." The following guidelines describe how to load envelopes. • Use only freshly unpackaged and undamaged envelopes. If you do not load envelopes in the tray right after they have been removed from the package, they may bulge. To avoid jams, press firmly across the whole envelopes to flatten them as shown in the illustration before loading the envelopes in the tray. Feed direction • • • • Use only same size envelopes for a single print job. The maximum height (quantity) of envelopes that can be loaded in the tray is approximately 27.5 mm (1.08 inch) (20 envelopes). When printing on envelopes, set the print media source to the tray. From the print driver, select Envelope for the paper type, and then select the correct size of the envelope. Adjust the paper guides accordingly after envelopes are loaded. Envelope #10, Monarch, or DL Load the envelopes with the flaps closed and the print side facing up. Make sure that the flaps are on the left side when you face towards the printer. C5 When loading envelopes with the flaps open, load the envelopes so that the print side Loading Print Media 197 faces up and the bottom edge (the edge with no flaps) enters the printer first. When loading envelopes with the flaps closed, load the envelopes so that the print side faces up and the top edge (the edge with flaps) enters the printer first. Loading Print Media in the Multipurpose Feeder (MPF) NOTE: • Do not add or remove print media when there is still print media in the MPF or when the printer is printing from the MPF. This may result in a paper jam. • Do not place objects on the MPF. • Do not apply excessive force on the MPF or press it down. • If a jam occurs with print media, feed one sheet at a time through the MPF. • The label on the MPF shows how to load the MPF with paper, and how to turn an envelope for printing. 1 Gently pull and open the MPF cover. NOTE: • Extend the extension tray as necessary. 198 Loading Print Media 2 Slide the width guides according to the paper size that you want to load. 3 Insert all print media facing up and top edge first into the MPF. NOTE: • Do not force the print media into the MPF. • When loading coated paper, load one sheet at a time. • When loading letterhead, pre-printed, or pre-punched paper, see "Loading Letterhead, Pre-Printed, and Pre-Punched Paper." 4 Make sure that both width guides rest lightly against the edge of the print media stack. NOTE: • Overtightening the guides may cause jams. Loading Print Media 199 5 When the MPF Configuration screen appears, tap Size. 6 Tap or until the desired paper size appears, and then select the size. 7 Tap Type. 8 Tap or until the desired paper type appears, and then select the type. 9 Tap OK. Loading Envelopes in the MPF NOTE: • Use only recommended envelopes. See "Recommended Envelopes." The following guidelines describe how to load envelopes. • Use only freshly unpackaged and undamaged envelopes. If you do not load envelopes in the MPF right after they have been removed from the package, they may bulge. To avoid jams, press firmly across the whole envelopes to flatten them as shown in the illustration before loading the envelopes in the MPF. Feed direction • • • • 200 Use only same size envelopes for a single print job. The maximum height (quantity) of envelopes that can be loaded in the MPF is approximately 5 mm (0.19 inch) (5 envelopes). When printing on envelopes, set the print media source to the MPF. From the print driver, select Envelope for the paper type, and then select the correct size of the envelope. Adjust the width guides accordingly after envelopes are loaded. Loading Print Media Envelope #10, Monarch, or DL Load the envelopes with the flaps closed and the print side facing up. Make sure that the flaps are on the left side when you face towards the printer. C5 When loading envelopes with the flaps open, load the envelopes with the print side facing up and the bottom edge first into the MPF. When loading envelopes with the flaps closed, load the envelopes with the print side facing up and the top edge first into the MPF. Loading Labels in the MPF NOTE: • Use only recommended labels. See "Recommended Labels." The following guidelines describe how to load labels: • Do not load labels in the MPF together with other types of paper. • Use full label sheets. Partial sheets may cause labels to peel off during printing, resulting in a jam. • Set the paper type to Label from the print driver. Loading Print Media 201 • • • • Portrait orientation is preferred, especially when printing bar codes. Do not print within 1 mm (0.04 inch) of the die-cut. Do not print within 1 mm (0.04 inch) of the edge of the label, of the perforations, or between die-cuts of the label. Do not print a label through the printer more than once. Loading Letterhead, Pre-Printed, and Pre-Punched Paper Letterhead, pre-printed, and pre-punched paper must be inserted bottom edge first with the print side facing down as shown in the following illustration. NOTE: • Make sure that Letterhead 2 Sided or Letterhead Duplex Mode is set to Enable, and Type is set to Letterhead, Preprinted, or Prepunched on the operator panel even when printing on a single side. You can also set the same setting using the print driver. For Tray1 and optional 550-sheet feeder: • Face up • Letterhead enters the printer first. AD HE ER TT LE For MPF: • Face up • Letterhead enters the printer first. EA ER LET Linking Trays The printer links the trays when you load the same size and type of print media in them. The first tray is utilized until the print media runs out after which the next tray is used. NOTE: • The print media should be the same size and type in each tray. The Multipurpose Feeder (MPF) cannot be linked to any of the tray sources. After loading the selected trays with the same size and type of print media, select the 202 Loading Print Media Paper Type setting in the Tray Settings component for each tray. To disable tray linking, change the paper type for one of the trays to a unique value. NOTE: • If different types of print media of the same size are loaded in the trays, the printer links them if the paper type is not specified in the print driver properties/preferences. Loading Print Media 203 Loading Documents You can use the Duplex Automatic Document Feeder (DADF) or the document glass to load a document. Using the DADF, you can load up to 50 sheets of 75 g/m2 (20 lb) paper at a time. Using the document glass, you can load one sheet at a time. NOTE: • To get the best scan quality, especially for color or gray scale images, use the document glass instead of the DADF. Before Loading Documents in the DADF The following instructions describe how to avoid paper jams: • Do not use document smaller than 139.7 mm by 139.7 mm (5.5 inches by 5.5 inches) and larger than 215.9 mm by 355.6 mm (8.5 inches by 14 inches) • Do not use booklets, pamphlets, photographs, transparencies, and documents having other unusual characteristics. • Do not use carbon or carbon-backed paper, coated paper, onion skin or thin paper, wrinkled or creased paper, curled or rolled paper, and torn paper. • Do not use documents with staples or paper clips. • Do not use documents exposed to adhesives or solvent based materials such as glue, ink and correcting fluid. • Do not use document that you have cut or trimmed. • Do not use wrinkled, creased, damp, or curled document. • Do not mix different sizes, weights, or types of document in the DADF. • Flex, fan, and straighten document before you load it. • Do not overload the DADF. Make sure that the document stack height does not exceed the maximum height indicated by the load-line labels in the DADF. • If jams caused by misfeeding paper occur frequently, wipe the DADF feed rollers with a cloth moistened with water. Loading a Document in the Duplex Automatic Document Feeder (DADF) 1 Adjust the document guides according to the document size that you want to load, and place the document(s) facing up with the top edge of the document(s) first into the DADF. 204 Loading Documents NOTE: • Overtightening the guides may cause jams. • Before loading the document(s) on the DADF, straighten the edges of the stack of the document(s). • Use the document stopper when copying a legal-size document. Loading a Document on the Document Glass NOTE: • Make sure that no document is in the DADF. If any document is detected in the DADF, it takes priority over the document on the document glass. 1 Open the document cover. 2 Place the document facing down on the document glass and align it with the registration guide on the top left corner of the glass. Loading Documents 205 3 Close the document cover. NOTE: • Leaving the document cover open while copying may affect the copy quality and increase the toner consumption. • If you are copying/scanning/faxing a page from a book or magazine, lift the cover until its hinges are caught by the stopper and then close the cover. If the book or magazine is thicker than 30 mm, start copying/scanning/faxing with the cover open. 206 Loading Documents 4 Printing, Copying, Scanning, Faxing, and Dell Document Hub Printing 208 Copying 217 Scanning 220 Faxing 245 Dell™ Document Hub (Windows® Only) 262 207 Printing This chapter covers tips for printing, how to print certain information from the printer, and how to cancel a job. NOTE: • Selecting the appropriate print media and loading them properly into the paper tray is key to producing good quality prints and reducing paper jams. See "Print Media Guidelines" and "Loading Print Media." Sending a Job to Print NOTE: • Print settings made from the print driver have precedence over the menu settings made from the operator panel or Tool Box. • If you are not familiar with a feature in the print driver window, open the online Help for more information. The following procedure uses a typical Windows® and OS X program as an example. 1 Open the file you want to print. 2 From the File menu, select Print. 3 Check that the correct printer is selected in the dialog box, and then check and change the print settings in the dialog box. 4 For Windows®, click Preferences, adjust print settings that are not available in the dialog box, and then click OK. For OS X, proceed to step 5. 5 Click Print. NOTE: • You can switch the paper size loaded in the tray between A4 and letter. Also, you can switch the paper size between A5 and statement. When you want to switch the page size, load the print media of the selected size. See "A4<>Letter Switch" and "A5<>Statement Switch." Canceling a Print Job You can cancel a job using the operator panel or a computer. Canceling a Job From the Operator Panel Canceling a Job While Print Is in Progress Tap Stop. The print job in progress is canceled. NOTE: • All the following jobs are not canceled. Canceling a Job Before Printing Starts 1 Press the (Job Status) button. 2 Tap the job you want to cancel. 208 Printing 3 Tap Stop Stop Job. Canceling a Job From a Computer Canceling a Job From the Taskbar (Windows® Only) When you send a job to print, a small printer icon appears in the bottom right corner of the taskbar. 1 Double-click the printer icon. A list of print jobs appears in the printer window. 2 Select the job you want to cancel. 3 Press on the keyboard. Canceling a Job From the Dock (OS X Only) When you send a job to print, the printer icon appears in the Dock. The following procedure uses OS X 10.10 as an example. 1 Click the printer icon. A list of print jobs appears in the printer window. 2 Click the delete job button on the right. Duplex Printing The duplex printing feature allows you to print on both sides of a sheet of paper. NOTE: • The duplex printing feature does not support thick cover paper, thick coated paper, labels, and envelopes. Using Duplex Print For Windows®: The following procedure uses a typical Windows® program on Windows® 7/Windows® 10 as an example. 1 Open the file you want to print. 2 Open the print dialog box from the program. 3 Select the print driver, and then click Preferences. 4 In the Paper Source drop-down list box, select a paper tray. 5 In the Duplex drop-down list box, select Flip on Short Edge or Flip on Long Edge. NOTE: • For details about the Flip on Short Edge and Flip on Long Edge options, see "Flip on Short Edge" and "Flip on Long Edge." 6 Click OK. 7 Click OK or Print. Printing 209 For OS X: The following procedure uses TextEdit on OS X 10.10 as an example. 1 Open the file you want to print. 2 Open the print dialog box from the program. 3 In the TextEdit drop-down list box, click Printer Features. 4 In the Feature Sets drop-down list box, click Paper Handling. 5 In the Duplex drop-down list box, select Flip on Short Edge or Flip on Long Edge. 6 Click Print. Using Booklet Print The booklet print feature prints a document as a booklet. The pages are arranged in the correct order when the printout is collated or stapled. NOTE: • When the XML Paper Specification (XPS) or PostScript (PS) driver is used, booklet print is not available. • You must select Flip on Long Edge in the Duplex when using the Booklet Print feature. Flip on Long Edge Assumes binding along the long edge of the page (left edge for portrait orientation and top edge for landscape orientation). The following illustration shows long-edge binding for portrait and landscape pages: Portrait 210 Printing Landscape Flip on Short Edge Assumes binding along the short edge of the page (top edge for portrait orientation and left edge for landscape orientation). The following illustration shows short-edge binding for portrait and landscape pages: Portrait Landscape Using Stored Print When you send a job to the printer, you can specify in the print driver to store the job in the memory. When you are ready to print the job, go to the printer and use the operator panel to identify which job in the memory you want to print. NOTE: • The data in the memory is cleared when the printer is turned off. • The Stored Print feature is available when: - The RAM disk is enabled in the printer menu. - RAM Disk is set to Available in the print driver. Overview The Stored Print feature includes the following job types. Read each description to select optimum job type for your print job. If you want to print confidential documents, see "Secure Print" and "Private Mail Box Print." If you want to store the print job in the printer for re-printing, see "Private Mail Box Print" and "Public Mail Box Print." If you want to prevent large number of misprinted copies, see "Proof Print." Secure Print You can temporarily store print jobs secured with a password in the memory. Users with the password can print them from the operator panel. This feature can be used to print confidential documents. A stored print job is deleted after you print it or at a designated time. Printing 211 Send confidential data. Enter the password from the operator panel. Print data. Confidential Data is deleted at a designated time. Private Mail Box Print You can store print jobs in the printer for re-printing with a password. The stored jobs remain in the printer until you delete them from the operator panel. Only users with the password can print them from the operator panel. This feature can be used to print confidential documents. Send data. Enter the password from the operator panel. Print data. Public Mail Box Print You can store print jobs in the printer for re-printing without a password. The stored jobs remain in the printer until you delete them from the operator panel. Any user can print them from the operator panel. Print data. Send data. Proof Print The collated print job is stored in the memory, but a single copy is printed so you can check the print result. If you do not have problems with the print result, you can choose to print more copies. This prevents large number of misprinted copies. 212 Printing One set is printed. Send data. Print the rest of sets from the operator panel. Check if the print result is OK. Procedures for Printing Stored Print NOTE: • The Stored Print feature is not available when a print job is too large for the available memory. • The Stored Print feature is available when using the Printer Control Language (PCL) or PostScript (PS) driver. Storing Print Jobs With the Print Driver To use the Stored Print feature, you need to select Secure Print, Proof Print, Private Mailbox, or Public Mailbox from Job Type in the General tab of the print driver. The job is stored in the memory until you request to print it from the operator panel. NOTE: • You must specify a password for the Secure Print and Private Mail Box Print jobs. • If a document name is not assigned to your print job in the print driver, the job's name is identified using the printer's time and date of submission to distinguish it from other jobs you have stored under your name. Printing the Stored Jobs From the Operator Panel 1 Press the (Home) button. Print. 2 Tap 3 Select a job type. If the desired job type is not displayed, swipe the screen. 4 Select the desired user ID. If the desired document is not displayed, tap or to scroll through the screen. If you have selected Secure Print or Private Mailbox in step 3, enter the password using the number pad, and then tap OK. NOTE: • If you enter an invalid password, the message Incorrect password Try again. appears. Tap Close to return to the screen for entering the password. 5 Select the desired document. If the desired document is not displayed, tap or to scroll through the screen. To specify the number of copies, tap Quantity. NOTE: • For Secure Print, Quantity is not available. 6 For Secure Print, tap Print and Delete. Printing 213 For Private Mailbox Print, tap Print. NOTE: • For Secure Print, the data in the memory is deleted after printing. • For Private Mailbox Print, you can delete the data in the memory after printing if you select the Print and Delete check box. 7 Tap OK. The stored job will be printed. Deleting Stored Jobs With Secure Print, a job that has been stored is deleted after printing or deleted at a designated time entered on the operator panel. For other jobs, these jobs remain stored until you delete them from the operator panel. To delete the stored jobs: 1 Press the (Home) button. Print. 2 Tap 3 Select a job type. If the desired job type is not displayed, swipe the screen. 4 Select the desired user ID. If the desired document is not displayed, tap or to scroll through the screen. If you have selected Secure Print or Private Mailbox in step 3, enter the password using the number pad, and then tap OK. NOTE: • If you enter an invalid password, the message Incorrect password Try again. appears. Tap Close to return to the screen for entering the password. 5 Select the desired document. If the desired document is not displayed, tap or to scroll through the screen. 6 Tap Delete. Printing From USB Flash Drive The USB Direct Print feature allows you to print files stored in a USB flash drive without using a computer. CAUTION: • To prevent damage to the printer, do not connect any device other than a USB flash drive to the front USB port of the printer. • Do not remove the USB flash drive from the front USB port until the printer has finished printing. NOTE: • If the Functions Control setting is set to On (Password), you need to enter the four-digit password to use the function. If the Functions Control setting is set to Off, the function is disabled and the menu is not displayed on the screen. See "Functions Control." Supported USB Flash Drive For the front USB port of the printer, you can use a USB flash drive with the following specification: 214 Printing • • • • USB 2.0 and 1.1 Type A connector Metal shielded FAT16, FAT32, or VFAT file system NOTE: • If the USB flash drive is formatted in a file system other than the above, the printer may not detect the USB flash drive. • A USB flash drive with authentication feature and some brands of USB flash drive cannot be used with this printer. Supported File Formats Files in the following file formats can be printed directly from a USB flash drive: • PDF • TIFF • JPEG Printing a PDF/TIFF or JPEG File in a USB Flash Drive 1 Press the (Home) button. 2 Insert a USB flash drive to the front USB port of the printer. 3 Tap Print PDF/TIFF or Print JPEG. 4 Select the desired file. If the desired file is not displayed, swipe the screen or tap folders. NOTE: • Only the following characters are displayed on the touch panel: A B C D E F G H I J K L M N O P Q R S T U V W X Y Z 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 $ % ’ ‘ - @ {} ~ ! # ( ) & _ ^ • Up to 10 PDF/TIFF or 100 JPEG files can be selected and printed in display order. 5 Tap , and then check and change the print settings. See "Print Settings." Printing 215 6 Tap Print. CAUTION: • Do not remove the USB flash drive while the printer is accessing the drive. The data in the drive may be destroyed, or the drive itself may be damaged and become unusable. NOTE: • Color printing is secured with a password if the Functions Control setting for USB Direct Print is set to On(Color Password). If you set Output Color to Full Color and the Functions Control setting for USB Direct Print to On(Color Password), you are required to enter the four-digit password. • Only PDF/TIFF or JPEG files created using the scan function of the printer can be printed through the USB Direct Print feature. 7 Remove the USB flash drive from the printer. CAUTION: • Make sure that the printer is not accessing the USB flash drive. Printer Settings You can change most of the print settings from the program you are printing from. Settings from the program update the default system settings for the printer. Settings from the print driver only apply to the job that you are currently sending to the printer. If you cannot change a setting from the program, use the operator panel, Tool Box on the Dell Printer Hub/Dell Print Management Tool, or the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool. Changing a system setting from the operator panel, Tool Box, or Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool makes that setting the user default. You can verify the detailed system settings by printing a system settings report. For details about how to print a system settings report, see "Report / List." You can reset settings to their default values from the operator panel. See "Resetting Defaults." To specify your own default settings: 1 Press the (Information) button. If Panel Lock Control is set to Enable, enter the password. See "Panel Lock." 2 Tap the Tools tab Admin Settings. 3 Tap PCL, PS, or PDF. 4 Select the desired menu item. If the desired menu item is not displayed, tap or to scroll through the screen. 5 Select the desired setting or enter the value, and then tap OK. 6 Repeat steps 4 and 5 as needed. 216 Printing Copying NOTE: • If the Functions Control setting is set to On (Password), you need to enter the four-digit password to use the function. If the Functions Control setting is set to Off, the function is disabled and the menu is not displayed on the screen. See "Functions Control." Making Copies From the Document Glass NOTE: • A computer connection is not required for copying. • Remove any documents from the Duplex Automatic Document Feeder (DADF) before copying from the document glass. • Contaminants on the document glass may cause black spots on the copy output. For best results, clean the document glass before use. See "Cleaning the Scanner." 1 Place a single document facing down on the document glass, and then close the document cover. See "Loading Documents." 2 Press the (Home) button. Copy. 3 Tap 4 Check and change the copy settings. See "Copy." 5 In Quantity, tap – or + to specify the number of copies. 6 Tap Copy. NOTE: • To cancel a copy job, tap Stop at any time while scanning a document. Making Copies From the DADF CAUTION: • Do not load more than 50 sheets into the DADF or allow more than 50 sheets to be fed to the document output tray. The document output tray should be emptied before it exceeds 50 sheets or your documents may be damaged. NOTE: • A computer connection is not required for copying. 1 Load the document(s). See "Loading Documents." 2 Press the 3 Tap (Home) button. Copy. 4 Check and change the copy settings. See "Copy." 5 In Quantity, tap – or + to specify the number of copies. Copying 217 6 Tap Copy. NOTE: • To cancel a copy job, tap Stop at any time while scanning a document. Using the ID Copy NOTE: • If the Functions Control setting is set to Disable, the function is disabled and the menu is not displayed on the screen. See "Functions Control." You can copy both sides of an ID card on one side of a single sheet of paper in its original size by tapping ID Copy on the touch panel. This feature helps to show both sides of an ID card in one page in its original size. 1 Place an ID card facing down on the document glass, and then close the document cover. See "Loading Documents." 2 Press the (Home) button. ID Copy. 3 Tap 4 Check and change the copy settings. See "Copy." 5 In Quantity, tap – or + to specify the number of copies. 6 Tap Copy. NOTE: • Color copy is secured with a password if the Functions Control setting for Copy is set to On(Color Password). If you set Output Color to Full Color and the Functions Control setting for Copy to On(Color Password), you are required to enter the four-digit password. After the front side of the ID card is scanned, the screen prompts you to turn over the card. To copy the back side: a Turn the ID card over. b Tap Continue. To copy only one side: a Tap Print Now. Changing the Default Copy Settings The default settings of the copy menu options such as Output Color, Select Tray, and Darken/Lighten can be set to the most frequently used modes. When you copy a document, the specified default settings are used unless they are changed using the operator panel. The settings on Default Settings will be reflected when you create a new tile. If you change the settings on Default Settings after creating the new tile, it does not affect the settings of the tile you created earlier. See "Adding a New Tile." NOTE: • You can set the same setting using the Tool Box on the Dell Printer Hub/Dell Print Management Tool or Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool. See the help on the Tool Box or "Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool." 218 Copying To specify your own default settings: 1 Press the (Information) button. 2 Tap the Tools tab Default Settings 3 Select the desired menu item. If the desired menu item is not displayed, tap Copy Defaults. or to scroll through the screen. 4 Select the desired setting or enter the value, and then tap OK. 5 Repeat steps 3 and 4 as needed. Copying 219 Scanning NOTE: • If the Functions Control setting is set to On (Password), you need to enter the four-digit password to use the function. If the Functions Control setting is set to Off, the function is disabled and the menu is not displayed on the screen. See "Functions Control." Scanning Overview The printer provides several ways to scan your document. There are two main scanning types. One is operated on the printer side without using the scanner driver, and the other is operated on the computer side using a software and the scanner driver. The following illustration shows overview for each scanning type. Computer/ Mobile Device Operate from the Printer "Scanning to a Computer With a USB Connection” “Scanning to a Computer With a Network Connection" Operate from the Computer/Mobile Device "Scanning From a Computer Using Web Services on Devices (WSD)" “Scanning Using the TWAIN Driver" "Scanning Using the Windows® Image Acquisition (WIA) Driver” "Scanning Using Wi-Fi Direct" Scan FTP Server/ Shared Folder "Scanning to a Computer or Server With SMB/FTP" E-mail "Sending a Scanned Data via E-Mail" USB "Scanning to a USB Flash Drive" The resolution setting to use when you scan an item depends on the item type and how you plan to use the image or document after you scan it to your computer. For the best results, use these recommended settings. Type Resolution Documents 300 dpi black-and-white or 200 dpi grayscale or color Documents of poor quality or that contain small text 400 dpi black-and-white or 300 dpi grayscale Photographs and pictures 100–200 dpi color or 200 dpi grayscale Images for an inkjet printer 150–300 dpi Images for a high-resolution printer 300–600 dpi Scanning above the recommended resolutions may exceed the capabilities of the 220 Scanning program. To scan above the recommended resolutions, preview (or pre-scan) and crop the image to reduce the size before scanning the image. Tips for Easy Network Scanning • • The network scanning with the Scan to Computer feature is recommended if you are not familiar with the network scanning setup. It provides the simple and easy steps for your convenience. For details, see "Scanning to a Computer With a Network Connection." Before using the Scan to Network Folder feature, configure the network connection details using the Address Book Editor if you are not familiar with the setup using the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool. The Address Book Editor helps to register the scanning destination details to the printer. Scanning to a Computer With a USB Connection You can send scanned data from the operator panel to a computer connected via USB cable. The scanned data is saved in the Documents folder for Windows® or on the desktop for OS X by default. To change the location to save, see "Changing the Location to Save the Scanned Data." NOTE: • You must connect your computer via USB for selecting the Scan to Computer feature from the operator panel. Network connection is not supported. • This feature is supported on both Windows® and OS X. 1 Load the document(s). See "Loading Documents." 2 Press the 3 Tap (Home) button. Scan to Computer. 4 Select a computer. If the desired computer is not displayed, swipe the screen. 5 Check and change the scan settings. See "Scan to Computer." 6 Tap Scan. Scanning to a Computer With a Network Connection If the printer is connected to a computer via the Scan to Computer network using Web Services on Devices (WSD), you can send scanned data to a computer. NOTE: • You need to setup connection using Web Services on Devices (WSD). • Web Services on Devices (WSD) is supported only on Windows Vista®, Windows® 7, Windows® 8, Windows® 8.1, and Windows® 10. Printer Setup for Scan to Web Services on Devices (WSD) Setup the printer and computer for connection using Web Services on Devices (WSD). Scanning 221 Checking the Printer Setting To use this scanning method, make sure that the Web Services on Devices (WSD) is enabled from the operator panel of the printer or on the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool. See "Port Settings" or "Protocols." Setting Up the Computer NOTE: • For Windows® 8, Windows® 8.1, and Windows® 10, the computer automatically connects the printer using Web Services on Devices (WSD). There is no need to install the printer manually. The following procedure uses Windows® 7 as an example. 1 Click Start Computer Network. 2 Right-click the icon for the printer, and then click Install. The printer is connected using Web Services on Devices (WSD). 3 Right-click the icon for the printer, and then click Scan profiles. 4 Specify the various settings of the profile, including the Source where the documents are loaded. Scanning and Sending Images to the Computer 1 Load the document(s). See "Loading Documents." 2 Press the (Home) button. Scan to Computer. 3 Tap NOTE: • Whether to scan from the DADF or from the document glass can be specified in the scan profile. Make sure to specify the scan profile accordingly if you want to scan the document from the DADF. 4 Select a computer. If the desired computer is not displayed, swipe the screen. 5 Specify the type of scan. If the desired type is not displayed, swipe the screen. For details about the type of scan, see "Scan to Computer." 222 Scanning 6 Tap Scan. Changing the Location to Save the Scanned Data Use Dell Printer Hub (Dell H625cdw and Dell H825cdw) or Dell Print Management Tool (Dell S2825cdn) to change the output destination of the obtained image files and to select whether to open the image files using the related program. NOTE: • Dell Printer Hub and Dell Print Management Tool are supported on only Windows® 7 or later. To open Dell Printer Hub: The following procedure uses Windows® 7, Windows® 10, and OS X 10.10 as examples. For Windows® 7: Click Start All Programs For Windows® 10: Click the Start button Dell Printers Dell Printer Hub. Dell Printer Hub. For OS X 10.10: Click Finder Applications Dell Dell Color Cloud Multifunction Printer H625cdw/Dell Color Cloud Multifunction Printer - H825cdw/Dell Color Smart Multifunction Printer - S2825cdn, and then double-click ScanButton Manager. Scanning From a Computer Using Web Services on Devices (WSD) If the printer is connected to a computer via network using Web Services on Devices Scanning 223 (WSD), you can scan documents from the computer. NOTE: • To scan from the computer using Web Services on Devices (WSD), you need to setup connection using Web Services on Devices (WSD). • Web Services on Devices (WSD) is supported only on Windows Vista®, Windows® 7, Windows® 8, Windows® 8.1, and Windows® 10. Preparations for Scanning From the Computer The same preparations are necessary as in using the Scan to Computer feature. See "Scanning to a Computer With a Network Connection." Scanning From the Computer The following procedure uses Windows® 7 and Windows® 10 as example. 1 Load the document(s). See "Loading Documents." 2 Click Start Devices and Printers. For Windows® 10: Right-click the Start button, and then click Control Panel Hardware and Sound Devices and Printers. 3 Right-click the printer, and then select Start scan. 4 Specify the necessary settings for scanning, and then click Scan. NOTE: • When you use Windows Vista®, use the drawing software such as Microsoft® Photo Gallery, select the printer connected using the Web Services on Devices (WSD), and start scanning. Scanning Using the TWAIN Driver With the TWAIN driver, you can import scanned images to a software such as Adobe® Photoshop®. NOTE: • Both USB and Network connections are supported. • This feature is supported on Windows® and Mac OS X 10.7 or later. • To check and set the IP address of the printer, or set the password for Functions Control feature when PC Scan is set to On (Password). For details, see "Managing the Scanner." The following procedure uses typical program that supports TWAIN as an example. 1 Load the document(s). See "Loading Documents." 2 Start the graphic software that supports TWAIN, such as Adobe® Photoshop®. 3 Select the scanner from the TWAIN menu on the graphic software, specify the necessary settings, and then start scanning on the window such as shown below. For details on operating the graphic software, see the manuals of your software. For Windows®: 224 Scanning For OS X: NOTE: • The screen image may vary depending on the operating system. Scanning Using the Windows® Image Acquisition (WIA) Driver Windows® Image Acquisition (WIA) is one of the standard components provided by Windows® XP and later operating systems and works with digital cameras and scanners. Unlike the TWAIN driver, the Windows® Image Acquisition (WIA) driver allows you to scan an image and easily manipulate those images without using additional software. With the Windows® Image Acquisition (WIA) driver, you can import scanned images to Microsoft® programs such as Windows® Photo Gallery and Microsoft® Paint. NOTE: • Both USB and Network connections including Web Services on Devices (WSD) are supported. • The Windows® Image Acquisition (WIA) driver is supported only on Windows® computers. • To check and set the IP address of the printer, or set the password for Functions Control feature when PC Scan is set to On (Password). For details, see "Managing the Scanner." Scanning 225 Scanning an Image From the Drawing Software The following procedure uses Windows® 7 as an example. 1 Load the document(s). See "Loading Documents." 2 Start the drawing software, such as Microsoft® Paint for Windows®. NOTE: • When using Windows Vista® or Windows Server® 2008, use Windows® Photo Gallery instead of Microsoft® Paint. • When using programs that utilize Windows® Image Acquisition (WIA) 2.0, such as Windows® Fax and Scan on Windows Vista®, Windows® 7, Windows® 8, Windows® 8.1, and Windows® 10, the Feeder (Scan both sides) option can be selected for duplex scanning. 3 Click the Paint button From scanner or camera. The following image uses Dell H825cdw as an example. NOTE: • The screen image may vary depending on the operating system. 4 Select your desired type of picture, and then click Adjust the quality of the scanned picture. The Advanced Properties dialog box appears. 5 Click the desired properties 6 Click Scan OK. Save. Scanning Using Wi-Fi Direct This section provides information for Wi-Fi Direct scanning. Wi-Fi Direct allows your mobile devices such as computers, smartphones, and tablets, to connect to the printer directly via a Wi-Fi network. With Wi-Fi Direct, you can scan documents from your mobile devices directly without an access point or a wireless router. 226 Scanning To setup and connect using Wi-Fi Direct, See ”Setting Up Wi-Fi Direct.” NOTE: • • • • Wi-Fi Direct is available on Dell H625cdw and Dell H825cdw. The maximum number of mobile devices that can be connected via the Wi-Fi Direct network is 3. You cannot connect your mobile device to the Internet via the printer’s Wi-Fi Direct network. Depending on the mobile device, the channel used to connect the mobile device to the printer via Wi-Fi Direct may differ from the channel used by the printer to connect to a network via Wi-Fi infrastructure mode. In such a case, simultaneous connection with Wi-Fi Direct and Wi-Fi infrastructure mode may not work properly. • The printer connected with Wi-Fi Direct supports the following protocols; LPD, Port9100, WSD*, Bonjour (mDNS), SNMPv1/v2c, Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool, TWAIN, WIA, ICA. WSD stands for Web Services on Devices. Scanning via Wi-Fi Direct The scanning procedure varies depending on the mobile device and the application you are using. Refer to the manual supplied with your mobile device or application to scan. Scanning to a Computer or Server With SMB/FTP You can scan and send the scanned data to a shared folder on a computer or an FTP server. NOTE: • This feature does not require a network scanner driver. Overview The Scan to Network Folder feature allows you to send the scanned data to a computer or FTP server. Computer FTP Server Scan Using FTP Using SMB Computer Required Operating Systems: For FTP: NOTE: • For details about how to configure the FTP service, refer to the manual supplied with the software. • Windows Vista® supports IPv4 only. Scanning 227 • Windows® Windows Server® FTP service of Microsoft® Internet Information Services • Mac OS X 10.7 or later operating systems FTP service of Mac OS X For SMB: This feature is supported on Windows Server® 2008 or later and Mac OS X 10.7 or later. Overview for Scanning to an FTP Server The following is a typical setup flow for sending scanned data to an FTP server: 1 Set SMB/FTP Destination into the Address Book. See "Setting SMB/FTP Destination Into the Address Book." 2 Send the scanned data on the network. See "Sending the Scanned Data on the Network." Overview for Scanning to a Shared Folder Using SMB NOTE: • The setup for Scan to Network Folder via SMB can be configured easily with the bundled Address Book Editor utility. For details about Address Book Editor, see "Using Address Book Editor." • Scan to Network Folder can be also accomplished with the Web Services on Devices (WSD) function. For details about scanning using the Web Services on Devices (WSD) function, see "Scanning to a Computer With a Network Connection" and "Scanning From a Computer Using Web Services on Devices (WSD)." The following is a typical setup flow for sending scanned data to a shared folder using SMB: 1 Set a user account. See "Setting a User Account (SMB Only)." 2 Create a shared folder. See "Creating a Shared Folder (SMB Only)." 3 Set SMB/FTP Destination into the Address Book. See "Setting SMB/FTP Destination Into the Address Book." 4 Send the scanned data on the network. See "Sending the Scanned Data on the Network." Setting a User Account (SMB Only) To send scanned data to a SMB shared folder, it is necessary to have a shared folder on a computer. To create a shared folder, a user account with a valid password is required. For Windows®: 228 Scanning If the user account you are going to use does not have a login password, set a password with the following procedure. After checking the login user name and password of the user account, proceed to "Creating a Shared Folder (SMB Only)." The following procedure uses Windows® 7, Windows® 10, and OS X 10.10 as examples. For Windows® 7: 1 Click Start Control Panel User Accounts and Family Safety Create a password for your account. User Accounts 2 Add in a password for your user login account. For Windows® 10: 1 Right-click the Start button, and then click Settings. 2 Click Accounts Sign-in options Add under Password. 3 Add in a password for your user login account. For OS X 10.10: 1 Click System Preferences Users & Groups Change Password. 2 Enter a password for your user login account in New password. 3 Re-enter the password in Verify. Creating a Shared Folder (SMB Only) Create a shared folder to store the scanned data from the printer. The following procedure uses Windows® 7, Windows® 10, and OS X 10.10 as examples. For Windows® 7 and Windows® 10: 1 Create a folder in the desired directory on your computer. MyShare is used as an example folder name in this procedure. 2 Right-click on the folder, and then click Properties. The Properties dialog box appears. 3 Click the Sharing tab Advanced Sharing. Scanning 229 4 Select the Share this folder check box. 5 Enter a shared name in the Share name box. NOTE: • Write down the shared name as you need to use this name in the next setting procedure. 6 Click Permissions to create a write permission for this folder. 7 Click Add. 8 Search user login name by performing either of the following: • Click Advanced, and then search user login name. • Enter the user login name in the Enter the object names to select text box, and then click Check Names. Myself is used as an example login name in the following illustration. 9 Click OK. 230 Scanning 10 Click the user login name that you have just entered, and then select the Full Control check box. This permits the document to be sent into this folder. NOTE: • Do not use Everyone as the user login name. 11 Click OK. NOTE: • To add sub-folders, create new folders in the shared folder you have created. For example: Folder name: MyShare, Second-level folder name: MyPic, Third-level folder name: John You should now see MyShare\MyPic\John in your directory. When you are finished creating a shared folder, proceed to "Setting SMB/FTP Destination Into the Address Book." For OS X 10.10: 1 Create a folder in the desired directory on your computer. MyShare is used as an example folder name. 2 Click the created folder File Get Info. 3 Select the Shared folder check box. 4 Open System Preferences, and then click Sharing. 5 Select the File Sharing check box, and then click Options. 6 Select the Share Files and folders using SMB and account name check boxes. 7 Click Done. When you are finished creating a shared folder, proceed to "Setting SMB/FTP Destination Into the Address Book." Setting SMB/FTP Destination Into the Address Book You can register the connection details for SMB and FTP server in the address book using Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool or Address Book Editor. Before entering the destination information, make sure that you have the IP address of your computer ready. See "Confirming the IP Address of Your Computer." Scanning 231 After you finish registering the destination information of the SMB or FTP server, proceed to "Sending the Scanned Data on the Network." Confirming the IP Address of Your Computer Perform the following procedure to check the IP address of the computer. For Windows®: The following procedure uses Windows® 7/Windows® 10 as an example. 1 Click Start All Programs Accessories Run. For Windows® 10: Right-click the Start button, and then click Run. 2 Enter "cmd" in the text box, and then click OK. A command prompt window opens. 3 Enter ipconfig, and then press on the keyboard. 4 Write down the IP address. For OS X: The following procedure uses OS X 10.10 as an example. 1 Open System Preferences, and then click Network. The IP address is displayed under Status. 2 Write down the IP address. Using Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool 1 Start the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool. See "Starting the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool." 2 Click Address Book. 232 Scanning If a security login dialog box appears, enter user name and password. NOTE: • The default user name is "admin," and the default password is left blank (NULL). 3 Click the Server Address tab Create of an ID. The Server Address page appears. 4 Enter the information as follows to fill in the fields. Name Enter a name of your choice. This appears as the name for the Server Address in the Address Book. Server Type Select FTP to send documents to an FTP server. Select SMB to send documents to a shared folder on your computer using Server Message Block (SMB). Scanning 233 Server Address Enter the name or IP address of the server or computer. Example: • For FTP: Server name: myhost.example.com (myhost: host name, example.com: domain name) IP address: 192.0.2.1 • For SMB: Computer name: myhost IP address: 192.0.2.1 Share Name Enter the name of the shared folder. See "Creating a Shared Folder (SMB Only)." For SMB only. • Example: Share, Sharefolder Server Path Enter the path of the sub-folder within the shared folder. If you have not created a sub-folder, leave this blank. When entering the sub-folder path, make sure that the sub-folder is already created. Do not enter the name of the shared folder. Example: Shared Folder name: MyShare, Second-level folder name: MyPic Enter "MyPic". If you have created a sub-folder within a sub-folder, separate each sub-folder name with a backslash (SMB) or forward slash (FTP). Example: Shared Folder name: MyShare, Second-level folder name: MyPic, Third-level folder name: John • For SMB enter "MyPic\John". • For FTP enter "MyPic\John". Server Port Number Enter the Server Port Number. If you are unsure, you can enter the default value of 21 for FTP or 139 for SMB. Available ports are: FTP: 21, 5000 - 65535 SMB: 139, 445, 5000 - 65535 Login Name Enter the user account name to allow access to a shared folder on your computer or to an FTP server. • For FTP: Contact your system administrator. • For SMB: Windows® login name that you have specified in "Setting a User Account (SMB Only)." Login Password Enter the password corresponding to the above login name. • For FTP: Contact your system administrator • For SMB: Empty password is not valid in the Network (Computer) feature. Make sure that you have a valid password for the user login account. See "Setting a User Account (SMB Only)." Re-enter Password Re-enter your password. 5 Click Apply New Settings. Using Address Book Editor The following procedure uses OS X 10.10 as an example. NOTE: • For Windows®, you can operate Address Book Editor with using the Tool Box on the Dell Printer Hub and Dell Print Management Tool. See "Tool Box." 234 Scanning 1 Click Finder Applications Dell Dell Color Cloud Multifunction Printer H625cdw/Dell Color Cloud Multifunction Printer - H825cdw/Dell Color Smart Multifunction Printer - S2825cdn, and then double-click Address Book Editor. 2 Perform either of the following: Click New (Device Address Book) New Server. Server Address dialog box appears. 3 Enter the information as follows to fill in the fields. Name Enter a name of your choice. This appears as the name for the Server Address in the Address Book. Server Type Select Computer to send documents to a shared folder on your computer using Server Message Block (SMB). Select Server to send documents to an FTP server. Server Name/IP Address Enter the name or IP address of the server or computer. Example: • For Computer (SMB): Computer name: myhost IP address: 192.0.2.1 • For Server (FTP): Server name: myhost.example.com (myhost: host name, example.com: domain name) IP address: 192.0.2.1 Scanning 235 Share Name Enter the name of the shared folder. See "Creating a Shared Folder (SMB Only)." For SMB only. Example: Share, Sharefolder Path Enter the path of the sub-folder within the shared folder. If you have not created a sub-folder, leave this blank. When entering the sub-folder path, make sure that the sub-folder is already created and do not enter the name of the shared folder. Example: Shared Folder name: MyShare, Second-level folder name: MyPic Enter "MyPic". If you have created a sub-folder within a sub-folder, separate each sub-folder name with a backslash (SMB) or forward slash (FTP). Example: Shared Folder name: MyShare, Second-level folder name: MyPic, Third-level folder name: John • For SMB enter "MyPic\John". • For FTP enter "MyPic\John". Login Name Enter the user account name to allow access to a shared folder on your computer (SMB) or to an FTP server. • For Computer (SMB): Windows® login name that you have specified in the procedure 1. • For Server (FTP): Contact your system administrator. Login Password Enter the password corresponding to the login name. • For Computer (SMB): Empty password is not valid in the Network(Computer) feature. Make sure that you have a valid password for the user login account. See "Setting a User Account (SMB Only)." • For Server (FTP): Contact your system administrator. Confirm Login Password Re-enter your password. Port Number Enter the Server Port Number. If you are unsure, you can enter the default value of 139 for Computer (SMB) and 21 for FTP server. Available ports are: For Computer (SMB): 139, 445, 5000 - 65535 For Server (FTP): 21, 5000 - 65535 4 Click OK. Sending the Scanned Data on the Network 1 Load the document(s). See "Loading Documents." 2 Press the (Home) button. Scan to Network Folder. 3 Tap 4 Tap the desired address Done. If the desired address is not displayed, swipe the screen. 5 Tap , and then check and change the scan settings. See "Scan Settings." 6 Tap Scan. 236 Scanning When the document is loaded on the document glass, the screen prompts you to scan another page. • • If you want to scan another page, place the document, and then tap Continue. If you are finished scanning, tap Done. Scanning to a USB Flash Drive The Scan to USB feature allows you to store scanned data directly to a USB flash drive attached to the printer without using software. See "Supported USB Flash Drive." Procedures To store the scanned data to a USB flash drive: NOTE: • If you insert a USB flash drive to the front USB port first, the USB Drive Detected screen may appear. In this case, select Scan to USB, and then proceed to step 6. 1 Load the document(s). See "Loading Documents." 2 Press the (Home) button. 3 Insert a USB flash drive into the front USB port of the printer. 4 Tap Scan to USB. 5 Select a folder to save the scanned data. See "Specifying a Folder to Save the Scanned Data." 6 Tap , and then check and change the scan settings. See "Scan Settings." 7 Tap Scan. CAUTION: • Do not remove the USB flash drive while the printer is accessing the drive. The data in the drive may be destroyed, or the drive itself may be damaged and become unusable. When the document is loaded on the document glass, the screen prompts you to scan another page. • • If you want to scan another page, place the document, and then tap Continue. If you are finished scanning, tap Done. 8 Remove the USB flash drive from the printer. CAUTION: • Make sure that the printer is not accessing the USB flash drive. Specifying a Folder to Save the Scanned Data To save the scanned data to a folder in the USB flash drive, specify the folder before executing the scan job. 1 If folders exist in the USB flash drive, the folder names appear on the touch panel. Scanning 237 2 Select a folder to save the scanned data. NOTE: • The default saving location is the root directory of the USB flash drive. • You cannot directly enter a folder path using the numeric keypad. • You can select any folder in the USB flash drive but cannot create a new folder in this step. You should always create a new folder before connecting the USB flash drive to the printer. If the name of the scanned data already exists in the folder, the printer generates a new file name to save the data. Sending a Scanned Data via E-Mail You can send the data scanned as an e-mail attachment using the Scan to Email feature. To send an e-mail, an e-mail account is necessary such as the corporate mail account or the Internet service provider's mail account. Gmail account can be used as well. The following are the procedures necessary to setup Scan to E-mail feature: 1 "Gathering the Necessary Information About Your E-mail Account" 2 "Setting the DNS Server Address" 3 "Setting the Information Necessary to Access the Mail Server" Gathering the Necessary Information About Your E-mail Account To send an e-mail from the printer, the following information is necessary: • E-mail account (user account) information • E-mail sever information NOTE: • For details about your e-mail account or the mail server, contact your network administrator or your Internet service provider. • When the printer is connected to the network via a proxy server, the printer may not be able to send the e-mail. In this case, contact your network administrator. • The following preparations are effective while the e-mail account information is valid. You do not have to repeat the settings whenever you send the e-mail. Setting the DNS Server Address To set the DNS server address to the printer, perform the following procedure: 1 Start the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool. See "Starting the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool." 2 Click Print Server Settings the Print Server Settings tab TCP/IP. 3 Perform either of the following: • If you are using DHCP for TCP/IP setting for the printer: Select the Enable check box for Get DNS Server Address from DHCP in DNS. • If you are setting TCP/IP manually: Set Manual DNS Server Address in DNS. 4 Click Apply New Settings. 238 Scanning Setting the Information Necessary to Access the Mail Server To make the printer to send an e-mail, perform the following procedure: 1 Start the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool. See "Starting the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool." 2 Click E-Mail Server Settings Overview. 3 Set the mail server information as follows: NOTE: • In this procedure, the server settings for a Gmail account are used as an example. The server settings differ for each e-mail service. • Information about the Gmail account is based on the information as of October 2013. For the latest information, visit the homepage of Gmail. a In the Primary SMTP Gateway text box, set the primary SMTP gateway. For example: smtp.gmail.com b In the SMTP Port Number text box, enter the SMTP port number. This must be 25, 587 or between 5000 and 65535. For example: 587 c In the E-Mail Send Authentication drop-down list box, specify the authentication method for outgoing e-mail. For example: SMTP_Auth (Auto) d In the SMTP Login User text box, set the SMTP login user. Up to 63 alphanumeric characters, periods, hyphens, underscores, and at symbols (@) can be used. If specifying more than one address, separate them using commas. For example: aaaa@gmail.com NOTE: • It is not recommended to share a personal e-mail account with the Scan to Email function of the printer. Instead, use an e-mail account dedicated to Scan to Email function. e In the SMTP Login Password text box, set the SMTP account password. Scanning 239 Up to 31 alphanumeric characters can be used. In the Re-enter SMTP Login Password text box, enter the login password again to check it. g Perform either of the following: • If you have selected other than POP before SMTP (Plain) or POP before SMTP (APOP) in the E-Mail Send Authentication drop-down list box, proceed to step h. • If you have selected POP before SMTP (Plain) or POP before SMTP (APOP) in the E-Mail Send Authentication drop-down list box, enter the following: – In the POP3 Server Address text box, enter the POP3 server address in IP address format of aaa.bbb.ccc.ddd or as a DNS host name using up to 63 characters. – In the POP3 Port Number text box, enter the POP3 server port number. This must be 110 or between 5000 and 65535. – In the POP User Name text box, set the POP3 account user name. Up to 63 alphanumeric characters, periods, hyphens, underscores, and at symbols (@) can be used. If specifying more than one address, separate them using commas. – In the POP User Password text box, enter the POP3 account password. Up to 31 alphanumeric characters. – In the Re-enter POP User Password text box, enter the POP user password again to check it. h In the Reply Address text box, enter the reply e-mail address sent with each E-Mail Alert. 4 Click Apply New Settings. • If SSL/TLS is not used or if Invalid, POP before SMTP (Plain), or POP before SMTP (APOP) is selected for E-Mail Send Authentication, the mail server settings are complete. • If SMTP authentication is selected for E-Mail Send Authentication and if SSL/TLS encryption is used to communicate with the SMTP sever, the SSL/TLS type must be set in SMTP-SSL/TLS Communication of SSL/TLS under the Security tab. Proceed to step 5. NOTE: • To send an e-mail through Gmail, set the SSL/TLS type to STARTTLS in SMTP-SSL/TLS Communication of SSL/TLS under the Security tab. 5 Click the Security tab SSL/TLS. 6 Select a SSL/TLS type from the SMTP-SSL/TLS Communication list. NOTE: • To use a Gmail account, select STARTTLS. 7 Click Apply New Settings. Registering a Destination E-Mail Address to Address Book 1 Start the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool. See "Starting the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool." 240 Scanning 2 Click Address Book E-Mail Address tab Create of an ID. The E-Mail Address page for registering a new e-mail address appears. 3 Enter the following: • Name • Address 4 Click Apply New Settings. Sending an E-mail With the Scanned Data 1 Press the 2 Tap (Home) button. Scan to Email. 3 Specify a recipient by either of the following: • If you want to enter an e-mail address directly: a Tap the Enter Recipient's Address text box. b Enter the address using the keyboard. c Tap Done. You can remove or edit the recipient by tapping + and the recipient you specified. • If you want to select from the following types of address books: a Tap Address Book. b Select a recipient from either of the following: – Tap Individuals to select an e-mail address registered in the address book. – Tap Groups to select a group of e-mails registered in the address book. – Tap Network Address Book to search an e-mail address from the LDAP server address book. See "Sending an E-mail With the Scanned Data Using the E-mail Server Address Book." c Tap Done. Scanning 241 You can remove or see details of the recipient, or set the e-mail as Bcc by tapping + and the recipient you specified. 4 Tap Sender, and then specify the sender's e-mail address by either of the following: • If you want to enter an e-mail address directly: a Tap Keyboard. b Enter the address using the keyboard. c Tap Done. • If you want to select from the address book: a Tap Address Book. b Select an e-mail address registered in the address book. c Tap Done. • If you want to select from the server address book: See "Sending an E-mail With the Scanned Data Using the E-mail Server Address Book." NOTE: • For details about address book and server address book, see "Using the Address Book and Phone Book." • For details about Network Address Book, see "Using the Server Address Book and Server Phone Book." • E-mail addresses need to be registered before you can select Address Book. 5 Tap , and then check and change the scan settings. See "Scan Settings." 6 Tap Send. When the document is loaded on the document glass, the screen prompts you to scan another page. If you want to scan another page, place the document, and then tap Continue. If you are finished scanning, tap Done. • • Managing the Scanner You can connect the specified scanner, and set the password for the scanner. Port Settings When the printer is connected to the computer directly by a USB cable, select USB. When the printer is connected to the network, select Network. Enter the IP address of the printer in the IP Address text box, and then click OK. When the Printer is Connected to the Network When you are using DHCP for TCP/IP setting for the printer, the image capturing software may not find the scanner occasionally due to the change of the IP address allocated for the printer. In this case, check the IP address of the printer, and then connect the scanner by specifying the IP address. On Windows®, you can check the IP address of the printer using the Dell Printer Hub or Dell Print Management Tool. Open Dell Printer Hub or Dell Print Management Tool, and then click Printer information. 242 Scanning Searching the Scanner In the Port Settings tab, you can search the scanners from the network and select the desired one from the detected scanners. Search all scanners from the network (Windows® only) Select to search scanners in your network. Scanner List Displays a list of detected scanners. Search again Click to search the scanners in your network. ® Search Criteria (Windows only) Click to display the Search Criteria dialog box for setting the search condition. See "Search Criteria Dialog Box (Windows® only)." Search Criteria Dialog Box (Windows® only) Subnet Address Enter the subnet address. • IPv4: Broadcast Address such as 192.0.2.1 • IPv6: Multicast Address such as 2001:db8:: Search Time Specify a time period for searching a scanner. Community Name Enter the SNMPv1/v2 community name. The default community name is "public." Password Settings In the Password Settings tab, you can input the password that is set for your scanner to access from your computer to the printer. For Windows®: For OS X: Scanning 243 Password for Scanner Enter the password. Changing the Default Scan Setting NOTE: • You can set the same setting using the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool. See "Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool." 1 Press the (Information) button. 2 Tap the Tools tab Default Settings 3 Select the desired menu item. If the desired menu item is not displayed, tap Scan Defaults. or to scroll through the screen. 4 Select the desired setting or enter the value, and then tap OK. 5 Repeat steps 3 and 4 as needed. 244 Scanning Faxing NOTE: • If the Functions Control setting is set to On (Password), you need to enter the four-digit password to use the function. If the Functions Control setting is set to Off, the function is disabled and the menu is grayed out. See "Functions Control." Initial Settings To use the fax function, you need to perform the initial settings. If you have already performed the initial settings for fax when you first turned on the printer, you can skip this procedure. See "Setting Initial Settings on the Operator Panel." If you have not performed the initial settings for fax, you can perform initial settings using the Dell Printer Easy Install or Operator Panel. Specifying the Fax Initial Settings Using the Dell Printer Easy Install 1 Insert the Software and Documentation disc into your computer. The Dell Printer Easy Install program starts. 2 Click Main Menu. 3 Click Change. The Configure Printer screen appears. Faxing 245 4 Click Configure the Fax settings Next. 5 Follow the on-screen instruction. Specifying the Fax Initial Settings Using the Operator Panel To set the fax settings manually from the operator panel, set the following menus. NOTE: • You can set the same setting using the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool. See "Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool." • If Panel Lock Control is set to Enable, enter the password when entering Admin Settings. See "Panel Lock." • Fax Number, Country, Fax Header Name, and Line Type: From the (Information) button Tools tab Admin Settings Settings Fax Line Settings Fax If you use DRPD option, you can set DRPD Pattern here. NOTE: • When you configure the country setting, the settings relevant to it is initialized. • • Receive Mode: From the (Information) button Settings Incoming Defaults Tools tab Admin Settings Fax Tone / Pulse: From the (Information) button Tools tab Settings Transmission Defaults Admin Settings Fax For details about each menu, see "Fax Settings." Changing the Fax Settings 1 Press the (Information) button. 2 Tap the Tools tab Admin Settings Fax Settings. If Panel Lock Control is set to Enable, enter the password. See "Panel Lock." 3 Select the desired menu. 4 Select the desired setting or specify a value. To specify a value, tap – or +, or use the number pad or the keyboard. 5 Tap OK. 6 Repeat steps 3 to 5 as needed. For available options, see "Fax Settings." Sending a Fax You can fax data from the printer. You can also directly fax data transferred from a computer running a Microsoft® Windows® operating system or a Macintosh computer. Sending a Fax From Memory 1 Load the document(s). 246 Faxing See "Loading Documents." 2 Press the (Home) button. Fax. 3 Tap 4 Tap , and then check and change the fax settings. See "Fax Settings." To return to the previous screen, tap Back. 5 Enter or select a fax number by performing either of the following: • If you want to enter a fax number directly: a Tap the Enter Number text box. b Enter the number using the keyboard. c Tap Done. • If you want to select from the phone book: a Tap Phone Book. – Tap Individuals to select an individual fax number. – Tap Groups to select a group dial number. – Tap Network Phone Book to search and select a fax number from the LDAP server. See "Sending a Fax Using the Fax Server Phone Book." b Tap Done. NOTE: • For details about address book and server address book, see "Using the Address Book and Phone Book." • For details about Network Phone Book, see "Using the Server Address Book and Server Phone Book." • The fax number needs to be registered before you can select Address Book. • If you want to select from the speed dial: a Tap Speed Dial. b Enter the speed dial number using the number pad. c Tap Done. You can add more fax numbers by tapping +. 6 Tap Send. NOTE: • To cancel the fax job, tap Stop at any time while sending the fax. When the document is loaded on the document glass, the screen prompts you for another page. • If you want to place a new document, replace the document with a new document, and then tap Continue. • When you have finished loading documents, tap Done. The printer starts dialing the number, and then sends the fax when the remote fax machine is ready. Faxing 247 Sending a Fax Manually 1 Load the document(s). See "Loading Documents." 2 Press the (Home) button. Fax. 3 Tap 4 Tap , and then check and change the fax settings. See "Fax Settings." 5 Tap On Hook. 6 Enter the fax number of the recipient using the number pad. You can also select the recipient by using speed dial number or address book. See "Automatic Dialing." 7 Tap Send. NOTE: • To cancel the fax job, tap Stop at any time while sending the fax. • Tapping Send does not start sending a fax when the available time is set or the Fax function is locked. For details about the available time and the Fax function, see "Set Available Time" and "Functions Control." When the document is loaded on the document glass, the screen prompts you for another page. • If you want to place a new document, replace the document with a new document, and then tap Continue. When you have finished loading documents, tap Done. • Confirming Transmissions When the last page of your document has been sent successfully, the printer beeps and returns to the standby mode. If something goes wrong while sending your fax, an error message appears on the touch panel. If you receive an error message, tap Close to clear the message and send the document again. You can set the printer to print a confirmation report after each fax transmission. See "Fax Transmit." Automatic Redialing If the number you have dialed is busy or there is no answer when you send a fax, the printer redials the number every minute based on the number set in the redial settings. For details about how to change the time interval between redials and the number of redial attempts, see "Fax Settings." NOTE: • The printer does not redial a number when you send a fax manually. 248 Faxing Sending a Delayed Fax The Delayed Start mode can be used to save scanned data for transmission at a specified time to take advantage of lower long distance rates. Once Delayed Start mode is activated, the printer stores all of the documents to be faxed into its memory and sends them at the specified time. After faxing in the Delayed Start mode is complete, the data in the memory is cleared. 1 Load the document(s). See "Loading Documents." 2 Press the (Home) button. Fax. 3 Tap 4 Tap , and then check and change the fax settings. See "Fax Settings." 5 In the Fax Settings screen, tap Delayed Send. 6 Select the On check box. 7 Specify the start time by tapping – or +, and then tap OK. 8 Tap Back. 9 Enter the fax number of the recipient using the number pad. You can also select the recipient using speed dial number or address book. See "Automatic Redialing." 10 Tap Send. When the document is loaded on the document glass, the screen prompts you for another page. • If you want to place a new document, replace the document with a new document, and then tap Continue. • When you have finished loading documents, tap Done. Scanning starts and the data is stored in the memory to be sent at the specified time. NOTE: • If you restart the printer, the stored documents are sent as soon as the printer is activated. • If the specified start time overlaps with the time periods for the available time or the Fax function, the printer cannot send the delayed fax at the specified time. For details about the available time and the Fax function, see "Set Available Time" and "Functions Control." Sending a Fax Directly From a Computer You can send a fax directly from your computer using the driver. NOTE: • Only black and white faxes can be sent using Direct Fax. • If the specified start time overlaps with the time periods for the available time or the Fax function, the printer cannot send the delayed fax at the specified time. For details about the available time and the Fax function, see "Set Available Time" and "Functions Control." Faxing 249 Overview The following images use Dell H825cdw as examples. Send data Dell Color MFP H825cdw Fax driver Send fax Sending machine (this printer) Receiving machine (fax machine/ multifunction printer) Procedure NOTE: • The names of the dialog boxes and the buttons may be different from those given in the following procedure depending on the program you are using. • To use this feature, you must install the fax driver. For Windows®, see "Installing the Software for Windows® Computers." For OS X, see "Installing the Software and Print Drivers." The following procedure uses Dell H825cdw as an example. 1 Open the file you want to fax. 2 Open the print dialog box from the program. 3 Click Dell Color MFP H825cdw Fax OS X. For Windows®: For OS X: 250 Faxing Preferences for Windows® or FAX Setting for 4 Specify the following settings. NOTE: • The settings made here are only applied to a single fax job. For Windows®: For OS X: Transmission image quality Select the output quality. • Standard: For documents with normal sized characters. • High Quality: For documents containing small characters or thin lines or documents printed using a dot-matrix printer. • Super-high image quality: For documents containing extremely fine detail. The super fine mode is enabled only if the remote machine also supports Super Fine resolution. NOTE: • Faxes printed in the Super-high image quality by Direct Fax driver transmits at the highest resolution supported by the receiving device. Faxing 251 Transmission report Specify whether to print a fax transmission result. • Output regularly: Prints a transmission result after every fax transmission. • Output for non-transmission: Prints a transmission result only when an error occurs. • Do not output: Does not print fax transmission results. Fax Cover Page Specify whether to attach a cover page to your fax. • According to Printer Settings: Determines whether to attach a cover page to your fax in accordance with the setting you specify in Fax Cover Page on the operator panel. • Attach: Attaches a cover page to your fax. • None: Does not attach a cover page to your fax. Sender Specify whether to print the sender's name on the fax cover page. • According to Printer Settings: Determines whether or not to print the sender's name on the fax cover page based on the printer settings. • Enter a sender name: Allows you to enter a sender's name to be printed on the fax cover page in Sender Name. Sender Name Enter a sender's name to be printed on the fax cover page. The sender's name can be up to 30 characters. If it exceeds 30 characters, only the first 30 characters are printed. 5 Perform either of the following: • For Windows®: Click OK to close the Printing Preferences dialog box, and then click Print. • For OS X: Click Print. The Recipient Setting dialog box for Windows® or the Set/Check Fax Transmission dialog box for OS X appears. 6 Enter the destination for the recipient by performing the following. For details about how to enter the destination, refer to the Help of the driver. For Windows®: 252 Faxing For OS X: • • Enter the name and fax number directly. Select a fax number from a phone book: Look Up Phone Book Select from a list of fax numbers saved in the file specified for My Phone Book file. Look Up Device Data Select from a list of fax numbers saved in the Phone Book on the printer. Import and add file (Windows® only) Select a source file such as a CSV file, WAB file, MAPI, or a LDAP server. See "LDAP Server" and "Fax Server Phone Book." NOTE: • When you are using Mac OS X 10.7 or later, you cannot use Look Up Device Data feature on some programs. • Enter the password in the Password text box in the Authorization area before sending a fax if the fax function is locked with a password. • If the Functions Control setting is set to On (Password), you need to enter the four-digit password to use the function. Faxing 253 7 Click Start Sending. Automatic Dialing Speed Dialing You can store up to 200 frequently dialed numbers in speed dial locations (001–200). When the speed dial job specified in the delayed fax or redial exists, you cannot change the speed dial number from the operator panel or Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool. Setting Speed Dial 1 Press the (Information) button. 2 Tap the Tools tab Admin Settings Phone Book Individuals. If Panel Lock Control is set to Enable, enter the password. See "Panel Lock." 3 Select the desired speed dial number. If the desired speed dial number is not displayed, tap screen. or to scroll through the To jump to a specific speed dial number, enter the desired number and then # using the number pad. If a speed dial number is already set, the screen shows the name and the number of entries. 4 Tap the Enter Name text box. 5 Enter the name, and then tap OK. 6 Tap the Enter Number text box. 7 Enter the fax number using the number pad, and then tap OK. To insert a pause between numbers, press the (Redial/Pause) button. "-" appears on the touch panel. 8 Tap OK. 9 Repeat steps 3 to 8 as needed. Editing Speed Dial You can edit or delete a speed dial number. 1 Press the (Information) button. 2 Tap the Tools tab Admin Settings Phone Book Individuals. If Panel Lock Control is set to Enable, enter the password. See "Panel Lock." 3 Select the desired speed dial number. If the desired speed dial number is not displayed, tap screen. 4 Perform the following: • 254 To edit a speed dial number: Faxing or to scroll through the • a Tap Edit the Name or Fax Number text box. b Enter a new name or a fax number, and then tap OK. To delete a speed dial number: Tap Remove Delete. 5 Repeat steps 3 to 4 as needed. Sending a Fax Using Speed Dial 1 Load the document(s). See "Loading Documents." 2 Press the (Home) button. Fax 3 Tap Speed Dial. 4 Enter the speed dial number using the number pad, and then tap Done. NOTE: • Using the asterisk (*) in the first digit, you can send a document to multiple locations. For example, if you enter 00*, you can send a document to the locations registered between 001 and 009. 5 Tap , and then check and change the fax settings. See "Fax Settings." 6 Tap Send. When the document is loaded on the document glass, the screen prompts you for another page. • If you want to scan another document, replace the document with a new document, and then tap Continue. • When you have finished loading documents, tap Done. The fax number stored in the speed dial location is dialed. The document is sent when the remote fax machine answers. Group Dialing If you frequently send a document to several destinations, you can create a group of these destinations and set them under a one-digit group dial location. This enables you to use a group dial number setting to send the same document to all the destinations in the group. NOTE: • You cannot include one group dial number within another group dial number. Setting Group Dial 1 Press the (Information) button. 2 Tap the Tools tab Admin Settings Phone Book Groups. If Panel Lock Control is set to Enable, enter the password. See "Panel Lock." 3 Select the desired group dial number. If the desired group dial number is not displayed, tap screen. or to scroll through the Faxing 255 If a group dial number is already set, the screen shows the name and the number of entries stored in that group dial number. 4 Tap the Enter Group Name text box. 5 Enter the name, and then tap OK. 6 Tap Add from Address Book. NOTE: • The fax number needs to be registered before you can select Add from Address Book. 7 Select the desired speed dial number. If the desired speed dial number is not displayed, tap screen. or to scroll through the 8 Tap OK. 9 Repeat steps 3 to 8 as needed. Editing Group Dial You can delete a specific speed dial number from a selected group or add a new number to the selected group. 1 Press the (Information) button. 2 Tap the Tools tab Admin Settings Phone Book Groups. If Panel Lock Control is set to Enable, enter the password. See "Panel Lock." 3 Select the desired group dial number. If the desired group dial number is not displayed, tap screen. or to scroll through the 4 Perform the following: • To edit a speed dial number: a Tap Edit Enter Group Name text box. b Enter a new name, and then tap OK. • To delete a speed dial number from the group dial number: Tap Remove. 5 Repeat steps 3 to 4 as needed. Sending a Fax Using Group Dial (Multi-address Transmission) You can use group dialing for Broadcasting or Delayed transmissions. Follow the procedure of the desired operation. See "Delayed Send." You can use one or more group numbers in one operation. Then continue the procedure to complete the desired operation. The printer scans the document loaded in the Duplex Automatic Document Feeder (DADF) or on the document glass into the memory. The printer dials each of the numbers included in the group. Printing a Speed Dial List You can check your automatic dial setting by printing a Speed Dial list. 256 Faxing See "Report / List." Phone Book You can select or search the registered phone numbers from the phone books. 1 Load the document(s). See "Loading Documents." 2 Press the (Home) button. Fax 3 Tap Phone Book. 4 Specify the recipient by performing either of the following: • If you want to select from the local phone book: a Tap Individuals or Groups. b Select the desired speed dial number or the group dial number. If the desired number is not displayed, swipe the screen. • c Tap Done. If you want to search from the server phone book: a Tap Network Phone Book. b Enter a keyword using the keyboard, and then tap Search. c Tap a recipient from the search result Done. NOTE: • For details about address book and server address book, see "Using the Address Book and Phone Book." • For details about Network Phone Book, see "Using the Server Address Book and Server Phone Book." • A fax number needs to be registered before you can select an address book. 5 Tap Send. When the document is loaded on the document glass, the screen prompts you for another page. • • If you want to place a new document, replace the document with a new document, and then tap Continue. When you have finished loading documents, tap Done. Receiving a Fax NOTE: • To use the Telephone / Fax or Ans Machine/Fax mode, connect an answering machine to the phone connector on the rear of the printer. See "Connecting a Telephone or Answering Machine." When the memory is full, the fax is received in the Telephone mode. Loading Paper for Receiving Faxes The instructions for loading paper in the paper tray are the same whether you are printing, faxing, or copying, except that faxes can only be printed on Letter-sized, A4-sized, or Legal-sized paper. See "Loading Print Media" and "Print Media Guidelines." Faxing 257 Receiving a Fax Automatically To automatically receive a fax, use the Fax, Telephone / Fax, or Ans Machine/Fax mode. The default setting is Fax mode. See "Receive Mode." NOTE: • To use the Telephone / Fax or Ans Machine/Fax mode, you must connect an external telephone to the phone connector on the rear of the printer. See "Connecting a Telephone or Answering Machine." Receiving a Fax Manually When in the Telephone or Telephone / Fax mode, you can receive the fax manually. See "Receive Mode." Using Remote Receive Use Remote Receive to manually receive a fax from an external telephone without having to go to the printer. To manually receive a fax using the external telephone, you must connect an external telephone to the phone connector on the rear of the printer and also set Remote Receive to On. See "Connecting a Telephone or Answering Machine." When you receive a call on the external telephone and hear a fax tone, enter the remote receive code from the external telephone. NOTE: • When entering the remote receive code from the external telephone, press the number keys slowly in sequence. If you still hear the fax tone from the remote machine, try entering the two-digit code again. • The default remote receive code is 00. You can change the two-digit code to a number of your choice. See "Receive Mode." • Set the dialing system of your external telephone to DTMF. Using Manual Receive in On Hook You can manually receive a fax by tapping Manual Receive in On Hook on the touch panel. 1 When the external telephone rings, pick up the handset. 2 Make sure that you hear the fax tone, and then press the 3 Tap Fax On Hook Receive (Home) button. Receive. 4 Hang up the hand set of the external telephone. The printer begins receiving a fax and returns to the standby mode when the reception is completed. Receiving Faxes Using the Distinctive Ring Pattern Detection (DRPD) The DRPD is a telephone company service which enables a user to use a single telephone line to answer several different telephone numbers. The particular number someone uses to call you on is identified by different ringing patterns, which consist of various combinations of long and short ringing sounds. 258 Faxing Before using the Distinctive Ring Pattern Detection option, Distinctive Ring service must be installed on your telephone line by the telephone company. To set up Distinctive Ring Pattern Detection, you need another telephone line at your location, or someone available to dial your fax number from outside. To set up the DRPD: NOTE: • You can set the same setting using the Tool Box or Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool. See "Tool Box" or "Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool." 1 Press the (Information) button. 2 Tap the Tools tab Admin Settings Fax Settings Fax Line Settings. If Panel Lock Control is set to Enable, enter the password. See "Panel Lock." until DRPD Pattern appears, and then tap DRPD Pattern. 3 Tap 4 Select the desired pattern, and then tap OK. NOTE: • The printer provides seven DRPD patterns. If this service is available from your telephone company, ask your telephone company which pattern you need to select to use this service. 5 Turn off the printer, and then turn it on again to apply the settings. To receive faxes in the DRPD, you need to set the menu to DRPD. See "Receive Mode." Receiving Faxes in the Secure Receiving Mode You may need to prevent your received faxes from being accessed by unauthorized people. To restrict printing out all of the received faxes when the printer is unattended, turn on the secure fax mode using the Secure Receive option. In the secure fax mode, all incoming faxes is stored in memory. When the mode is turned off, all stored faxes are printed. NOTE: • To turn on the secure fax mode, Panel Lock Control must be set to Enable. To turn the secure receiving mode on: NOTE: • You can set the same setting using the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool. See "Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool." 1 Press the (Information) button. 2 Tap the Tools tab Admin Settings Fax Settings Incoming Defaults. If Panel Lock Control is set to Enable, enter the password. See "Panel Lock." 3 Tap until Secure Receive appears, and then tap Secure Receive. 4 Tap Secure Receive Set Enable. 5 Enter a four-digit password, and then tap OK. When a fax is received in the secure receiving mode, the printer stores it into memory and Secure Fax Receive is enabled on the Print screen to let you know that there is a fax stored. Faxing 259 To print received documents: 1 Press the (Home) button. Print. 2 Tap 3 Swipe the screen until Secure Fax Receive appears, and then tap Secure Fax Receive. 4 Enter a four-digit password, and then tap OK. The faxes stored in memory are printed. To turn the secure receiving mode off: 1 Follow the same steps 1 to 3 in "To turn the secure receiving mode on:." 2 Tap Secure Receive Set Disable. Receiving Faxes in the Memory Since the printer is a multi-tasking device, it can receive faxes while you are making copies or printing. If you receive a fax while you are copying, printing, or run out of paper or toner, the printer stores incoming faxes in the memory. And then, as soon as you finish copying, printing, or re-supply the consumables, the printer starts printing the fax. Polling Receive You can receive faxes from the remote fax machine when you want to receive it. 1 Press the (Home) button. Fax 2 Tap On Hook Polling. 3 Enter the fax number of the remote machine using the number pad. 4 Tap Receive. Reports Related to Fax The following reports may be useful when using fax: NOTE: • For details about other reports and how to print a report, see "Report / List." Speed Dial This list shows all the numbers currently stored in the memory of the printer as speed dial numbers. Address Book This list shows all the addresses currently stored in the printer's memory as Address Book information. Server Address This list shows all of the numbers currently stored in the printer's memory as Server Address information. Fax Activity This report shows information about the faxes you recently received or sent. Fax Pending This list shows the status of pending faxes. You may print this list to check your changes after changing any settings. Print Meter This report shows the total number of pages printed. The report is titled as Print Volume Report or ColorTrack Report, depending on the ColorTrack Mode setting. 260 Faxing Changing the Default Fax Setting NOTE: • You can set the same setting using the Tool Box or Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool. See "Tool Box" or "Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool." 1 Press the (Information) button. 2 Tap the Tools tab Default Settings 3 Select the desired menu item. If the desired menu item is not displayed, tap Fax Defaults. or to scroll through the screen. 4 Select the desired setting or enter the value, and then tap OK. 5 Repeat steps 3 and 4 as needed. Faxing 261 Dell™ Document Hub (Windows® Only) The Dell Document Hub is a convenient one-stop gateway to a variety of cloud services to help you manage your documents. With the Dell Document Hub, you can convert hard copy documents into editable digital content and store them directly in your preferred cloud storage service. You can search for files across multiple clouds simultaneously and then share and print content easily. NOTE: • Dell Document Hub is available on Dell H625cdw and Dell H825cdw. Registering the User and Signing In to the Dell Document Hub To use the Dell Document Hub, you need a user account registered to the printer, and sign in to the Dell Document Hub. Registering a New User to the Dell Document Hub Prepare the access information required for each of the cloud services you want to use, and then make sure that you have a user account registered to the printer. See "Creating a New User Account." To Register a New User From a Computer 1 Access the Dell Document Hub website from your computer by entering the following URL in the web browser: www.dell.com/dochub 2 Follow the on-screen instruction. An e-mail is sent to the registered e-mail address. 3 Check the e-mail and follow the instructions on the e-mail to activate. To Register a New User From the Printer You can start the user registration alternatively using the printer. NOTE: • To complete the registration process, you need a computer or mobile device to receive an e-mail and access the Dell Document Hub website. 1 Log in to the printer as a registered user. 2 In the Home screen, tap Dell Document Hub 262 Dell™ Document Hub (Windows® Only) New User Next. 3 Follow the on-screen instruction. Signing In to the Dell Document Hub 1 Log in to the printer as a registered user. 2 In the Home screen, tap Dell Document Hub. The Dell Doc Hub Sign In screen is displayed. 3 Tap the E-mail text box, and then enter the e-mail address. NOTE: • You can also tap to select a recently entered e-mail address from a list. The list can contain up to eight recently entered e-mail addresses. 4 Tap the Password text box, enter the password, and then tap Done. If you want to save your e-mail address and password, select the Save E-mail & Password check box. NOTE: • The e-mail address and password are stored in the printer under your user account of the printer. For security purpose, it is recommended that you protect your user account of the printer with a password. If your user account is not protected with a password, unauthorized users may login to your user account of the printer, and then access your documents in the cloud services through the Dell Document Hub. 5 Tap Sign in. NOTE: • If all the tiles on the Dell Document Hub screen are pale and disabled when you sign in, you have not completed the necessary procedures to activate your account of the Dell Document Hub. Check the e-mail you received from the Dell Document Hub, and then activate your account. Icons for the Dell Document Hub Screens 5 6 7 Dell™ Document Hub (Windows® Only) 263 1 Indicates that the cloud service is correctly associated with the Dell Document Hub. Tap to display more information. Indicates that the cloud service is not associated, or not linked correctly. Visit www.dell.com/dochub to link it again. Tap to display more information. Indicates that the cloud service link with the Dell Document Hub has expired. Visit www.dell.com/dochub to link it again. Tap to display more information. Tap to search for files in the current folder and subfolders (if any) from the selected cloud service. This is displayed when you select Scan or Smart OCR Scan. Tap to sort the results in ascending, descending, or by cloud services order. Tap to change print, scan or e-mail settings. Tap to preview the selected files, up to the first three pages of each file. Tap to save print, scan, e-mail settings or folder as Favorite. When the Favorite List Screen Is Displayed When You Tap the Tile on the Dell Document Hub Screen This means that your favorite settings for functions have been saved on the printer. Select the desired setting from the list, or tap Skip to continue the procedure. Returning to the Home Screen Tap Back or press the (Home) button. NOTE: • When you return to the Home screen by tapping Back or by pressing the (Home) button, sign-in status is maintained. Next time you tap Dell Document Hub on the Home screen, you do not have to sign in while you are logged in to the Home screen. • You can tap Sign out as well to return to the Home screen, but the sign-in status is not maintained. Next time you sign in to the Dell Document Hub, you need to re-enter your e-mail address and password. Logging Out From the Printer Press the (Log In/Out) button to log out from the Home screen and to display the portal screen. NOTE: • When you log out using the (Log In/Out) button, the sign-in status to the Dell Document Hub is maintained as far as the Save E-mail & Password check box is selected in the step 5 in "Signing In to the Dell Document Hub." Next time you tap Dell Document Hub on the Home screen, you can skip the sign in process. Searching for and Printing Files You can search for the files saved in the cloud services, and print them from the printer. You can search across multiple cloud services at once. This method is suitable when you 264 Dell™ Document Hub (Windows® Only) want to search by the keywords, including the file name. NOTE: • To search for files across multiple cloud services, visit www.dell.com/dochub and connect the cloud services with the Dell Document Hub. • This feature is enabled only when your printer still has the black toner, and the waste toner box is not full. 1 In the Dell Document Hub screen, tap Search for Files. 2 Enter the keywords, and then tap Search. Files are searched across multiple cloud services you registered. 3 Tap the files you want to print. NOTE: • If the desired file is not displayed, swipe the screen. • You can select up to 10 files. • You can sort the results by tapping and selecting the sorting order. 4 Tap , and then preview the selected files. The first three pages of each file are displayed in the small previews of the File Preview screen. • • • • To show the page in the large preview, tap the page in the small previews. To preview other files, flick the screen side to side. To specify the file as the one to be printed, select the check box at the upper-left corner beside the small previews. To return to the previous screen, tap Back. 5 Tap , and then check and change the print settings. See "Print Settings." 6 Tap Print. NOTE: • To cancel printing, tap Stop. • You can start printing by tapping Print in any screens of Search Results, File Preview or Print Settings. Browsing and Printing Files You can browse and print the files saved in the selected cloud services. This method is suitable when you know which cloud service the file you want to print is located in. 1 In the Dell Document Hub screen, tap Browse for Files. The Cloud Services screen is displayed. Dell™ Document Hub (Windows® Only) 265 To link the cloud service with the Dell Document Hub, visit www.dell.com/dochub. 2 Tap the cloud service you want to browse in. NOTE: • If the desired cloud service is not displayed, swipe the screen. 3 Select the file you want to print by performing either of the following: • Tap the location you want to browse in and the file you want to print. NOTE: • If the desired location is not displayed, swipe the screen. • Search the files in the selected cloud service. a Tap b Enter the file name or keywords, and then tap Search. NOTE: • You can sort the results by tapping and selecting the sorting order. c Tap Back to return to the previous screen. NOTE: • You can select up to 10 files. 4 Tap , and then preview the selected files. NOTE: On the File Preview screen, the first three pages of each file are displayed. To show the page in the large preview, tap the page in the small previews. To preview other files, flick the screen side to side. To specify the file as the one to be printed, select the check box at the upper-left corner beside the small previews. • To return to the previous screen, tap Back. • • • • 5 Tap , and then check and change the print settings. See "Print Settings." NOTE: • You can save your print settings and file path to the cloud service as a favorite. 1 Tap in the Print Settings screen. 2 Name your favorite in the Save Favorite screen, and then tap Save. • If you choose a name for a favorite that is the same as an existing favorite, the settings and the file path will be overwritten. • You can delete an unnecessary favorite by tapping • Once you save your settings as a favorite, you can recall those settings the next time you sign in to the Dell Document Hub from any printer of the same model. 266 Dell™ Document Hub (Windows® Only) 6 Tap Print. NOTE: • To cancel printing, tap Stop. • You can start printing by tapping Print in any screens of contents list, Search Results, File Preview, or Print Settings. Scanning You can scan the document and save the scanned data in the cloud service. 1 In the Dell Document Hub screen, tap Scan. The Cloud Services screen is displayed. 2 Select the destination you want to save the scanned data to by performing either of the following: • Tap a cloud service you want to save the scanned data to, and then perform either of the following: – Tap the location you want to save the scanned data to. NOTE: • If the location is not displayed, swipe the screen. – Search the files in the selected cloud service. a Tap b Enter the file name or keywords, and then tap Search. NOTE: • You can sort the results by tapping • and selecting the sorting order. c Tap Back to return to the previous screen. Search the files across multiple cloud services. a Tap b Enter the file name or keywords, and then tap Search. NOTE: • You can sort the results by tapping and selecting the sorting order. c Tap Back to return to the previous screen. 3 Tap Next. 4 Tap the File Name text box, and then enter the file name. 5 Tap the File Format box, and then select a file format. 6 Tap , and then check and change the scan settings. Dell™ Document Hub (Windows® Only) 267 See "Scan Settings." NOTE: • You can save your print settings and file path to the cloud service as a favorite. 1 Tap in the Scan Settings screen. 2 Name your favorite in the Save Favorite screen, and then tap Save. • If you choose a name for a favorite that is the same as an existing favorite, the settings and the file path will be overwritten. • You can delete an unnecessary favorite by tapping • Once you save your settings as a favorite, you can recall those settings the next time you sign in to the Dell Document Hub from any printer of the same model. 7 Tap Scan. NOTE: • To cancel scanning, tap Stop. When the document is loaded on the document glass, the screen prompts you for another page. • If you want to scan another document, replace the document with a new document, and then tap Continue. When you have finished loading documents, tap Done. • Scanning the Document Using Optical Character Recognition (OCR) You can scan the document using OCR, and save it in the cloud service. 1 In the Dell Document Hub screen, tap Smart OCR Scan. The Cloud Services screen is displayed. 2 Select the destination you want to save the converted file to by performing either of the following: • Tap a cloud service you want to save the converted file to, and then perform either of the following: – Tap the location you want to save the converted file to. NOTE: • If the location is not displayed, swipe the screen. – Search the files in the selected cloud service. a Tap b Enter the file name or keywords, and then tap Search. NOTE: • You can sort the results by tapping 268 Dell™ Document Hub (Windows® Only) and selecting the sorting order. • c Tap Back to return to the previous screen. Search the files across multiple cloud services. a Tap b Enter the file name or keywords, and then tap Search. NOTE: • You can sort the results by tapping and selecting the sorting order. c Tap Back to return to the previous screen. 3 Tap Next. 4 Tap the File Name text box, and then enter the file name. 5 Tap the File Format box, and then select a file format. 6 Tap , and then check and change the scan settings. See "Smart OCR Scan" and "Scan Settings.” NOTE: • You can save your print settings and file path to the cloud service as a favorite. 1 Tap in the Scan Settings screen. 2 Name your favorite in the Save Favorite screen, and then tap Save. • If you choose a name for a favorite that is the same as an existing favorite, the settings and the file path will be overwritten. • You can delete an unnecessary favorite by tapping • Once you save your settings as a favorite, you can recall those settings the next time you sign in to the Dell Document Hub from any printer of the same model. 7 Tap Scan. When the document is loaded on the document glass, the screen prompts you for another page. • • If you want to scan another document, replace the document with a new document, and then tap Continue. When you have finished loading documents, tap Done. Sending the Scanned Data to Yourself via E-Mail The document can be scanned and sent to you as an attached file of an e-mail. 1 In the Dell Document Hub screen, tap E-mail Me. The E-mail Me screen is displayed. 2 Tap the File Format box, and then select a file format. 3 Tap the Subject text box, and then enter the subject of the mail sent with the scanned data. Dell™ Document Hub (Windows® Only) 269 4 Tap , and then check and change the e-mail settings. See "E-mail Me" and "Scan Settings." NOTE: • You can save your e-mail settings to the cloud service as a favorite. 1 Tap in the E-mail Settings screen. 2 Name your favorite in the Save Favorite screen, and then tap Save. • If you choose a name for a favorite that is the same as an existing favorite, the settings and the file path will be overwritten. • You can delete an unnecessary favorite by tapping • Once you save your settings as a favorite, you can recall those settings the next time you sign in to the Dell Document Hub from any printer of the same model. 5 Tap Send. When the document is loaded on the document glass, the screen prompts you for another page. • If you want to scan another document, replace the document with a new document, and then tap Continue. When you have finished loading documents, tap Done. • Sending a Scanned Data of a Business Card to Yourself via E-Mail Business cards can be scanned and converted to vCard files, and sent to you as an attached file of an e-mail. 1 In the Dell Document Hub screen, tap Business Card Reader. The Business Card Reader screen is displayed. 2 Tap the Subject text box, and then enter the subject of the e-mail sent with the vCard file. 3 Tap , and then check and change the e-mail settings. a Tap OCR Language, and then select a language. b Tap Back to return to the previous screen. 4 Tap Send. When the document is loaded on the document glass, the screen prompts you for another page. • If you want to scan another document, replace the document with a new document, and then tap Continue. When you have finished loading documents, tap Done. • 270 Dell™ Document Hub (Windows® Only) 5 Know Your Printer Understanding the Software of Your Printer 272 User Authentication 286 Multiple Desktop - Tile Customization 290 Using the Address Book and Phone Book 292 Using Digital Certificates 298 Understanding Printer Messages 307 Specifications 317 271 Understanding the Software of Your Printer Overview Use the Software and Documentation disc to install a combination of software programs. Windows® Item OS X Linux Dell Printer Hub/Dell Print Management Tool Printer Status Window Status Monitor Console Status Monitor Widget Tool Box Address Book Editor ScanButton Manager Dell™ Supplies Management System User Setup Disk Creating Tool App Manager : supported, Blank: not supported) Dell Printer Hub/Dell Print Management Tool NOTE: • Dell Printer Hub is available on Dell H625cdw and Dell H825cdw. • Dell Print Management Tool is available on Dell S2825cdn. • It is supported on only Windows® 7 or later. This software consolidates your printer management, monitoring tools and cloud connectivity. You can conveniently access printer utilities, advanced scan features and printer/consumables details, and receive notifications on driver/software updates as well as printer status. To launch the Dell Printer Hub/Dell Print Management Tool, click Start All Programs Dell Printers Dell Printer Hub or Dell Print Management Tool. The Dell Printer Hub and Dell Print Management Tool have the following software and directories: • Address Book Editor See "Address Book Editor." • Tool Box See "Tool Box." • Printer Embedded Web Server (EWS) Displays the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool. See "Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool." • • Configuration tool App Manager See "App Manager." 272 Understanding the Software of Your Printer See the FAQ on the Dell Printer Hub or Dell Print Management Tool. Printer Status Window The Printer Status window alerts you when there is a warning or an error such as paper jams and low toner. By default, the Printer Status window opens only when an error occur. When an error occur, the error message appears on the Printer Status window. You can set the Printer Status window to always stay open when printing in Printing Status Window Properties. You can also check the toner level, quantity of paper remaining or configuration of the options for the printer. See the help on the Printer Status window. Status Monitor Console/Status Monitor Widget Use the Status Monitor Console/Status Monitor Widget to manage multiple instances of the Status Window for a particular printer. To start the Status Monitor Console, select a printer from the list view or Printer Selection, and then click the name of the printer to open the Status Window for that particular printer. For OS X, see "Using the Status Monitor Widget for Macintosh." For Linux, see "Using the Status Monitor Console for Linux." Tool Box The Tool Box allows you to view, specify, and diagnose the system settings. See the help on the Tool Box. Address Book Editor The Address Book Editor allows you to register the contact information such as phone number and e-mail address. See "Using Address Book Editor." Dell™ Supplies Management System You can use the Dell Supplies Management System to order consumables online or by phone from Dell. See "Using the Dell Supplies Management System." User Setup Disk Creating Tool The User Setup Disk Creating Tool program is used to create driver installation packages that contain custom driver settings. The User Setup Disk Creating Tool program is located in the MakeDisk folder of the Utilities folder on the Software and Documentation disc. The print drivers that are used are also located on the Software and Documentation disc. A driver installation package can contain a group of saved print driver settings and other data for things such as: • Print orientation and Multiple Up • Watermarks • Font references If you want to install the print driver with the same settings on multiple computers Understanding the Software of Your Printer 273 running the same operating system, create a setup disk in a media or in a server on the network. Using the setup disk that you have created reduces the amount of work required when installing the print driver. • Install the print driver in the computer on which the setup disk is to be created. • The setup disk can only be used on the operating system on which the disk was created or computers running the same operating system. Create a separate setup disk for each of the operating systems. App Manager The App Manager is a utility that lets you manage the apps on the printer. NOTE: • App Manager is supported only on Windows® 7 or later. The following tasks can be performed from the App Manager: • Install, update, and uninstall apps • Backup and restore printer settings, address books, and apps CAUTION: • Do not turn off the printer or the computer while backing up or restoring data. NOTE: • The App Manager can backup the data of 10 printers. For each printer, up to five backup history can be cached. • The following are not included in the backup data: - Settings data of Default Settings, Network Settings, Fax Settings, Maintenance, Secure Settings, and USB Settings - Data that is integral with other setting data such as digital certificates - Data that is specific to the printer such as an IP address - Data that is not permitted to be backed up due to security reasons - Settings about date and time, and also settings that are associated with date and time - Data that are considered invalid for settings of the printer • The time to send and create backup files may take longer depending on the data size. • The features of the App Manager may not be used when the printer has an error. If the App Manager does not respond, check and clear the status of the printer. Preparing to Use the App Manager To use the App Manager, it is recommended for your computer to have more than 25GB of storage space. NOTE: • Your computer needs to be connected to a network. USB connection is not supported. • .Net Framework4.0 or later is required. Using the App Manager The following procedure uses Windows® 7/Windows® 10 as an example. 1 Click Start All Programs Dell Printers Dell Printer Hub or Dell Print Management Tool. For Windows® 10: Click the Start button Dell Printer Hub or Dell Print Management Tool. 2 Click Printers. 3 Click Add Printer. 274 Understanding the Software of Your Printer 4 Find the printer you want to register and click Add. NOTE: • If the printer you are looking for does not appear in the list, enter the IP address of the printer in the search text box. 5 Enter the same ID and password that is used for the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool, and then click OK. 6 Click . The screen returns to the printer list. 7 Click the printer you want to manage from the list. NOTE: • If the printer you are looking for does not appear in the list or cannot be accessed from the App Manager, check that On is selected for the check boxes of Port9100 and SNMP in the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool Print Server Settings tab Port Settings. Using the Status Monitor Widget for Macintosh Status Monitor Widget is a printer utility that promotes efficient use of the printer through the exchange of information between the Macintosh and the printer. Status Monitor Widget • Monitoring Dell Printers Allows you to check the status of Dell printers currently connected to your Macintosh • Receiving Alerts Alerts you when there is a problem, such as paper jams or low toner • Ordering Supplies Allows you to access the web site to order supplies Before Installing the Status Monitor Widget Operating Systems • • • • Mac OS X 10.7 OS X 10.8 OS X 10.9 OS X 10.10 Network Protocols and Interfaces • • • • LPR Socket 9100 Bonjour USB 2.0 and 1.1 (When connecting with multiple printers of the same model via USB cables, only the printer recognized first can be monitored in the Status Monitor Widget.) Understanding the Software of Your Printer 275 Installing the Status Monitor Widget 1 Double-click the Dell Color MFP H625cdw/Dell Color MFP H825cdw/Dell Color MFP S2825cdn icon in the Finder window. 2 Follow the on-screen instructions. When the Install Succeeded screen appears, the installation is complete. NOTE: • Entering the administrative login name and password are required during the installation process. Opening and Closing the Status Monitor Widget Opening the Status Monitor Widget 1 Click the Dashboard icon in the Dock. 2 Click the Plus (+) sign. 3 Click the icon of Status Monitor in the Widget Bar. NOTE: • If the message Select a printer is displayed, select the printer in Preferences. See "Preferences." Closing the Status Monitor Widget Click the Close (x) button in the upper-left corner of the Printer Status window. Printer Status Window When the Status Monitor Widget is activated, the Printer Status window appears on Dashboard. 276 Understanding the Software of Your Printer Printer Status Message Area Displays a message of the current printer status. NOTE: • The Status Monitor Widget obtains the printer information at the updated interval that can be specified in Preferences. Also, the printer status is refreshed when Dashboard appears or Preferences is closed. • If the Status Monitor Widget receives no response from the printer, the message Cannot get printer information is displayed. • When the printer is connected via USB cable, you cannot check the status of the printer during a print or scan job. Printer Status Image Area Displays the image of printer condition. • Estimated Toner Level image Displays the estimated toner level of each color if the printer is functioning properly. NOTE: • If the utility does not receive a response from the printer, the Unknown toner image is displayed. • Printer error image Displays an indication image when an error occurs. When this image is displayed, the printer cannot be used. Order Supplies Button Displays the Order window. To hide the Order window, click Order Supplies again. Understanding the Software of Your Printer 277 Info (i) Button Opens Preferences. NOTE: • The info (i) button appears on the lower-right corner of the window when the cursor is over the Printer Status window. The info (i) button is a standard used across all widgets. Order Window This window provides you with the information for ordering printer supplies online or by phone. To open the Order window: Click Order Supplies in the Printer Status window. NOTE: • The Order window appears when low toner is detected. Order Online • Visit Dell printer supplies ordering web site. hyperlink Displays the web site for ordering Dell printer supplies. • URL list Displays a list of available URLs where you can order Dell printer supplies. Select a URL address to use when the Visit Dell printer supplies ordering web site hyperlink is clicked. Order By Phone • Phone number list Displays a list of available phone numbers that you can call to order Dell printer supplies. • Update phone contacts when rebooting check box Select this check box to regularly update the phone number list. Dell and the Environment Click the hyperlink to access the web site about recycling. 278 Understanding the Software of Your Printer Preferences To open Preferences: Click the info (i) button in the Printer Status window. NOTE: • The info (i) button appears on the lower-right corner of the window when the cursor is over the Printer Status window. The info (i) button is a standard used across all widgets. Printer Displays a list of available printer names in the pull down menu. The first printer displayed in this list is set as default. Status Update Interval You can specify the update interval of the printer status. By default, it is set to obtain the printer information every 10 seconds. SNMP Community Name You can change the SNMP (Simple Network Management Protocol) community name if using default community name (public). Up to 31 characters can be entered. Service Tag Button Click this button to obtain the service tag. NOTE: • You cannot retrieve the service tag when the printer is connected via USB cable. done Button Click this button to return to the Printer Status window. Using the Status Monitor Console for Linux Status Monitor Console is a printer utility that promotes efficient use of the printer through the exchange of information between the Linux and the printer. Status Monitor Console • Monitoring Dell Printers Allows you to check the status of Dell printers currently connected to your Linux. • Receiving Alerts Alerts you to problems, such as paper jams or low toner. • Ordering Supplies Allows you to access the web site to order supplies. Understanding the Software of Your Printer 279 Before Installing the Status Monitor Console NOTE: • The Status Monitor Console requires the following modules installed. - Python, PyGTK, Net-SNMP, cups-libs, and xdg-open Make sure that these modules are installed before you install the Status Monitor Console. • The Status Monitor Console is available when the printer is connected to a network (LPR or Socket 9100). USB connection is not supported. Distributions • • • Red Hat Enterprise Linux 6 Desktop SUSE Linux Enterprise Desktop 11 Ubuntu 12.04 LTS Printing System • Common UNIX Printing System (CUPS) Installing the Status Monitor Console 1 Activate the terminal, and then log in as a super user. 2 Enter the following rpm command in the terminal window. For Red Hat Enterprise Linux 6 Desktop and SUSE Linux Enterprise Desktop 11: # rpm -ivh (Type the package file name) For Ubuntu 12.04 LTS: # dpkg -i (Type the package file name) Starting the Status Monitor Console 1 Click Dell Printers Status Monitor Console See "Printer Selection Window." 2 Select the printer. See "Printer Status Window." Printer Selection Window 280 Understanding the Software of Your Printer Printers List All the printers registered in the Common UNIX Printing System (CUPS) are displayed in a list. • Status icons: Ready Unknown/Offline/Toner Low/Paper Low Door Open/Paper Jam/No Toner/Out Of Paper Settings Button Opens the Settings window. Details Button Opens the Printer Status window. If a non-supported printer is selected, it opens the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool. See "Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool." Refresh Button Updates the information of printers. Close Button Closes the Printer Selection window. Printer Status Window When the printer is specified in the Printer Selection window, the Printer Status window appears. Printer Status Message Area Displays a message of the current printer status. NOTE: • The Status Monitor Console obtains the printer information at the updated interval that can be specified in the Settings window. To refresh the printer status, click Refresh. • If the Status Monitor Console receives no response from the printer, the message Cannot get printer information is displayed. Understanding the Software of Your Printer 281 Printer Status Image Area • Current Toner Status icons Displays icons of the current status of each toner. The toner level is more than 30%. The toner level is less than 29%. The toner level is less than 9%. The toner level is unknown. • Estimated Toner Level images Informs about the amount of toner that remains for each color. Toner Alert Displays an alert message when any remaining toner is low, empty, or unknown. Order Online • Order Supplies Online button Displays the web site for ordering Dell printer supplies. This button appears when the amount of toners becomes less than 30%. Refresh Button Updates the status of the printer. Close Button Closes the Printer Status window. Dell Supplies Management System Window This window provides you with the information for ordering printer supplies by telephone or from the web site. To open the Dell Supplies Management System window: Click Order Supplies Online in the Printer Status window. OR Click Dell Printers Dell Supplies Management System. 282 Understanding the Software of Your Printer Select Printer Model Select the printer model name. Order Online • Order Supplies Online button – When the Regular URL is selected in the Select Reorder URL: Displays Service Tag window. – When the Premier URL is selected in the Select Reorder URL: Displays the procurement and support web site. • Select Reorder URL Displays a list of available URLs where you can order Dell printer supplies. Select a URL address to use when the Order Supplies Online button is clicked. – Regular URL: http://accessories.us.dell.com/sna/PrinterSeg.aspx – Premier URL: http://premier.dell.com Order by Phone • To order Dell printer supplies by phone, call the following Select your country with phone number from the list, and then call the displayed telephone number. • Update phone contacts when rebooting check box Select this check box to regularly update the phone number list. Dell and the Environment Click the hyperlink to access the web site about recycling. Close Button Closes the Dell Supplies Management System window. Understanding the Software of Your Printer 283 Service Tag Window Enter the Dell printer service tag. NOTE: • For details about the service tag, see "Express Service Code and Service Tag." Settings Window Click Settings in the Printer Selection window. Update of status • Printer Status is regularly updated check box Select the check box to enable the printer status to be updated by the specified interval. • Update interval text box Specify the update interval of the printer status. Port Number Settings • Port Number Specify the port number in the Port Number text box to open the setting page of the printer in a web browser. Protocol Settings - SNMP • Community Name Enter the Community name of SNMP in the Community Name text box. Order URL • 284 Select Reorder URL Understanding the Software of Your Printer The selected URL address is set as default web site for the Select Reorder URL in the Dell Supplies Management System window. Software Update Software, driver, and firmware updates can be downloaded from the Dell Support web site located at www.dell.com/support. Understanding the Software of Your Printer 285 User Authentication Using the user authentication setting, it is possible to create and manage up to 18 user accounts secured with a password. Each user of the accounts can customize the Home screen and save the changes. You can select the user authentication method from either local authentication or remote authentication. To use the remote authentication method, the LDAP or Kerberos server is required to authenticate the user. To select the user authentication method, see "Desktop Login" or "Desktop Authentication." It is also possible to associate NFC (Near Field Communication) capable ID Cards to user account. When an ID card is associated with a user account, you can login to that user account by tapping the ID card to the NFC reader, or waving the ID card over the NFC reader. NOTE: • The printer supports the following card types: - MIFARE® Ultralight - MIFARE Standard (Classic) 1K - MIFARE Standard (Classic) 4K • The NFC feature is available on Dell H625cdw and Dell H825cdw. • The portal screen is available when you select the local authentication. • Remote authentication is available for Dell S2825cdn only. Creating and Editing the User Accounts To use user authentication, you must first create a user account. Creating a New User Account 1 Turn on the printer and wait until the portal screen is displayed. NOTE: • If other account was created and specified as Initial Login, the Home screen of the account appears. 2 Tap If Panel Lock Control is set to Enable, enter the password. See "Panel Lock." 3 Tap OK. The printer enters the edit mode, and Add Account is displayed in the portal screen. NOTE: • In the edit mode, each tile except Add Account has 4 Enter the account name, tap Done, and then select the tile color. You can preview the image of your custom tile in Preview. 286 User Authentication Account Settings 1/2 Account Name Preview Guest Preview Guest Tile Color Print Back Next 5 Tap Next. 6 Enter the account password and NFC ID. To display the Home screen of your account when you turn on the printer, select the Initial Login check box. NOTE: • If no account is specified as Initial Login, the portal screen is displayed when you turn on the printer. • You can create a new account without setting the account password and NFC ID. • When the NFC Authentication is disabled, NFC ID is not displayed. NFC Authentication is available on Dell H625cdw and Dell H825cdw. • When you use UID as the NFC ID, enter the hexadecimal characters. The characters A to F should be entered in the capital letters. 7 Tap Done Done. Editing the User Account 1 Tap in the portal screen. 2 Tap OK. 3 Tap the account tile you want to edit. 4 Edit the account name, tile color, password, NFC ID, or Initial Login. NOTE: • When the NFC authentication is disabled, NFC ID is not displayed. NFC Authentication is available on Dell H625cdw and Dell H825cdw. 5 Tap Done. Deleting the User Account 1 Tap in the portal screen. 2 Tap OK. 3 Tap and hold the account tile you want to delete. 4 Drag the tile to 5 Tap OK. Logging In to the User Account There are two ways to log in to the account. One is to log in using the touch panel, and User Authentication 287 the other is to log in using the NFC authentication card. NOTE: • NFC Authentication is available on Dell H625cdw and Dell H825cdw. Logging In Using the Touch Panel 1 Start the printer and wait until the portal screen is displayed. 2 Tap the account tile you want to log in to. NOTE: • When the account you want to log in to does not require a password, skip step 3. The Home screen is displayed. 3 Enter the account password, and then tap Login. Logging In Using the NFC Authentication Card NOTE: • NFC Authentication is available on Dell H625cdw and Dell H825cdw. • To use the NFC authentication card, the following settings are required: - Enable the NFC authentication setting in Secure Settings of the operator panel. See "NFC Authentication." - Register your user account to the printer. See "Creating a New User Account." 1 Turn on the printer and wait until the portal screen is displayed. NOTE: • The NFC authentication is available only when the portal screen is displayed. 2 Wave the card over the NFC reader on the printer. Logging In Using the Local Authentication or Remote Authentication Specifying the User Authentication Method Use the operator panel menu or the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool. For details about how to specify the user authentication method, see "Desktop Login" or "Desktop Authentication." Preparations for Remote Authentication To use the remote authentication method, the printer needs to be specified so that the printer can access to the LDAP or Kerberos server, and that the users need to be registered to the Server Address Book. For details, see "Using the Server Address Book and Server Phone Book" and "Using the Address Book and Phone Book." Logging In for Remote Authentication The Sign in screen is displayed when the printer is turned on while the printer is specified to use the remote authentication method. Enter the login name and password registered in the LDAP or Kerberos server to log in to the printer. 288 User Authentication Logging Out When there is an account which is specified as Initial Login, the Home screen of the account is always displayed after the printer is turned on. To log in to another account, you need to log out first. 1 Press the (Log In/Out) button. User Authentication 289 Multiple Desktop - Tile Customization The Home screen is like a desktop of your computer and customizable to suit your preference or work style. For example, you can gather only the tiles you often use, or rearrange the tiles so that you can easily access the tiles you often use. Home Guest Dell Document Hub Copy Print PDF/TIFF Fax The tiles on the Home screen can be the shortcuts to the jobs to be performed on the printer, like "taking seven copies of the handouts for the weekly meeting in two-sided color copy" or "scanning the document and sending the scanned data to my boss by e-mail." If you create a tile for a job with such job settings, the printer changes the settings of the printer as you specified just by tapping the tile. Adding a New Tile You can select and add the tile from the pre-defined tiles, or you can create a new customized tile which includes specific settings for copy, fax, scan or print. Up to 28 tiles can be placed in your Home screen. You can also add tiles to each of the copy, print, scan, and fax group screen that is displayed when tapping the icons in the Dock Menu. Up to 8 tiles can be placed in each group screen. NOTE: • If a tile is added to the Home screen, it will also be added to the relevant group screen. If a tile is added to a group screen, it will also be added to the Home screen. Selecting From the Pre-defined Tiles The printer offers the pre-defined tiles which include the default job settings. 1 On the Home screen or group screen, tap Add App. NOTE: • If the maximum number of tiles have been reached in a group screen, the tiles relevant to the group is not displayed in the list. 2 Tap the tile you want to add to your Home screen or group screen. is displayed on the upper-right of the tile when you add the tile in your Home screen. Creating a New Tile Including the Job Settings You may often use the same settings to copy a certain document, for example. You can create the tile including those job settings and save it in your Home screen. 290 Multiple Desktop - Tile Customization Creating Your Custom Tile The following explanation is an example to create your custom tile for copying. To create custom tiles for other jobs such as faxing, scanning, or printing, follow the same procedures on the job settings screen of each job. 1 Tap the Copy tile in your Home screen. 2 Tap the setting tiles and change the copy options as needed. See "Copy." 3 Tap 4 Tap the text box, and then enter the name of your settings. 5 Tap the color tile you want to set as your custom tile. NOTE: • You can preview the image of your custom tile in Preview. 6 Tap Save As. NOTE: • When a tile has the Lock icon, that function is controlled by the Functions Control setting. To enable the function, you need to enter the password. See "Functions Control." • When you save the job settings for Fax or Scan to Email as a custom tile, recipient information is saved together with the settings. To prevent from sending faxes or e-mails to wrong recipients, make sure that the fax numbers or e-mail addresses of the recipients displayed on the touch panel are correct. To prevent others from using customized tiles with personal information, log out from your user account after you finish using the printer. Editing Your Custom Tile You can edit the job settings saved in your custom tile. 1 Tap the tile you want to edit in your Home screen or group screen. 2 Change the job settings as needed. 3 Tap 4 Tap the text box to name your settings if you want to rename your settings. 5 Tap the color tile if you want to change the color of the tile. 6 Tap Save. NOTE: • If you tap Save As instead, the new tile is added in your Home screen. Moving or Deleting Your Tiles You can move or delete your tiles from your Home screen or group screen. See "Moving, Adding or Deleting the Tiles." Multiple Desktop - Tile Customization 291 Using the Address Book and Phone Book There are several address books available for Scan and Fax functions. Address books help you organize contact information, such as e-mail addresses, fax numbers and server information, and quickly choose the recipient or locate the address. The address book data can be obtained from the printer or a remote LDAP server. NOTE: • Phone Book is described as one of Address Books in this section. • For details about how to setup the LDAP server, see "LDAP Server" and "LDAP User Mapping." For details about how to obtain e-mail addresses and fax numbers from LDAP servers, see "Using the Server Address Book and Server Phone Book." Types of Address Books • E-mail Address Book (for Scan to Email) E-mail addresses registered for sending the scanned data via e-mail • E-mail Group (for Scan to Email) Groups of e-mail addresses registered for sending the scanned data via e-mail • LDAP Server Address Book (for Scan to Email) E-mail addresses registered in the LDAP server for sending the scanned data via e-mail • Network Address Book (for Scan to Network Folder) Computer and FTP server information registered for sending the scanned data to a computer or ftp server • Phone Book (for Fax) Fax numbers registered for sending scanned data from the printer • Group Dial (for Fax) Groups of fax numbers registered for sending scanned data from the printer • LDAP Server Phone Book (for Fax) Fax numbers registered in the LDAP server for sending scanned data from the printer • PC Fax Address Book (for Direct Fax) Fax numbers registered for sending scanned data from your computer • PC Fax Address Book for group (for Direct Fax) Groups of fax numbers registered for sending scanned data from your computer Adding and Editing Entries to the Address Books There are following three ways to add or edit entries to the address books: • Operator panel of the printer • Address Book Editor • Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool 292 Using the Address Book and Phone Book Functions Scan Features E-mail Types of Address Books Entry Method Operator Panel Address Book on the Printer Editor Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool Address Book E-mail Group Server Address Book (LDAP server) Fax Network Address Book Fax Phone Book Group Dial Server Phone Book (LDAP server) Direct Fax PC Fax Address Book PC Fax Address Book - group : supported, Blank: not supported) Using Operator Panel of the Printer You can directly enter the fax numbers on the operator panel. NOTE: • For details about how to add a new entry, see "Setting Speed Dial." Using Address Book Editor You can use Address Book Editor installed on your computer to add or edit entries. Address Book Editor is synchronized with the address books of the printer and updated simultaneously as you save changes to the entries in Address Book Editor. NOTE: • When the printer and your computer is connected via USB, you must install the scanner driver. With Address Book Editor, you can: • Retrieve data from the address books of the printer at startup. • Synchronize with the printer. • Import the Address Book data from CSV file, WAB file, MAPI, and LDAP server. • Export the Address Book data into a CSV file. NOTE: • Do not edit the exported CSV file with programs other than the Address Book Editor. Editing the CSV file with other programs may corrupt the address data. Address Book Panel There are two address books you can manage in the Address Book Editor: Device Address Book for Fax, E-mail, and Server and PC Fax Address Book for Direct Fax. Editing an Entry 1 Select an Address Book that the entry you want to edit is stored. Using the Address Book and Phone Book 293 2 Select an entry that you want to edit. 3 Click Edit, and then enter new information. 4 Click Save. NOTE: • When the address book entries are updated, it synchronizes with the printer and updates the address books of the printer simultaneously. Using Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool You can use Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool using a general web browser. NOTE: • For details about how to add a new entry, see "Address Book." • When the address book entries are updated, the address books of the printer are also updated simultaneously. Using the Server Address Book and Server Phone Book With the E-mail Server Address Book and the Fax Server Phone Book, you can specify an e-mail address or fax number of a recipient registered in the external LDAP server when sending a scanned data with e-mail or fax. To use the E-mail Server Address Book and the Fax Server Phone Book, the printer needs to be configured in order to access the external LDAP server. NOTE: • To configure the settings of the external LDAP server, contact your system administrator. Preparing the Printer to Access the External LDAP Server Set the following items using the Dell™ Printer Configuration Web Tool. • Authentication type • LDAP Server • LDAP User Mapping Starting the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool To start the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool, enter the IP address of the printer in the address bar of a web browser. If you do not know the IP address of the printer, verify the IP address by using the operator panel, printing the system settings report, or using the ping command. See "Verifying the IP Settings." Setting Authentication Type 1 Click Print Server Settings 294 the Security tab Using the Address Book and Phone Book Authentication System. 2 In the Authentication System Settings drop-down list box under Authentication Type, select LDAP as the authentication method, and then click Apply New Settings. NOTE: • When the server you are accessing uses the Kerberos authentication, select Kerberos as the authentication method. To set the information necessary to access the Kerberos server, enter the information in Kerberos Server under the Security tab. See "Kerberos Server." 3 Click Restart Printer. Setting LDAP Server NOTE: • When SSL/TLS communication is required to access the LDAP server, select the Enable check box for LDAP-SSL/TLS Communication in SSL/TLS under the Security tab. See "SSL/TLS." 1 Click Print Server Settings the Security tab LDAP Server. 2 In the IP Address/Host Name & Port text box under Server Information, enter IP address or the host name, and the port number. Using the Address Book and Phone Book 295 The port number must be 389, 3268, or between 5000 and 65535. NOTE: • When LDAPS communication is required, set the port number to 636, and when you use the global catalog, set the port number to 3269. 3 Under Optional information, set the following items. For details about configuring each item, contact your network administrator. a In the Search Directory Root text box, enter the search directory root. b In Login Credentials to Access LDAP Server, select credential used to access the LDAP server. c In the Login Name text box, enter the login name. d In the Password text box, enter the login password using 1 to 127 alphanumeric characters. If the password is left blank (NULL), you cannot log in to a server. e In the Re-enter Password text box, enter the login password again to check it. f In Search Time-Out, select Wait LDAP Server Limit if you want to follow the time specified by the LDAP server. Select Wait if you want to specify the time. g In the Search Name Order drop-down list box, specify the search order. h In Server Address Book, select the check box if you want to enable the server address book. i In Server Phone Book, select the check box if you want to enable the server phone book. 4 Click Apply New Settings. 5 Click Restart Printer. Setting LDAP User Mapping 1 Click Print Server Settings the Security tab LDAP User Mapping. 2 Specify the attribute names used in the LDAP server. NOTE: • If the attribute names are not customized in the LDAP server, leave the settings in this step as they are by default. 3 Click Apply New Settings. 4 Click Restart Printer. 296 Using the Address Book and Phone Book Sending an E-mail With the Scanned Data Using the E-mail Server Address Book 1 Press the 2 Tap (Home) button. Scan to Email. 3 Tap Address Book. 4 Tap Network Address Book. 5 Enter a keyword using the keyboard, and then tap Search. 6 Tap a recipient from the search result, and then tap Done. 7 Tap Send. Sending a Fax Using the Fax Server Phone Book 1 Press the 2 Tap (Home) button. Fax. 3 Tap Phone Book. 4 Tap Network Phone Book. 5 Enter a keyword using the keyboard, and then tap Search. 6 Tap a recipient from the search result, and then tap Done. 7 Tap Send. Using the Address Book and Phone Book 297 Using Digital Certificates The authentication feature using digital certificates upgrades security when sending print data or setting data. This chapter describes how to manage digital certificates. The printer supports the following digital certificate formats. • PKCS#12 HTTPS, IPsec (PKI), Wi-Fi (WPA-Enterprise) • PKCS#7 (for CSR) HTTPS, IPsec (PKI) NOTE: • For details about digital certificate error, see "Understanding Printer Messages" and "Digital Certificate Problems." The following is a typical setup flow for using digital certificates. Prepare to manage digital certificates. • Set HTTPS Communication Import and set digital certificates. • Import a Digital Certificate • Set a Digital Certificate • Check the Settings of a Digital Certificate Set various security features using digital certificates. Managing Certificates This section describes how to manage digital certificates as follows: • "Preparing to Use HTTPS Communication" • "Creating and Downloading a Certificate Signing Request (CSR)" • "Importing a Digital Certificate" • "Setting a Digital Certificate" • "Confirming the Settings of a Digital Certificate" • "Deleting a Digital Certificate" • "Exporting a Digital Certificate" Preparing to Use HTTPS Communication Before managing digital certificates, set HTTPS communication with a self-signed certificate. 1 Start the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool. See "Starting the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool." 2 Click Print Server Settings the Security tab SSL/TLS. 3 Click Generate Self-Signed Certificate of Machine Digital Certificate. 298 Using Digital Certificates 4 Select the size of public key from the list of Size of Public Key. 5 Specify the issuer of SSL self-signed certificate. 6 Click Generate Signed Certificate. After the self-signed certificate is generated, the Restart Printer button appears. 7 Click Restart Printer. 8 Repeat steps 2 to 4. The SSL/TLS page is displayed. 9 When the self-signed certificate is set correctly, the HTTP- SSL/TLS Communication column is set to Enable, select the Enable check box. Creating and Downloading a Certificate Signing Request (CSR) NOTE: • To download a CSR from the printer, you must set up HTTPS communication. See "Preparing to Use HTTPS Communication." 1 Start the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool. See "Starting the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool." 2 Click Print Server Settings the Security tab SSL/TLS. 3 Click Certificate Signing Request (CSR). 4 Specify each item of certificate signing request. 5 Click Apply New Settings. 6 Check the settings of certificate signing request, and then click Download. 7 Save a CSR file to your computer. Use this CSR to receive a signed certificate from a trusted certificate authority. Importing a Digital Certificate CAUTION: • Before importing a certificate file, backup the certificate file. NOTE: • To manage digital certificates, you must set up HTTPS communication. See "Preparing to Use HTTPS Communication." • Make sure to import the certificate with Internet Explorer. • After importing a PKCS#12 format certificate, the secret key is not exported even if you execute exporting. 1 Start the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool. See "Starting the Dell Printer Configuration Web Tool." 2 Click Print Server Settings the Security tab SSL/TLS. 3 Click Upload Signed Certificate of Machine Digital Certificate. Using Digital Certificates 299
Source Exif Data:
File Type : PDF File Type Extension : pdf MIME Type : application/pdf PDF Version : 1.6 Linearized : No Author : 40701 Create Date : 2015:08:31 17:27:59+09:00 Modify Date : 2015:08:31 17:52:33+09:00 XMP Toolkit : Adobe XMP Core 5.2-c001 63.139439, 2010/09/27-13:37:26 Creator Tool : FrameMaker 12.0.2 Metadata Date : 2015:08:31 17:52:33+09:00 Producer : Acrobat Distiller 10.1.2 (Windows) Format : application/pdf Title : untitled Creator : 40701 Document ID : uuid:a6622c76-465c-4115-aa97-9f098c3c2fce Instance ID : uuid:ec615001-3346-4a0c-96cb-eb2d33dfdc3a Page Count : 299EXIF Metadata provided by EXIF.tools